]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/md.texi
Initial commit of Networking TS implementation
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / md.texi
CommitLineData
85ec4feb 1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
03dda8e3
RK
2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@ifset INTERNALS
6@node Machine Desc
7@chapter Machine Descriptions
8@cindex machine descriptions
9
10A machine description has two parts: a file of instruction patterns
11(@file{.md} file) and a C header file of macro definitions.
12
13The @file{.md} file for a target machine contains a pattern for each
14instruction that the target machine supports (or at least each instruction
15that is worth telling the compiler about). It may also contain comments.
16A semicolon causes the rest of the line to be a comment, unless the semicolon
17is inside a quoted string.
18
19See the next chapter for information on the C header file.
20
21@menu
55e4756f 22* Overview:: How the machine description is used.
03dda8e3
RK
23* Patterns:: How to write instruction patterns.
24* Example:: An explained example of a @code{define_insn} pattern.
25* RTL Template:: The RTL template defines what insns match a pattern.
26* Output Template:: The output template says how to make assembler code
6ccde948 27 from such an insn.
03dda8e3 28* Output Statement:: For more generality, write C code to output
6ccde948 29 the assembler code.
e543e219 30* Predicates:: Controlling what kinds of operands can be used
6ccde948 31 for an insn.
e543e219 32* Constraints:: Fine-tuning operand selection.
03dda8e3
RK
33* Standard Names:: Names mark patterns to use for code generation.
34* Pattern Ordering:: When the order of patterns makes a difference.
35* Dependent Patterns:: Having one pattern may make you need another.
36* Jump Patterns:: Special considerations for patterns for jump insns.
6e4fcc95 37* Looping Patterns:: How to define patterns for special looping insns.
03dda8e3 38* Insn Canonicalizations::Canonicalization of Instructions
03dda8e3 39* Expander Definitions::Generating a sequence of several RTL insns
6ccde948 40 for a standard operation.
f3a3d0d3 41* Insn Splitting:: Splitting Instructions into Multiple Instructions.
6ccde948 42* Including Patterns:: Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
f3a3d0d3 43* Peephole Definitions::Defining machine-specific peephole optimizations.
03dda8e3 44* Insn Attributes:: Specifying the value of attributes for generated insns.
3262c1f5 45* Conditional Execution::Generating @code{define_insn} patterns for
6ccde948 46 predication.
477c104e
MK
47* Define Subst:: Generating @code{define_insn} and @code{define_expand}
48 patterns from other patterns.
c25c12b8
R
49* Constant Definitions::Defining symbolic constants that can be used in the
50 md file.
3abcb3a7 51* Iterators:: Using iterators to generate patterns from a template.
03dda8e3
RK
52@end menu
53
55e4756f
DD
54@node Overview
55@section Overview of How the Machine Description is Used
56
57There are three main conversions that happen in the compiler:
58
59@enumerate
60
61@item
62The front end reads the source code and builds a parse tree.
63
64@item
65The parse tree is used to generate an RTL insn list based on named
66instruction patterns.
67
68@item
69The insn list is matched against the RTL templates to produce assembler
70code.
71
72@end enumerate
73
74For the generate pass, only the names of the insns matter, from either a
75named @code{define_insn} or a @code{define_expand}. The compiler will
76choose the pattern with the right name and apply the operands according
77to the documentation later in this chapter, without regard for the RTL
78template or operand constraints. Note that the names the compiler looks
d7d9c429 79for are hard-coded in the compiler---it will ignore unnamed patterns and
55e4756f
DD
80patterns with names it doesn't know about, but if you don't provide a
81named pattern it needs, it will abort.
82
83If a @code{define_insn} is used, the template given is inserted into the
84insn list. If a @code{define_expand} is used, one of three things
85happens, based on the condition logic. The condition logic may manually
86create new insns for the insn list, say via @code{emit_insn()}, and
aee96fe9 87invoke @code{DONE}. For certain named patterns, it may invoke @code{FAIL} to tell the
55e4756f
DD
88compiler to use an alternate way of performing that task. If it invokes
89neither @code{DONE} nor @code{FAIL}, the template given in the pattern
90is inserted, as if the @code{define_expand} were a @code{define_insn}.
91
92Once the insn list is generated, various optimization passes convert,
93replace, and rearrange the insns in the insn list. This is where the
94@code{define_split} and @code{define_peephole} patterns get used, for
95example.
96
97Finally, the insn list's RTL is matched up with the RTL templates in the
98@code{define_insn} patterns, and those patterns are used to emit the
99final assembly code. For this purpose, each named @code{define_insn}
100acts like it's unnamed, since the names are ignored.
101
03dda8e3
RK
102@node Patterns
103@section Everything about Instruction Patterns
104@cindex patterns
105@cindex instruction patterns
106
107@findex define_insn
2f9d3709
JG
108A @code{define_insn} expression is used to define instruction patterns
109to which insns may be matched. A @code{define_insn} expression contains
110an incomplete RTL expression, with pieces to be filled in later, operand
111constraints that restrict how the pieces can be filled in, and an output
112template or C code to generate the assembler output.
03dda8e3
RK
113
114A @code{define_insn} is an RTL expression containing four or five operands:
115
116@enumerate
117@item
0016d8d9
RS
118An optional name @var{n}. When a name is present, the compiler
119automically generates a C++ function @samp{gen_@var{n}} that takes
120the operands of the instruction as arguments and returns the instruction's
121rtx pattern. The compiler also assigns the instruction a unique code
122@samp{CODE_FOR_@var{n}}, with all such codes belonging to an enum
123called @code{insn_code}.
124
125These names serve one of two purposes. The first is to indicate that the
126instruction performs a certain standard job for the RTL-generation
127pass of the compiler, such as a move, an addition, or a conditional
128jump. The second is to help the target generate certain target-specific
129operations, such as when implementing target-specific intrinsic functions.
130
131It is better to prefix target-specific names with the name of the
132target, to avoid any clash with current or future standard names.
03dda8e3
RK
133
134The absence of a name is indicated by writing an empty string
135where the name should go. Nameless instruction patterns are never
136used for generating RTL code, but they may permit several simpler insns
137to be combined later on.
138
661cb0b7
RK
139For the purpose of debugging the compiler, you may also specify a
140name beginning with the @samp{*} character. Such a name is used only
2f9d3709
JG
141for identifying the instruction in RTL dumps; it is equivalent to having
142a nameless pattern for all other purposes. Names beginning with the
143@samp{*} character are not required to be unique.
661cb0b7 144
0016d8d9
RS
145The name may also have the form @samp{@@@var{n}}. This has the same
146effect as a name @samp{@var{n}}, but in addition tells the compiler to
8bdea528 147generate further helper functions; see @ref{Parameterized Names} for details.
0016d8d9 148
03dda8e3 149@item
2f9d3709
JG
150The @dfn{RTL template}: This is a vector of incomplete RTL expressions
151which describe the semantics of the instruction (@pxref{RTL Template}).
152It is incomplete because it may contain @code{match_operand},
03dda8e3
RK
153@code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup} expressions that stand for
154operands of the instruction.
155
2f9d3709
JG
156If the vector has multiple elements, the RTL template is treated as a
157@code{parallel} expression.
03dda8e3
RK
158
159@item
160@cindex pattern conditions
161@cindex conditions, in patterns
2f9d3709
JG
162The condition: This is a string which contains a C expression. When the
163compiler attempts to match RTL against a pattern, the condition is
164evaluated. If the condition evaluates to @code{true}, the match is
165permitted. The condition may be an empty string, which is treated
166as always @code{true}.
03dda8e3
RK
167
168@cindex named patterns and conditions
2f9d3709
JG
169For a named pattern, the condition may not depend on the data in the
170insn being matched, but only the target-machine-type flags. The compiler
171needs to test these conditions during initialization in order to learn
172exactly which named instructions are available in a particular run.
03dda8e3
RK
173
174@findex operands
175For nameless patterns, the condition is applied only when matching an
176individual insn, and only after the insn has matched the pattern's
177recognition template. The insn's operands may be found in the vector
2f9d3709
JG
178@code{operands}.
179
49e478af
RS
180An instruction condition cannot become more restrictive as compilation
181progresses. If the condition accepts a particular RTL instruction at
182one stage of compilation, it must continue to accept that instruction
183until the final pass. For example, @samp{!reload_completed} and
184@samp{can_create_pseudo_p ()} are both invalid instruction conditions,
185because they are true during the earlier RTL passes and false during
186the later ones. For the same reason, if a condition accepts an
187instruction before register allocation, it cannot later try to control
188register allocation by excluding certain register or value combinations.
189
190Although a condition cannot become more restrictive as compilation
191progresses, the condition for a nameless pattern @emph{can} become
192more permissive. For example, a nameless instruction can require
193@samp{reload_completed} to be true, in which case it only matches
194after register allocation.
03dda8e3
RK
195
196@item
2f9d3709
JG
197The @dfn{output template} or @dfn{output statement}: This is either
198a string, or a fragment of C code which returns a string.
03dda8e3
RK
199
200When simple substitution isn't general enough, you can specify a piece
201of C code to compute the output. @xref{Output Statement}.
202
203@item
2f9d3709
JG
204The @dfn{insn attributes}: This is an optional vector containing the values of
205attributes for insns matching this pattern (@pxref{Insn Attributes}).
03dda8e3
RK
206@end enumerate
207
208@node Example
209@section Example of @code{define_insn}
210@cindex @code{define_insn} example
211
2f9d3709
JG
212Here is an example of an instruction pattern, taken from the machine
213description for the 68000/68020.
03dda8e3 214
3ab51846 215@smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
216(define_insn "tstsi"
217 [(set (cc0)
218 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
219 ""
220 "*
f282ffb3 221@{
0f40f9f7 222 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
03dda8e3 223 return \"tstl %0\";
f282ffb3 224 return \"cmpl #0,%0\";
0f40f9f7 225@}")
3ab51846 226@end smallexample
0f40f9f7
ZW
227
228@noindent
229This can also be written using braced strings:
230
3ab51846 231@smallexample
0f40f9f7
ZW
232(define_insn "tstsi"
233 [(set (cc0)
234 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
235 ""
f282ffb3 236@{
0f40f9f7
ZW
237 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
238 return "tstl %0";
f282ffb3 239 return "cmpl #0,%0";
0f40f9f7 240@})
3ab51846 241@end smallexample
03dda8e3 242
2f9d3709
JG
243This describes an instruction which sets the condition codes based on the
244value of a general operand. It has no condition, so any insn with an RTL
245description of the form shown may be matched to this pattern. The name
246@samp{tstsi} means ``test a @code{SImode} value'' and tells the RTL
247generation pass that, when it is necessary to test such a value, an insn
248to do so can be constructed using this pattern.
03dda8e3
RK
249
250The output control string is a piece of C code which chooses which
251output template to return based on the kind of operand and the specific
252type of CPU for which code is being generated.
253
254@samp{"rm"} is an operand constraint. Its meaning is explained below.
255
256@node RTL Template
257@section RTL Template
258@cindex RTL insn template
259@cindex generating insns
260@cindex insns, generating
261@cindex recognizing insns
262@cindex insns, recognizing
263
264The RTL template is used to define which insns match the particular pattern
265and how to find their operands. For named patterns, the RTL template also
266says how to construct an insn from specified operands.
267
268Construction involves substituting specified operands into a copy of the
269template. Matching involves determining the values that serve as the
270operands in the insn being matched. Both of these activities are
271controlled by special expression types that direct matching and
272substitution of the operands.
273
274@table @code
275@findex match_operand
276@item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} @var{constraint})
277This expression is a placeholder for operand number @var{n} of
278the insn. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n}
279will be substituted at this point. When matching an insn, whatever
280appears at this position in the insn will be taken as operand
281number @var{n}; but it must satisfy @var{predicate} or this instruction
282pattern will not match at all.
283
284Operand numbers must be chosen consecutively counting from zero in
285each instruction pattern. There may be only one @code{match_operand}
286expression in the pattern for each operand number. Usually operands
287are numbered in the order of appearance in @code{match_operand}
72938a4c
MM
288expressions. In the case of a @code{define_expand}, any operand numbers
289used only in @code{match_dup} expressions have higher values than all
290other operand numbers.
03dda8e3 291
e543e219
ZW
292@var{predicate} is a string that is the name of a function that
293accepts two arguments, an expression and a machine mode.
294@xref{Predicates}. During matching, the function will be called with
295the putative operand as the expression and @var{m} as the mode
296argument (if @var{m} is not specified, @code{VOIDmode} will be used,
297which normally causes @var{predicate} to accept any mode). If it
298returns zero, this instruction pattern fails to match.
299@var{predicate} may be an empty string; then it means no test is to be
300done on the operand, so anything which occurs in this position is
301valid.
03dda8e3
RK
302
303Most of the time, @var{predicate} will reject modes other than @var{m}---but
304not always. For example, the predicate @code{address_operand} uses
305@var{m} as the mode of memory ref that the address should be valid for.
306Many predicates accept @code{const_int} nodes even though their mode is
307@code{VOIDmode}.
308
309@var{constraint} controls reloading and the choice of the best register
310class to use for a value, as explained later (@pxref{Constraints}).
e543e219 311If the constraint would be an empty string, it can be omitted.
03dda8e3
RK
312
313People are often unclear on the difference between the constraint and the
314predicate. The predicate helps decide whether a given insn matches the
315pattern. The constraint plays no role in this decision; instead, it
316controls various decisions in the case of an insn which does match.
317
03dda8e3
RK
318@findex match_scratch
319@item (match_scratch:@var{m} @var{n} @var{constraint})
320This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}
321and indicates that operand must be a @code{scratch} or @code{reg}
322expression.
323
324When matching patterns, this is equivalent to
325
326@smallexample
e80f9fef 327(match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} "scratch_operand" @var{constraint})
03dda8e3
RK
328@end smallexample
329
330but, when generating RTL, it produces a (@code{scratch}:@var{m})
331expression.
332
333If the last few expressions in a @code{parallel} are @code{clobber}
334expressions whose operands are either a hard register or
335@code{match_scratch}, the combiner can add or delete them when
336necessary. @xref{Side Effects}.
337
338@findex match_dup
339@item (match_dup @var{n})
340This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}.
341It is used when the operand needs to appear more than once in the
342insn.
343
344In construction, @code{match_dup} acts just like @code{match_operand}:
345the operand is substituted into the insn being constructed. But in
346matching, @code{match_dup} behaves differently. It assumes that operand
347number @var{n} has already been determined by a @code{match_operand}
348appearing earlier in the recognition template, and it matches only an
349identical-looking expression.
350
55e4756f
DD
351Note that @code{match_dup} should not be used to tell the compiler that
352a particular register is being used for two operands (example:
353@code{add} that adds one register to another; the second register is
354both an input operand and the output operand). Use a matching
355constraint (@pxref{Simple Constraints}) for those. @code{match_dup} is for the cases where one
356operand is used in two places in the template, such as an instruction
357that computes both a quotient and a remainder, where the opcode takes
358two input operands but the RTL template has to refer to each of those
359twice; once for the quotient pattern and once for the remainder pattern.
360
03dda8e3
RK
361@findex match_operator
362@item (match_operator:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{operands}@dots{}])
363This pattern is a kind of placeholder for a variable RTL expression
364code.
365
366When constructing an insn, it stands for an RTL expression whose
367expression code is taken from that of operand @var{n}, and whose
368operands are constructed from the patterns @var{operands}.
369
370When matching an expression, it matches an expression if the function
371@var{predicate} returns nonzero on that expression @emph{and} the
372patterns @var{operands} match the operands of the expression.
373
374Suppose that the function @code{commutative_operator} is defined as
375follows, to match any expression whose operator is one of the
376commutative arithmetic operators of RTL and whose mode is @var{mode}:
377
378@smallexample
379int
ec8e098d 380commutative_integer_operator (x, mode)
03dda8e3 381 rtx x;
ef4bddc2 382 machine_mode mode;
03dda8e3
RK
383@{
384 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
385 if (GET_MODE (x) != mode)
386 return 0;
ec8e098d 387 return (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == RTX_COMM_ARITH
03dda8e3
RK
388 || code == EQ || code == NE);
389@}
390@end smallexample
391
392Then the following pattern will match any RTL expression consisting
393of a commutative operator applied to two general operands:
394
395@smallexample
396(match_operator:SI 3 "commutative_operator"
397 [(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "g")
398 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g")])
399@end smallexample
400
401Here the vector @code{[@var{operands}@dots{}]} contains two patterns
402because the expressions to be matched all contain two operands.
403
404When this pattern does match, the two operands of the commutative
405operator are recorded as operands 1 and 2 of the insn. (This is done
406by the two instances of @code{match_operand}.) Operand 3 of the insn
407will be the entire commutative expression: use @code{GET_CODE
408(operands[3])} to see which commutative operator was used.
409
410The machine mode @var{m} of @code{match_operator} works like that of
411@code{match_operand}: it is passed as the second argument to the
412predicate function, and that function is solely responsible for
413deciding whether the expression to be matched ``has'' that mode.
414
415When constructing an insn, argument 3 of the gen-function will specify
e979f9e8 416the operation (i.e.@: the expression code) for the expression to be
03dda8e3
RK
417made. It should be an RTL expression, whose expression code is copied
418into a new expression whose operands are arguments 1 and 2 of the
419gen-function. The subexpressions of argument 3 are not used;
420only its expression code matters.
421
422When @code{match_operator} is used in a pattern for matching an insn,
423it usually best if the operand number of the @code{match_operator}
424is higher than that of the actual operands of the insn. This improves
425register allocation because the register allocator often looks at
426operands 1 and 2 of insns to see if it can do register tying.
427
428There is no way to specify constraints in @code{match_operator}. The
429operand of the insn which corresponds to the @code{match_operator}
430never has any constraints because it is never reloaded as a whole.
431However, if parts of its @var{operands} are matched by
432@code{match_operand} patterns, those parts may have constraints of
433their own.
434
435@findex match_op_dup
436@item (match_op_dup:@var{m} @var{n}[@var{operands}@dots{}])
437Like @code{match_dup}, except that it applies to operators instead of
438operands. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be
439substituted at this point. But in matching, @code{match_op_dup} behaves
440differently. It assumes that operand number @var{n} has already been
441determined by a @code{match_operator} appearing earlier in the
442recognition template, and it matches only an identical-looking
443expression.
444
445@findex match_parallel
446@item (match_parallel @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
447This pattern is a placeholder for an insn that consists of a
448@code{parallel} expression with a variable number of elements. This
449expression should only appear at the top level of an insn pattern.
450
451When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be substituted at
452this point. When matching an insn, it matches if the body of the insn
453is a @code{parallel} expression with at least as many elements as the
454vector of @var{subpat} expressions in the @code{match_parallel}, if each
455@var{subpat} matches the corresponding element of the @code{parallel},
456@emph{and} the function @var{predicate} returns nonzero on the
457@code{parallel} that is the body of the insn. It is the responsibility
458of the predicate to validate elements of the @code{parallel} beyond
bd819a4a 459those listed in the @code{match_parallel}.
03dda8e3
RK
460
461A typical use of @code{match_parallel} is to match load and store
462multiple expressions, which can contain a variable number of elements
463in a @code{parallel}. For example,
03dda8e3
RK
464
465@smallexample
466(define_insn ""
467 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
468 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
469 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
470 (use (reg:SI 179))
471 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
472 ""
473 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
474@end smallexample
475
476This example comes from @file{a29k.md}. The function
9c34dbbf 477@code{load_multiple_operation} is defined in @file{a29k.c} and checks
03dda8e3
RK
478that subsequent elements in the @code{parallel} are the same as the
479@code{set} in the pattern, except that they are referencing subsequent
480registers and memory locations.
481
482An insn that matches this pattern might look like:
483
484@smallexample
485(parallel
486 [(set (reg:SI 20) (mem:SI (reg:SI 100)))
487 (use (reg:SI 179))
488 (clobber (reg:SI 179))
489 (set (reg:SI 21)
490 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
491 (const_int 4))))
492 (set (reg:SI 22)
493 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
494 (const_int 8))))])
495@end smallexample
496
497@findex match_par_dup
498@item (match_par_dup @var{n} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
499Like @code{match_op_dup}, but for @code{match_parallel} instead of
500@code{match_operator}.
501
03dda8e3
RK
502@end table
503
504@node Output Template
505@section Output Templates and Operand Substitution
506@cindex output templates
507@cindex operand substitution
508
509@cindex @samp{%} in template
510@cindex percent sign
511The @dfn{output template} is a string which specifies how to output the
512assembler code for an instruction pattern. Most of the template is a
513fixed string which is output literally. The character @samp{%} is used
514to specify where to substitute an operand; it can also be used to
515identify places where different variants of the assembler require
516different syntax.
517
518In the simplest case, a @samp{%} followed by a digit @var{n} says to output
519operand @var{n} at that point in the string.
520
521@samp{%} followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
522alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings described
523below. The machine description macro @code{PRINT_OPERAND} can define
524additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
525
526@samp{%c@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand that is a
527constant value without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate
528operand.
529
530@samp{%n@var{digit}} is like @samp{%c@var{digit}} except that the value of
531the constant is negated before printing.
532
533@samp{%a@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a
534memory reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may
535be useful when outputting a ``load address'' instruction, because often the
536assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
537as if it were a memory reference.
538
539@samp{%l@var{digit}} is used to substitute a @code{label_ref} into a jump
540instruction.
541
542@samp{%=} outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the
543entire compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be
544referred to more than once in a single template that generates multiple
545assembler instructions.
546
547@samp{%} followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
548does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: @samp{%%} outputs a
549@samp{%} into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be
550defined in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. You must also define
551which punctuation characters are valid with the
552@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} macro.
553
554@cindex \
555@cindex backslash
556The template may generate multiple assembler instructions. Write the text
557for the instructions, with @samp{\;} between them.
558
559@cindex matching operands
560When the RTL contains two operands which are required by constraint to match
561each other, the output template must refer only to the lower-numbered operand.
562Matching operands are not always identical, and the rest of the compiler
563arranges to put the proper RTL expression for printing into the lower-numbered
564operand.
565
566One use of nonstandard letters or punctuation following @samp{%} is to
567distinguish between different assembler languages for the same machine; for
568example, Motorola syntax versus MIT syntax for the 68000. Motorola syntax
569requires periods in most opcode names, while MIT syntax does not. For
570example, the opcode @samp{movel} in MIT syntax is @samp{move.l} in Motorola
571syntax. The same file of patterns is used for both kinds of output syntax,
572but the character sequence @samp{%.} is used in each place where Motorola
573syntax wants a period. The @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro for Motorola syntax
574defines the sequence to output a period; the macro for MIT syntax defines
575it to do nothing.
576
577@cindex @code{#} in template
578As a special case, a template consisting of the single character @code{#}
579instructs the compiler to first split the insn, and then output the
580resulting instructions separately. This helps eliminate redundancy in the
581output templates. If you have a @code{define_insn} that needs to emit
e4ae5e77 582multiple assembler instructions, and there is a matching @code{define_split}
03dda8e3
RK
583already defined, then you can simply use @code{#} as the output template
584instead of writing an output template that emits the multiple assembler
585instructions.
586
49e478af
RS
587Note that @code{#} only has an effect while generating assembly code;
588it does not affect whether a split occurs earlier. An associated
589@code{define_split} must exist and it must be suitable for use after
590register allocation.
591
03dda8e3
RK
592If the macro @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is defined, you can use construct
593of the form @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@}} in the templates. These
594describe multiple variants of assembler language syntax.
595@xref{Instruction Output}.
596
597@node Output Statement
598@section C Statements for Assembler Output
599@cindex output statements
600@cindex C statements for assembler output
601@cindex generating assembler output
602
603Often a single fixed template string cannot produce correct and efficient
604assembler code for all the cases that are recognized by a single
605instruction pattern. For example, the opcodes may depend on the kinds of
606operands; or some unfortunate combinations of operands may require extra
607machine instructions.
608
609If the output control string starts with a @samp{@@}, then it is actually
610a series of templates, each on a separate line. (Blank lines and
611leading spaces and tabs are ignored.) The templates correspond to the
612pattern's constraint alternatives (@pxref{Multi-Alternative}). For example,
613if a target machine has a two-address add instruction @samp{addr} to add
614into a register and another @samp{addm} to add a register to memory, you
615might write this pattern:
616
617@smallexample
618(define_insn "addsi3"
619 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
620 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0,0")
621 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g,r")))]
622 ""
623 "@@
624 addr %2,%0
625 addm %2,%0")
626@end smallexample
627
628@cindex @code{*} in template
629@cindex asterisk in template
630If the output control string starts with a @samp{*}, then it is not an
631output template but rather a piece of C program that should compute a
632template. It should execute a @code{return} statement to return the
633template-string you want. Most such templates use C string literals, which
634require doublequote characters to delimit them. To include these
635doublequote characters in the string, prefix each one with @samp{\}.
636
0f40f9f7
ZW
637If the output control string is written as a brace block instead of a
638double-quoted string, it is automatically assumed to be C code. In that
639case, it is not necessary to put in a leading asterisk, or to escape the
640doublequotes surrounding C string literals.
641
03dda8e3
RK
642The operands may be found in the array @code{operands}, whose C data type
643is @code{rtx []}.
644
645It is very common to select different ways of generating assembler code
646based on whether an immediate operand is within a certain range. Be
647careful when doing this, because the result of @code{INTVAL} is an
648integer on the host machine. If the host machine has more bits in an
649@code{int} than the target machine has in the mode in which the constant
650will be used, then some of the bits you get from @code{INTVAL} will be
651superfluous. For proper results, you must carefully disregard the
652values of those bits.
653
654@findex output_asm_insn
655It is possible to output an assembler instruction and then go on to output
656or compute more of them, using the subroutine @code{output_asm_insn}. This
657receives two arguments: a template-string and a vector of operands. The
658vector may be @code{operands}, or it may be another array of @code{rtx}
659that you declare locally and initialize yourself.
660
661@findex which_alternative
662When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
663the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which alternative
664was matched. When this is so, the C code can test the variable
665@code{which_alternative}, which is the ordinal number of the alternative
666that was actually satisfied (0 for the first, 1 for the second alternative,
667etc.).
668
669For example, suppose there are two opcodes for storing zero, @samp{clrreg}
670for registers and @samp{clrmem} for memory locations. Here is how
671a pattern could use @code{which_alternative} to choose between them:
672
673@smallexample
674(define_insn ""
675 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
676 (const_int 0))]
677 ""
0f40f9f7 678 @{
03dda8e3 679 return (which_alternative == 0
0f40f9f7
ZW
680 ? "clrreg %0" : "clrmem %0");
681 @})
03dda8e3
RK
682@end smallexample
683
684The example above, where the assembler code to generate was
685@emph{solely} determined by the alternative, could also have been specified
686as follows, having the output control string start with a @samp{@@}:
687
688@smallexample
689@group
690(define_insn ""
691 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
692 (const_int 0))]
693 ""
694 "@@
695 clrreg %0
696 clrmem %0")
697@end group
698@end smallexample
e543e219 699
94c765ab
R
700If you just need a little bit of C code in one (or a few) alternatives,
701you can use @samp{*} inside of a @samp{@@} multi-alternative template:
702
703@smallexample
704@group
705(define_insn ""
706 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,<,m")
707 (const_int 0))]
708 ""
709 "@@
710 clrreg %0
711 * return stack_mem_p (operands[0]) ? \"push 0\" : \"clrmem %0\";
712 clrmem %0")
713@end group
714@end smallexample
715
e543e219
ZW
716@node Predicates
717@section Predicates
718@cindex predicates
719@cindex operand predicates
720@cindex operator predicates
721
722A predicate determines whether a @code{match_operand} or
723@code{match_operator} expression matches, and therefore whether the
724surrounding instruction pattern will be used for that combination of
725operands. GCC has a number of machine-independent predicates, and you
726can define machine-specific predicates as needed. By convention,
727predicates used with @code{match_operand} have names that end in
728@samp{_operand}, and those used with @code{match_operator} have names
729that end in @samp{_operator}.
730
527a3750 731All predicates are boolean functions (in the mathematical sense) of
e543e219
ZW
732two arguments: the RTL expression that is being considered at that
733position in the instruction pattern, and the machine mode that the
734@code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} specifies. In this
735section, the first argument is called @var{op} and the second argument
736@var{mode}. Predicates can be called from C as ordinary two-argument
737functions; this can be useful in output templates or other
738machine-specific code.
739
740Operand predicates can allow operands that are not actually acceptable
741to the hardware, as long as the constraints give reload the ability to
742fix them up (@pxref{Constraints}). However, GCC will usually generate
743better code if the predicates specify the requirements of the machine
744instructions as closely as possible. Reload cannot fix up operands
745that must be constants (``immediate operands''); you must use a
746predicate that allows only constants, or else enforce the requirement
747in the extra condition.
748
749@cindex predicates and machine modes
750@cindex normal predicates
751@cindex special predicates
752Most predicates handle their @var{mode} argument in a uniform manner.
753If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode} (unspecified), then @var{op} can have
754any mode. If @var{mode} is anything else, then @var{op} must have the
755same mode, unless @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or integer
756@code{CONST_DOUBLE}. These RTL expressions always have
757@code{VOIDmode}, so it would be counterproductive to check that their
758mode matches. Instead, predicates that accept @code{CONST_INT} and/or
759integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE} check that the value stored in the
760constant will fit in the requested mode.
761
762Predicates with this behavior are called @dfn{normal}.
763@command{genrecog} can optimize the instruction recognizer based on
764knowledge of how normal predicates treat modes. It can also diagnose
765certain kinds of common errors in the use of normal predicates; for
766instance, it is almost always an error to use a normal predicate
767without specifying a mode.
768
769Predicates that do something different with their @var{mode} argument
770are called @dfn{special}. The generic predicates
771@code{address_operand} and @code{pmode_register_operand} are special
772predicates. @command{genrecog} does not do any optimizations or
773diagnosis when special predicates are used.
774
775@menu
776* Machine-Independent Predicates:: Predicates available to all back ends.
777* Defining Predicates:: How to write machine-specific predicate
778 functions.
779@end menu
780
781@node Machine-Independent Predicates
782@subsection Machine-Independent Predicates
783@cindex machine-independent predicates
784@cindex generic predicates
785
786These are the generic predicates available to all back ends. They are
787defined in @file{recog.c}. The first category of predicates allow
788only constant, or @dfn{immediate}, operands.
789
790@defun immediate_operand
791This predicate allows any sort of constant that fits in @var{mode}.
792It is an appropriate choice for instructions that take operands that
793must be constant.
794@end defun
795
796@defun const_int_operand
797This predicate allows any @code{CONST_INT} expression that fits in
798@var{mode}. It is an appropriate choice for an immediate operand that
799does not allow a symbol or label.
800@end defun
801
802@defun const_double_operand
803This predicate accepts any @code{CONST_DOUBLE} expression that has
804exactly @var{mode}. If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, it will also
805accept @code{CONST_INT}. It is intended for immediate floating point
806constants.
807@end defun
808
809@noindent
810The second category of predicates allow only some kind of machine
811register.
812
813@defun register_operand
814This predicate allows any @code{REG} or @code{SUBREG} expression that
815is valid for @var{mode}. It is often suitable for arithmetic
816instruction operands on a RISC machine.
817@end defun
818
819@defun pmode_register_operand
820This is a slight variant on @code{register_operand} which works around
821a limitation in the machine-description reader.
822
cd1a8088 823@smallexample
e543e219 824(match_operand @var{n} "pmode_register_operand" @var{constraint})
cd1a8088 825@end smallexample
e543e219
ZW
826
827@noindent
828means exactly what
829
cd1a8088 830@smallexample
e543e219 831(match_operand:P @var{n} "register_operand" @var{constraint})
cd1a8088 832@end smallexample
e543e219
ZW
833
834@noindent
835would mean, if the machine-description reader accepted @samp{:P}
836mode suffixes. Unfortunately, it cannot, because @code{Pmode} is an
837alias for some other mode, and might vary with machine-specific
8a36672b 838options. @xref{Misc}.
e543e219
ZW
839@end defun
840
841@defun scratch_operand
842This predicate allows hard registers and @code{SCRATCH} expressions,
843but not pseudo-registers. It is used internally by @code{match_scratch};
844it should not be used directly.
845@end defun
846
847@noindent
848The third category of predicates allow only some kind of memory reference.
849
850@defun memory_operand
851This predicate allows any valid reference to a quantity of mode
852@var{mode} in memory, as determined by the weak form of
853@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} (@pxref{Addressing Modes}).
854@end defun
855
856@defun address_operand
857This predicate is a little unusual; it allows any operand that is a
858valid expression for the @emph{address} of a quantity of mode
859@var{mode}, again determined by the weak form of
860@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}. To first order, if
861@samp{@w{(mem:@var{mode} (@var{exp}))}} is acceptable to
862@code{memory_operand}, then @var{exp} is acceptable to
863@code{address_operand}. Note that @var{exp} does not necessarily have
864the mode @var{mode}.
865@end defun
866
867@defun indirect_operand
868This is a stricter form of @code{memory_operand} which allows only
869memory references with a @code{general_operand} as the address
870expression. New uses of this predicate are discouraged, because
871@code{general_operand} is very permissive, so it's hard to tell what
872an @code{indirect_operand} does or does not allow. If a target has
873different requirements for memory operands for different instructions,
874it is better to define target-specific predicates which enforce the
875hardware's requirements explicitly.
876@end defun
877
878@defun push_operand
879This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for pushing a value
880onto the stack. This will be a @code{MEM} which refers to
df18c24a 881@code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side effect in its address expression
e543e219
ZW
882(@pxref{Incdec}); which one is determined by the
883@code{STACK_PUSH_CODE} macro (@pxref{Frame Layout}).
884@end defun
885
886@defun pop_operand
887This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for popping a value
888off the stack. Again, this will be a @code{MEM} referring to
df18c24a 889@code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side effect in its address
e543e219
ZW
890expression. However, this time @code{STACK_POP_CODE} is expected.
891@end defun
892
893@noindent
894The fourth category of predicates allow some combination of the above
895operands.
896
897@defun nonmemory_operand
898This predicate allows any immediate or register operand valid for @var{mode}.
899@end defun
900
901@defun nonimmediate_operand
902This predicate allows any register or memory operand valid for @var{mode}.
903@end defun
904
905@defun general_operand
906This predicate allows any immediate, register, or memory operand
907valid for @var{mode}.
908@end defun
909
910@noindent
c6963675 911Finally, there are two generic operator predicates.
e543e219
ZW
912
913@defun comparison_operator
914This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
915comparison in @var{mode}; that is, @code{COMPARISON_P} is true for the
916expression code.
917@end defun
918
c6963675
PB
919@defun ordered_comparison_operator
920This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
921comparison in @var{mode} and whose expression code is valid for integer
922modes; that is, the expression code will be one of @code{eq}, @code{ne},
923@code{lt}, @code{ltu}, @code{le}, @code{leu}, @code{gt}, @code{gtu},
924@code{ge}, @code{geu}.
925@end defun
926
e543e219
ZW
927@node Defining Predicates
928@subsection Defining Machine-Specific Predicates
929@cindex defining predicates
930@findex define_predicate
931@findex define_special_predicate
932
933Many machines have requirements for their operands that cannot be
934expressed precisely using the generic predicates. You can define
935additional predicates using @code{define_predicate} and
936@code{define_special_predicate} expressions. These expressions have
937three operands:
938
939@itemize @bullet
940@item
941The name of the predicate, as it will be referred to in
942@code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} expressions.
943
944@item
945An RTL expression which evaluates to true if the predicate allows the
946operand @var{op}, false if it does not. This expression can only use
947the following RTL codes:
948
949@table @code
950@item MATCH_OPERAND
951When written inside a predicate expression, a @code{MATCH_OPERAND}
952expression evaluates to true if the predicate it names would allow
953@var{op}. The operand number and constraint are ignored. Due to
954limitations in @command{genrecog}, you can only refer to generic
955predicates and predicates that have already been defined.
956
957@item MATCH_CODE
6e7a4706
ZW
958This expression evaluates to true if @var{op} or a specified
959subexpression of @var{op} has one of a given list of RTX codes.
960
961The first operand of this expression is a string constant containing a
962comma-separated list of RTX code names (in lower case). These are the
963codes for which the @code{MATCH_CODE} will be true.
964
965The second operand is a string constant which indicates what
966subexpression of @var{op} to examine. If it is absent or the empty
967string, @var{op} itself is examined. Otherwise, the string constant
968must be a sequence of digits and/or lowercase letters. Each character
969indicates a subexpression to extract from the current expression; for
970the first character this is @var{op}, for the second and subsequent
971characters it is the result of the previous character. A digit
972@var{n} extracts @samp{@w{XEXP (@var{e}, @var{n})}}; a letter @var{l}
973extracts @samp{@w{XVECEXP (@var{e}, 0, @var{n})}} where @var{n} is the
974alphabetic ordinal of @var{l} (0 for `a', 1 for 'b', and so on). The
975@code{MATCH_CODE} then examines the RTX code of the subexpression
976extracted by the complete string. It is not possible to extract
977components of an @code{rtvec} that is not at position 0 within its RTX
978object.
e543e219
ZW
979
980@item MATCH_TEST
981This expression has one operand, a string constant containing a C
982expression. The predicate's arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
983available with those names in the C expression. The @code{MATCH_TEST}
984evaluates to true if the C expression evaluates to a nonzero value.
985@code{MATCH_TEST} expressions must not have side effects.
986
987@item AND
988@itemx IOR
989@itemx NOT
990@itemx IF_THEN_ELSE
991The basic @samp{MATCH_} expressions can be combined using these
992logical operators, which have the semantics of the C operators
6e7a4706
ZW
993@samp{&&}, @samp{||}, @samp{!}, and @samp{@w{? :}} respectively. As
994in Common Lisp, you may give an @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expression an
995arbitrary number of arguments; this has exactly the same effect as
996writing a chain of two-argument @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expressions.
e543e219
ZW
997@end table
998
999@item
f0eb93a8 1000An optional block of C code, which should execute
e543e219
ZW
1001@samp{@w{return true}} if the predicate is found to match and
1002@samp{@w{return false}} if it does not. It must not have any side
1003effects. The predicate arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
1004available with those names.
1005
1006If a code block is present in a predicate definition, then the RTL
1007expression must evaluate to true @emph{and} the code block must
1008execute @samp{@w{return true}} for the predicate to allow the operand.
1009The RTL expression is evaluated first; do not re-check anything in the
1010code block that was checked in the RTL expression.
1011@end itemize
1012
1013The program @command{genrecog} scans @code{define_predicate} and
1014@code{define_special_predicate} expressions to determine which RTX
1015codes are possibly allowed. You should always make this explicit in
1016the RTL predicate expression, using @code{MATCH_OPERAND} and
1017@code{MATCH_CODE}.
1018
1019Here is an example of a simple predicate definition, from the IA64
1020machine description:
1021
1022@smallexample
1023@group
1024;; @r{True if @var{op} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} which refers to the sdata section.}
1025(define_predicate "small_addr_symbolic_operand"
1026 (and (match_code "symbol_ref")
1027 (match_test "SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_ADDR_P (op)")))
1028@end group
1029@end smallexample
1030
1031@noindent
1032And here is another, showing the use of the C block.
1033
1034@smallexample
1035@group
1036;; @r{True if @var{op} is a register operand that is (or could be) a GR reg.}
1037(define_predicate "gr_register_operand"
1038 (match_operand 0 "register_operand")
1039@{
1040 unsigned int regno;
1041 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
1042 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
1043
1044 regno = REGNO (op);
1045 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || GENERAL_REGNO_P (regno));
1046@})
1047@end group
1048@end smallexample
1049
1050Predicates written with @code{define_predicate} automatically include
1051a test that @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, or @var{op} has the same
1052mode as @var{mode}, or @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or
1053@code{CONST_DOUBLE}. They do @emph{not} check specifically for
1054integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE}, nor do they test that the value of either
1055kind of constant fits in the requested mode. This is because
1056target-specific predicates that take constants usually have to do more
1057stringent value checks anyway. If you need the exact same treatment
1058of @code{CONST_INT} or @code{CONST_DOUBLE} that the generic predicates
1059provide, use a @code{MATCH_OPERAND} subexpression to call
1060@code{const_int_operand}, @code{const_double_operand}, or
1061@code{immediate_operand}.
1062
1063Predicates written with @code{define_special_predicate} do not get any
1064automatic mode checks, and are treated as having special mode handling
1065by @command{genrecog}.
1066
1067The program @command{genpreds} is responsible for generating code to
1068test predicates. It also writes a header file containing function
1069declarations for all machine-specific predicates. It is not necessary
1070to declare these predicates in @file{@var{cpu}-protos.h}.
03dda8e3
RK
1071@end ifset
1072
1073@c Most of this node appears by itself (in a different place) even
b11cc610
JM
1074@c when the INTERNALS flag is clear. Passages that require the internals
1075@c manual's context are conditionalized to appear only in the internals manual.
03dda8e3
RK
1076@ifset INTERNALS
1077@node Constraints
1078@section Operand Constraints
1079@cindex operand constraints
1080@cindex constraints
1081
e543e219
ZW
1082Each @code{match_operand} in an instruction pattern can specify
1083constraints for the operands allowed. The constraints allow you to
1084fine-tune matching within the set of operands allowed by the
1085predicate.
1086
03dda8e3
RK
1087@end ifset
1088@ifclear INTERNALS
1089@node Constraints
1090@section Constraints for @code{asm} Operands
1091@cindex operand constraints, @code{asm}
1092@cindex constraints, @code{asm}
1093@cindex @code{asm} constraints
1094
1095Here are specific details on what constraint letters you can use with
1096@code{asm} operands.
1097@end ifclear
1098Constraints can say whether
1099an operand may be in a register, and which kinds of register; whether the
1100operand can be a memory reference, and which kinds of address; whether the
1101operand may be an immediate constant, and which possible values it may
1102have. Constraints can also require two operands to match.
54f044eb
JJ
1103Side-effects aren't allowed in operands of inline @code{asm}, unless
1104@samp{<} or @samp{>} constraints are used, because there is no guarantee
df18c24a 1105that the side effects will happen exactly once in an instruction that can update
54f044eb 1106the addressing register.
03dda8e3
RK
1107
1108@ifset INTERNALS
1109@menu
1110* Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1111* Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1112* Class Preferences:: Constraints guide which hard register to put things in.
1113* Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1114* Machine Constraints:: Existing constraints for some particular machines.
9840b2fa 1115* Disable Insn Alternatives:: Disable insn alternatives using attributes.
f38840db
ZW
1116* Define Constraints:: How to define machine-specific constraints.
1117* C Constraint Interface:: How to test constraints from C code.
03dda8e3
RK
1118@end menu
1119@end ifset
1120
1121@ifclear INTERNALS
1122@menu
1123* Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1124* Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1125* Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1126* Machine Constraints:: Special constraints for some particular machines.
1127@end menu
1128@end ifclear
1129
1130@node Simple Constraints
1131@subsection Simple Constraints
1132@cindex simple constraints
1133
1134The simplest kind of constraint is a string full of letters, each of
1135which describes one kind of operand that is permitted. Here are
1136the letters that are allowed:
1137
1138@table @asis
88a56c2e
HPN
1139@item whitespace
1140Whitespace characters are ignored and can be inserted at any position
1141except the first. This enables each alternative for different operands to
1142be visually aligned in the machine description even if they have different
1143number of constraints and modifiers.
1144
03dda8e3
RK
1145@cindex @samp{m} in constraint
1146@cindex memory references in constraints
1147@item @samp{m}
1148A memory operand is allowed, with any kind of address that the machine
1149supports in general.
a4edaf83
AK
1150Note that the letter used for the general memory constraint can be
1151re-defined by a back end using the @code{TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT} macro.
03dda8e3
RK
1152
1153@cindex offsettable address
1154@cindex @samp{o} in constraint
1155@item @samp{o}
1156A memory operand is allowed, but only if the address is
1157@dfn{offsettable}. This means that adding a small integer (actually,
1158the width in bytes of the operand, as determined by its machine mode)
1159may be added to the address and the result is also a valid memory
1160address.
1161
1162@cindex autoincrement/decrement addressing
1163For example, an address which is constant is offsettable; so is an
1164address that is the sum of a register and a constant (as long as a
1165slightly larger constant is also within the range of address-offsets
1166supported by the machine); but an autoincrement or autodecrement
1167address is not offsettable. More complicated indirect/indexed
1168addresses may or may not be offsettable depending on the other
1169addressing modes that the machine supports.
1170
1171Note that in an output operand which can be matched by another
1172operand, the constraint letter @samp{o} is valid only when accompanied
1173by both @samp{<} (if the target machine has predecrement addressing)
1174and @samp{>} (if the target machine has preincrement addressing).
1175
1176@cindex @samp{V} in constraint
1177@item @samp{V}
1178A memory operand that is not offsettable. In other words, anything that
1179would fit the @samp{m} constraint but not the @samp{o} constraint.
1180
1181@cindex @samp{<} in constraint
1182@item @samp{<}
1183A memory operand with autodecrement addressing (either predecrement or
54f044eb
JJ
1184postdecrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} this constraint is only
1185allowed if the operand is used exactly once in an instruction that can
df18c24a 1186handle the side effects. Not using an operand with @samp{<} in constraint
54f044eb 1187string in the inline @code{asm} pattern at all or using it in multiple
df18c24a 1188instructions isn't valid, because the side effects wouldn't be performed
54f044eb
JJ
1189or would be performed more than once. Furthermore, on some targets
1190the operand with @samp{<} in constraint string must be accompanied by
1191special instruction suffixes like @code{%U0} instruction suffix on PowerPC
1192or @code{%P0} on IA-64.
03dda8e3
RK
1193
1194@cindex @samp{>} in constraint
1195@item @samp{>}
1196A memory operand with autoincrement addressing (either preincrement or
54f044eb
JJ
1197postincrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} the same restrictions
1198as for @samp{<} apply.
03dda8e3
RK
1199
1200@cindex @samp{r} in constraint
1201@cindex registers in constraints
1202@item @samp{r}
1203A register operand is allowed provided that it is in a general
1204register.
1205
03dda8e3
RK
1206@cindex constants in constraints
1207@cindex @samp{i} in constraint
1208@item @samp{i}
1209An immediate integer operand (one with constant value) is allowed.
1210This includes symbolic constants whose values will be known only at
8ac658b6 1211assembly time or later.
03dda8e3
RK
1212
1213@cindex @samp{n} in constraint
1214@item @samp{n}
1215An immediate integer operand with a known numeric value is allowed.
1216Many systems cannot support assembly-time constants for operands less
1217than a word wide. Constraints for these operands should use @samp{n}
1218rather than @samp{i}.
1219
1220@cindex @samp{I} in constraint
1221@item @samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}
1222Other letters in the range @samp{I} through @samp{P} may be defined in
1223a machine-dependent fashion to permit immediate integer operands with
1224explicit integer values in specified ranges. For example, on the
122568000, @samp{I} is defined to stand for the range of values 1 to 8.
1226This is the range permitted as a shift count in the shift
1227instructions.
1228
1229@cindex @samp{E} in constraint
1230@item @samp{E}
1231An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double}) is
1232allowed, but only if the target floating point format is the same as
1233that of the host machine (on which the compiler is running).
1234
1235@cindex @samp{F} in constraint
1236@item @samp{F}
bf7cd754
R
1237An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double} or
1238@code{const_vector}) is allowed.
03dda8e3
RK
1239
1240@cindex @samp{G} in constraint
1241@cindex @samp{H} in constraint
1242@item @samp{G}, @samp{H}
1243@samp{G} and @samp{H} may be defined in a machine-dependent fashion to
1244permit immediate floating operands in particular ranges of values.
1245
1246@cindex @samp{s} in constraint
1247@item @samp{s}
1248An immediate integer operand whose value is not an explicit integer is
1249allowed.
1250
1251This might appear strange; if an insn allows a constant operand with a
1252value not known at compile time, it certainly must allow any known
1253value. So why use @samp{s} instead of @samp{i}? Sometimes it allows
1254better code to be generated.
1255
1256For example, on the 68000 in a fullword instruction it is possible to
630d3d5a 1257use an immediate operand; but if the immediate value is between @minus{}128
03dda8e3
RK
1258and 127, better code results from loading the value into a register and
1259using the register. This is because the load into the register can be
1260done with a @samp{moveq} instruction. We arrange for this to happen
1261by defining the letter @samp{K} to mean ``any integer outside the
630d3d5a 1262range @minus{}128 to 127'', and then specifying @samp{Ks} in the operand
03dda8e3
RK
1263constraints.
1264
1265@cindex @samp{g} in constraint
1266@item @samp{g}
1267Any register, memory or immediate integer operand is allowed, except for
1268registers that are not general registers.
1269
1270@cindex @samp{X} in constraint
1271@item @samp{X}
1272@ifset INTERNALS
1273Any operand whatsoever is allowed, even if it does not satisfy
1274@code{general_operand}. This is normally used in the constraint of
1275a @code{match_scratch} when certain alternatives will not actually
1276require a scratch register.
1277@end ifset
1278@ifclear INTERNALS
1279Any operand whatsoever is allowed.
1280@end ifclear
1281
1282@cindex @samp{0} in constraint
1283@cindex digits in constraint
1284@item @samp{0}, @samp{1}, @samp{2}, @dots{} @samp{9}
1285An operand that matches the specified operand number is allowed. If a
1286digit is used together with letters within the same alternative, the
1287digit should come last.
1288
84b72302 1289This number is allowed to be more than a single digit. If multiple
c0478a66 1290digits are encountered consecutively, they are interpreted as a single
84b72302
RH
1291decimal integer. There is scant chance for ambiguity, since to-date
1292it has never been desirable that @samp{10} be interpreted as matching
1293either operand 1 @emph{or} operand 0. Should this be desired, one
1294can use multiple alternatives instead.
1295
03dda8e3
RK
1296@cindex matching constraint
1297@cindex constraint, matching
1298This is called a @dfn{matching constraint} and what it really means is
1299that the assembler has only a single operand that fills two roles
1300@ifset INTERNALS
1301considered separate in the RTL insn. For example, an add insn has two
1302input operands and one output operand in the RTL, but on most CISC
1303@end ifset
1304@ifclear INTERNALS
1305which @code{asm} distinguishes. For example, an add instruction uses
1306two input operands and an output operand, but on most CISC
1307@end ifclear
1308machines an add instruction really has only two operands, one of them an
1309input-output operand:
1310
1311@smallexample
1312addl #35,r12
1313@end smallexample
1314
1315Matching constraints are used in these circumstances.
1316More precisely, the two operands that match must include one input-only
1317operand and one output-only operand. Moreover, the digit must be a
1318smaller number than the number of the operand that uses it in the
1319constraint.
1320
1321@ifset INTERNALS
1322For operands to match in a particular case usually means that they
1323are identical-looking RTL expressions. But in a few special cases
1324specific kinds of dissimilarity are allowed. For example, @code{*x}
1325as an input operand will match @code{*x++} as an output operand.
1326For proper results in such cases, the output template should always
1327use the output-operand's number when printing the operand.
1328@end ifset
1329
1330@cindex load address instruction
1331@cindex push address instruction
1332@cindex address constraints
1333@cindex @samp{p} in constraint
1334@item @samp{p}
1335An operand that is a valid memory address is allowed. This is
1336for ``load address'' and ``push address'' instructions.
1337
1338@findex address_operand
1339@samp{p} in the constraint must be accompanied by @code{address_operand}
1340as the predicate in the @code{match_operand}. This predicate interprets
1341the mode specified in the @code{match_operand} as the mode of the memory
1342reference for which the address would be valid.
1343
c2cba7a9 1344@cindex other register constraints
03dda8e3 1345@cindex extensible constraints
630d3d5a 1346@item @var{other-letters}
c2cba7a9
RH
1347Other letters can be defined in machine-dependent fashion to stand for
1348particular classes of registers or other arbitrary operand types.
1349@samp{d}, @samp{a} and @samp{f} are defined on the 68000/68020 to stand
1350for data, address and floating point registers.
03dda8e3
RK
1351@end table
1352
1353@ifset INTERNALS
1354In order to have valid assembler code, each operand must satisfy
1355its constraint. But a failure to do so does not prevent the pattern
1356from applying to an insn. Instead, it directs the compiler to modify
1357the code so that the constraint will be satisfied. Usually this is
1358done by copying an operand into a register.
1359
1360Contrast, therefore, the two instruction patterns that follow:
1361
1362@smallexample
1363(define_insn ""
1364 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1365 (plus:SI (match_dup 0)
1366 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r")))]
1367 ""
1368 "@dots{}")
1369@end smallexample
1370
1371@noindent
1372which has two operands, one of which must appear in two places, and
1373
1374@smallexample
1375(define_insn ""
1376 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1377 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
1378 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "r")))]
1379 ""
1380 "@dots{}")
1381@end smallexample
1382
1383@noindent
1384which has three operands, two of which are required by a constraint to be
1385identical. If we are considering an insn of the form
1386
1387@smallexample
1388(insn @var{n} @var{prev} @var{next}
1389 (set (reg:SI 3)
1390 (plus:SI (reg:SI 6) (reg:SI 109)))
1391 @dots{})
1392@end smallexample
1393
1394@noindent
1395the first pattern would not apply at all, because this insn does not
1396contain two identical subexpressions in the right place. The pattern would
d78aa55c 1397say, ``That does not look like an add instruction; try other patterns''.
03dda8e3 1398The second pattern would say, ``Yes, that's an add instruction, but there
d78aa55c 1399is something wrong with it''. It would direct the reload pass of the
03dda8e3
RK
1400compiler to generate additional insns to make the constraint true. The
1401results might look like this:
1402
1403@smallexample
1404(insn @var{n2} @var{prev} @var{n}
1405 (set (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 6))
1406 @dots{})
1407
1408(insn @var{n} @var{n2} @var{next}
1409 (set (reg:SI 3)
1410 (plus:SI (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 109)))
1411 @dots{})
1412@end smallexample
1413
1414It is up to you to make sure that each operand, in each pattern, has
1415constraints that can handle any RTL expression that could be present for
1416that operand. (When multiple alternatives are in use, each pattern must,
1417for each possible combination of operand expressions, have at least one
1418alternative which can handle that combination of operands.) The
1419constraints don't need to @emph{allow} any possible operand---when this is
1420the case, they do not constrain---but they must at least point the way to
1421reloading any possible operand so that it will fit.
1422
1423@itemize @bullet
1424@item
1425If the constraint accepts whatever operands the predicate permits,
1426there is no problem: reloading is never necessary for this operand.
1427
1428For example, an operand whose constraints permit everything except
1429registers is safe provided its predicate rejects registers.
1430
1431An operand whose predicate accepts only constant values is safe
1432provided its constraints include the letter @samp{i}. If any possible
1433constant value is accepted, then nothing less than @samp{i} will do;
1434if the predicate is more selective, then the constraints may also be
1435more selective.
1436
1437@item
1438Any operand expression can be reloaded by copying it into a register.
1439So if an operand's constraints allow some kind of register, it is
1440certain to be safe. It need not permit all classes of registers; the
1441compiler knows how to copy a register into another register of the
1442proper class in order to make an instruction valid.
1443
1444@cindex nonoffsettable memory reference
1445@cindex memory reference, nonoffsettable
1446@item
1447A nonoffsettable memory reference can be reloaded by copying the
1448address into a register. So if the constraint uses the letter
1449@samp{o}, all memory references are taken care of.
1450
1451@item
1452A constant operand can be reloaded by allocating space in memory to
1453hold it as preinitialized data. Then the memory reference can be used
1454in place of the constant. So if the constraint uses the letters
1455@samp{o} or @samp{m}, constant operands are not a problem.
1456
1457@item
1458If the constraint permits a constant and a pseudo register used in an insn
1459was not allocated to a hard register and is equivalent to a constant,
1460the register will be replaced with the constant. If the predicate does
1461not permit a constant and the insn is re-recognized for some reason, the
1462compiler will crash. Thus the predicate must always recognize any
1463objects allowed by the constraint.
1464@end itemize
1465
1466If the operand's predicate can recognize registers, but the constraint does
1467not permit them, it can make the compiler crash. When this operand happens
1468to be a register, the reload pass will be stymied, because it does not know
1469how to copy a register temporarily into memory.
1470
1471If the predicate accepts a unary operator, the constraint applies to the
1472operand. For example, the MIPS processor at ISA level 3 supports an
1473instruction which adds two registers in @code{SImode} to produce a
1474@code{DImode} result, but only if the registers are correctly sign
1475extended. This predicate for the input operands accepts a
1476@code{sign_extend} of an @code{SImode} register. Write the constraint
1477to indicate the type of register that is required for the operand of the
1478@code{sign_extend}.
1479@end ifset
1480
1481@node Multi-Alternative
1482@subsection Multiple Alternative Constraints
1483@cindex multiple alternative constraints
1484
1485Sometimes a single instruction has multiple alternative sets of possible
1486operands. For example, on the 68000, a logical-or instruction can combine
1487register or an immediate value into memory, or it can combine any kind of
1488operand into a register; but it cannot combine one memory location into
1489another.
1490
1491These constraints are represented as multiple alternatives. An alternative
1492can be described by a series of letters for each operand. The overall
1493constraint for an operand is made from the letters for this operand
1494from the first alternative, a comma, the letters for this operand from
1495the second alternative, a comma, and so on until the last alternative.
a6fa947e
DW
1496All operands for a single instruction must have the same number of
1497alternatives.
03dda8e3
RK
1498@ifset INTERNALS
1499Here is how it is done for fullword logical-or on the 68000:
1500
1501@smallexample
1502(define_insn "iorsi3"
1503 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=m,d")
1504 (ior:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1505 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dKs,dmKs")))]
1506 @dots{})
1507@end smallexample
1508
1509The first alternative has @samp{m} (memory) for operand 0, @samp{0} for
1510operand 1 (meaning it must match operand 0), and @samp{dKs} for operand
15112. The second alternative has @samp{d} (data register) for operand 0,
1512@samp{0} for operand 1, and @samp{dmKs} for operand 2. The @samp{=} and
1513@samp{%} in the constraints apply to all the alternatives; their
1514meaning is explained in the next section (@pxref{Class Preferences}).
03dda8e3 1515
03dda8e3
RK
1516If all the operands fit any one alternative, the instruction is valid.
1517Otherwise, for each alternative, the compiler counts how many instructions
1518must be added to copy the operands so that that alternative applies.
1519The alternative requiring the least copying is chosen. If two alternatives
1520need the same amount of copying, the one that comes first is chosen.
1521These choices can be altered with the @samp{?} and @samp{!} characters:
1522
1523@table @code
1524@cindex @samp{?} in constraint
1525@cindex question mark
1526@item ?
1527Disparage slightly the alternative that the @samp{?} appears in,
1528as a choice when no alternative applies exactly. The compiler regards
1529this alternative as one unit more costly for each @samp{?} that appears
1530in it.
1531
1532@cindex @samp{!} in constraint
1533@cindex exclamation point
1534@item !
1535Disparage severely the alternative that the @samp{!} appears in.
1536This alternative can still be used if it fits without reloading,
1537but if reloading is needed, some other alternative will be used.
d1457701
VM
1538
1539@cindex @samp{^} in constraint
1540@cindex caret
1541@item ^
1542This constraint is analogous to @samp{?} but it disparages slightly
0ab9eed6 1543the alternative only if the operand with the @samp{^} needs a reload.
d1457701
VM
1544
1545@cindex @samp{$} in constraint
1546@cindex dollar sign
1547@item $
1548This constraint is analogous to @samp{!} but it disparages severely
1549the alternative only if the operand with the @samp{$} needs a reload.
03dda8e3
RK
1550@end table
1551
03dda8e3
RK
1552When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
1553the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which
1554alternative was matched. When this is so, the C code for writing the
1555assembler code can use the variable @code{which_alternative}, which is
1556the ordinal number of the alternative that was actually satisfied (0 for
1557the first, 1 for the second alternative, etc.). @xref{Output Statement}.
1558@end ifset
a6fa947e
DW
1559@ifclear INTERNALS
1560
1561So the first alternative for the 68000's logical-or could be written as
1562@code{"+m" (output) : "ir" (input)}. The second could be @code{"+r"
1563(output): "irm" (input)}. However, the fact that two memory locations
1564cannot be used in a single instruction prevents simply using @code{"+rm"
1565(output) : "irm" (input)}. Using multi-alternatives, this might be
1566written as @code{"+m,r" (output) : "ir,irm" (input)}. This describes
1567all the available alternatives to the compiler, allowing it to choose
1568the most efficient one for the current conditions.
1569
1570There is no way within the template to determine which alternative was
1571chosen. However you may be able to wrap your @code{asm} statements with
1572builtins such as @code{__builtin_constant_p} to achieve the desired results.
1573@end ifclear
03dda8e3
RK
1574
1575@ifset INTERNALS
1576@node Class Preferences
1577@subsection Register Class Preferences
1578@cindex class preference constraints
1579@cindex register class preference constraints
1580
1581@cindex voting between constraint alternatives
1582The operand constraints have another function: they enable the compiler
1583to decide which kind of hardware register a pseudo register is best
1584allocated to. The compiler examines the constraints that apply to the
1585insns that use the pseudo register, looking for the machine-dependent
1586letters such as @samp{d} and @samp{a} that specify classes of registers.
1587The pseudo register is put in whichever class gets the most ``votes''.
1588The constraint letters @samp{g} and @samp{r} also vote: they vote in
1589favor of a general register. The machine description says which registers
1590are considered general.
1591
1592Of course, on some machines all registers are equivalent, and no register
1593classes are defined. Then none of this complexity is relevant.
1594@end ifset
1595
1596@node Modifiers
1597@subsection Constraint Modifier Characters
1598@cindex modifiers in constraints
1599@cindex constraint modifier characters
1600
1601@c prevent bad page break with this line
1602Here are constraint modifier characters.
1603
1604@table @samp
1605@cindex @samp{=} in constraint
1606@item =
5fd4bc96
JG
1607Means that this operand is written to by this instruction:
1608the previous value is discarded and replaced by new data.
03dda8e3
RK
1609
1610@cindex @samp{+} in constraint
1611@item +
1612Means that this operand is both read and written by the instruction.
1613
1614When the compiler fixes up the operands to satisfy the constraints,
5fd4bc96
JG
1615it needs to know which operands are read by the instruction and
1616which are written by it. @samp{=} identifies an operand which is only
1617written; @samp{+} identifies an operand that is both read and written; all
1618other operands are assumed to only be read.
03dda8e3 1619
c5c76735
JL
1620If you specify @samp{=} or @samp{+} in a constraint, you put it in the
1621first character of the constraint string.
1622
03dda8e3
RK
1623@cindex @samp{&} in constraint
1624@cindex earlyclobber operand
1625@item &
1626Means (in a particular alternative) that this operand is an
5fd4bc96 1627@dfn{earlyclobber} operand, which is written before the instruction is
03dda8e3 1628finished using the input operands. Therefore, this operand may not lie
5fd4bc96 1629in a register that is read by the instruction or as part of any memory
03dda8e3
RK
1630address.
1631
1632@samp{&} applies only to the alternative in which it is written. In
1633constraints with multiple alternatives, sometimes one alternative
1634requires @samp{&} while others do not. See, for example, the
1635@samp{movdf} insn of the 68000.
1636
5fd4bc96
JG
1637A operand which is read by the instruction can be tied to an earlyclobber
1638operand if its only use as an input occurs before the early result is
1639written. Adding alternatives of this form often allows GCC to produce
1640better code when only some of the read operands can be affected by the
1641earlyclobber. See, for example, the @samp{mulsi3} insn of the ARM@.
03dda8e3 1642
5fd4bc96
JG
1643Furthermore, if the @dfn{earlyclobber} operand is also a read/write
1644operand, then that operand is written only after it's used.
34386e79 1645
5fd4bc96
JG
1646@samp{&} does not obviate the need to write @samp{=} or @samp{+}. As
1647@dfn{earlyclobber} operands are always written, a read-only
1648@dfn{earlyclobber} operand is ill-formed and will be rejected by the
1649compiler.
03dda8e3
RK
1650
1651@cindex @samp{%} in constraint
1652@item %
1653Declares the instruction to be commutative for this operand and the
1654following operand. This means that the compiler may interchange the
1655two operands if that is the cheapest way to make all operands fit the
73f793e3 1656constraints. @samp{%} applies to all alternatives and must appear as
5fd4bc96 1657the first character in the constraint. Only read-only operands can use
73f793e3
RS
1658@samp{%}.
1659
03dda8e3
RK
1660@ifset INTERNALS
1661This is often used in patterns for addition instructions
1662that really have only two operands: the result must go in one of the
1663arguments. Here for example, is how the 68000 halfword-add
1664instruction is defined:
1665
1666@smallexample
1667(define_insn "addhi3"
1668 [(set (match_operand:HI 0 "general_operand" "=m,r")
1669 (plus:HI (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1670 (match_operand:HI 2 "general_operand" "di,g")))]
1671 @dots{})
1672@end smallexample
1673@end ifset
daf2f129 1674GCC can only handle one commutative pair in an asm; if you use more,
595163db
EB
1675the compiler may fail. Note that you need not use the modifier if
1676the two alternatives are strictly identical; this would only waste
4f237f2e
DW
1677time in the reload pass.
1678@ifset INTERNALS
1679The modifier is not operational after
be3914df
HPN
1680register allocation, so the result of @code{define_peephole2}
1681and @code{define_split}s performed after reload cannot rely on
1682@samp{%} to make the intended insn match.
03dda8e3
RK
1683
1684@cindex @samp{#} in constraint
1685@item #
1686Says that all following characters, up to the next comma, are to be
1687ignored as a constraint. They are significant only for choosing
1688register preferences.
1689
03dda8e3
RK
1690@cindex @samp{*} in constraint
1691@item *
1692Says that the following character should be ignored when choosing
1693register preferences. @samp{*} has no effect on the meaning of the
55a2c322
VM
1694constraint as a constraint, and no effect on reloading. For LRA
1695@samp{*} additionally disparages slightly the alternative if the
1696following character matches the operand.
03dda8e3
RK
1697
1698Here is an example: the 68000 has an instruction to sign-extend a
1699halfword in a data register, and can also sign-extend a value by
1700copying it into an address register. While either kind of register is
1701acceptable, the constraints on an address-register destination are
1702less strict, so it is best if register allocation makes an address
1703register its goal. Therefore, @samp{*} is used so that the @samp{d}
1704constraint letter (for data register) is ignored when computing
1705register preferences.
1706
1707@smallexample
1708(define_insn "extendhisi2"
1709 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=*d,a")
1710 (sign_extend:SI
1711 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "0,g")))]
1712 @dots{})
1713@end smallexample
1714@end ifset
1715@end table
1716
1717@node Machine Constraints
1718@subsection Constraints for Particular Machines
1719@cindex machine specific constraints
1720@cindex constraints, machine specific
1721
1722Whenever possible, you should use the general-purpose constraint letters
1723in @code{asm} arguments, since they will convey meaning more readily to
1724people reading your code. Failing that, use the constraint letters
1725that usually have very similar meanings across architectures. The most
1726commonly used constraints are @samp{m} and @samp{r} (for memory and
1727general-purpose registers respectively; @pxref{Simple Constraints}), and
1728@samp{I}, usually the letter indicating the most common
1729immediate-constant format.
1730
f38840db
ZW
1731Each architecture defines additional constraints. These constraints
1732are used by the compiler itself for instruction generation, as well as
1733for @code{asm} statements; therefore, some of the constraints are not
1734particularly useful for @code{asm}. Here is a summary of some of the
1735machine-dependent constraints available on some particular machines;
1736it includes both constraints that are useful for @code{asm} and
1737constraints that aren't. The compiler source file mentioned in the
1738table heading for each architecture is the definitive reference for
1739the meanings of that architecture's constraints.
6ccde948 1740
b4fbcb1b 1741@c Please keep this table alphabetized by target!
03dda8e3 1742@table @emph
5c0da018
IB
1743@item AArch64 family---@file{config/aarch64/constraints.md}
1744@table @code
1745@item k
1746The stack pointer register (@code{SP})
1747
1748@item w
43cacb12
RS
1749Floating point register, Advanced SIMD vector register or SVE vector register
1750
1751@item Upl
1752One of the low eight SVE predicate registers (@code{P0} to @code{P7})
1753
1754@item Upa
1755Any of the SVE predicate registers (@code{P0} to @code{P15})
5c0da018
IB
1756
1757@item I
1758Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in an @code{ADD}
1759instruction
1760
1761@item J
1762Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a @code{SUB}
1763instruction (once negated)
1764
1765@item K
1766Integer constant that can be used with a 32-bit logical instruction
1767
1768@item L
1769Integer constant that can be used with a 64-bit logical instruction
1770
1771@item M
1772Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 32-bit @code{MOV}
1773pseudo instruction. The @code{MOV} may be assembled to one of several different
1774machine instructions depending on the value
1775
1776@item N
1777Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 64-bit @code{MOV}
1778pseudo instruction
1779
1780@item S
1781An absolute symbolic address or a label reference
1782
1783@item Y
1784Floating point constant zero
1785
1786@item Z
1787Integer constant zero
1788
5c0da018
IB
1789@item Ush
1790The high part (bits 12 and upwards) of the pc-relative address of a symbol
1791within 4GB of the instruction
1792
1793@item Q
1794A memory address which uses a single base register with no offset
1795
1796@item Ump
1797A memory address suitable for a load/store pair instruction in SI, DI, SF and
1798DF modes
1799
5c0da018
IB
1800@end table
1801
1802
5d5f6720
JR
1803@item ARC ---@file{config/arc/constraints.md}
1804@table @code
1805@item q
1806Registers usable in ARCompact 16-bit instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3},
1807@code{r12}-@code{r15}. This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1808option is in effect.
1809
1810@item e
1811Registers usable as base-regs of memory addresses in ARCompact 16-bit memory
1812instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3}, @code{r12}-@code{r15}, @code{sp}.
1813This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1814option is in effect.
1815@item D
1816ARC FPX (dpfp) 64-bit registers. @code{D0}, @code{D1}.
1817
1818@item I
1819A signed 12-bit integer constant.
1820
1821@item Cal
1822constant for arithmetic/logical operations. This might be any constant
1823that can be put into a long immediate by the assmbler or linker without
1824involving a PIC relocation.
1825
1826@item K
1827A 3-bit unsigned integer constant.
1828
1829@item L
1830A 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1831
1832@item CnL
1833One's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1834
1835@item CmL
1836Two's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1837
1838@item M
1839A 5-bit unsigned integer constant.
1840
1841@item O
1842A 7-bit unsigned integer constant.
1843
1844@item P
1845A 8-bit unsigned integer constant.
1846
1847@item H
1848Any const_double value.
1849@end table
1850
dae840fc 1851@item ARM family---@file{config/arm/constraints.md}
03dda8e3 1852@table @code
b24671f7
RR
1853
1854@item h
1855In Thumb state, the core registers @code{r8}-@code{r15}.
1856
1857@item k
1858The stack pointer register.
1859
1860@item l
1861In Thumb State the core registers @code{r0}-@code{r7}. In ARM state this
1862is an alias for the @code{r} constraint.
1863
1864@item t
1865VFP floating-point registers @code{s0}-@code{s31}. Used for 32 bit values.
1866
9b66ebb1 1867@item w
b24671f7
RR
1868VFP floating-point registers @code{d0}-@code{d31} and the appropriate
1869subset @code{d0}-@code{d15} based on command line options.
1870Used for 64 bit values only. Not valid for Thumb1.
1871
1872@item y
1873The iWMMX co-processor registers.
1874
1875@item z
1876The iWMMX GR registers.
9b66ebb1 1877
03dda8e3 1878@item G
dae840fc 1879The floating-point constant 0.0
03dda8e3
RK
1880
1881@item I
1882Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in a data processing
1883instruction. That is, an integer in the range 0 to 255 rotated by a
1884multiple of 2
1885
1886@item J
630d3d5a 1887Integer in the range @minus{}4095 to 4095
03dda8e3
RK
1888
1889@item K
1890Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when inverted (ones complement)
1891
1892@item L
1893Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when negated (twos complement)
1894
1895@item M
1896Integer in the range 0 to 32
1897
1898@item Q
1899A memory reference where the exact address is in a single register
1900(`@samp{m}' is preferable for @code{asm} statements)
1901
1902@item R
1903An item in the constant pool
1904
1905@item S
1906A symbol in the text segment of the current file
03dda8e3 1907
1e1ab407 1908@item Uv
9b66ebb1
PB
1909A memory reference suitable for VFP load/store insns (reg+constant offset)
1910
fdd695fd
PB
1911@item Uy
1912A memory reference suitable for iWMMXt load/store instructions.
1913
1e1ab407 1914@item Uq
0bdcd332 1915A memory reference suitable for the ARMv4 ldrsb instruction.
db875b15 1916@end table
1e1ab407 1917
fc262682 1918@item AVR family---@file{config/avr/constraints.md}
052a4b28
DC
1919@table @code
1920@item l
1921Registers from r0 to r15
1922
1923@item a
1924Registers from r16 to r23
1925
1926@item d
1927Registers from r16 to r31
1928
1929@item w
3a69a7d5 1930Registers from r24 to r31. These registers can be used in @samp{adiw} command
052a4b28
DC
1931
1932@item e
d7d9c429 1933Pointer register (r26--r31)
052a4b28
DC
1934
1935@item b
d7d9c429 1936Base pointer register (r28--r31)
052a4b28 1937
3a69a7d5
MM
1938@item q
1939Stack pointer register (SPH:SPL)
1940
052a4b28
DC
1941@item t
1942Temporary register r0
1943
1944@item x
1945Register pair X (r27:r26)
1946
1947@item y
1948Register pair Y (r29:r28)
1949
1950@item z
1951Register pair Z (r31:r30)
1952
1953@item I
630d3d5a 1954Constant greater than @minus{}1, less than 64
052a4b28
DC
1955
1956@item J
630d3d5a 1957Constant greater than @minus{}64, less than 1
052a4b28
DC
1958
1959@item K
1960Constant integer 2
1961
1962@item L
1963Constant integer 0
1964
1965@item M
1966Constant that fits in 8 bits
1967
1968@item N
630d3d5a 1969Constant integer @minus{}1
052a4b28
DC
1970
1971@item O
3a69a7d5 1972Constant integer 8, 16, or 24
052a4b28
DC
1973
1974@item P
1975Constant integer 1
1976
1977@item G
1978A floating point constant 0.0
0e8eb4d8 1979
0e8eb4d8
EW
1980@item Q
1981A memory address based on Y or Z pointer with displacement.
052a4b28 1982@end table
53054e77 1983
b4fbcb1b
SL
1984@item Blackfin family---@file{config/bfin/constraints.md}
1985@table @code
1986@item a
1987P register
1988
1989@item d
1990D register
1991
1992@item z
1993A call clobbered P register.
1994
1995@item q@var{n}
1996A single register. If @var{n} is in the range 0 to 7, the corresponding D
1997register. If it is @code{A}, then the register P0.
1998
1999@item D
2000Even-numbered D register
2001
2002@item W
2003Odd-numbered D register
2004
2005@item e
2006Accumulator register.
2007
2008@item A
2009Even-numbered accumulator register.
2010
2011@item B
2012Odd-numbered accumulator register.
2013
2014@item b
2015I register
2016
2017@item v
2018B register
2019
2020@item f
2021M register
2022
2023@item c
2024Registers used for circular buffering, i.e. I, B, or L registers.
2025
2026@item C
2027The CC register.
2028
2029@item t
2030LT0 or LT1.
2031
2032@item k
2033LC0 or LC1.
2034
2035@item u
2036LB0 or LB1.
2037
2038@item x
2039Any D, P, B, M, I or L register.
2040
2041@item y
2042Additional registers typically used only in prologues and epilogues: RETS,
2043RETN, RETI, RETX, RETE, ASTAT, SEQSTAT and USP.
2044
2045@item w
2046Any register except accumulators or CC.
2047
2048@item Ksh
2049Signed 16 bit integer (in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767)
2050
2051@item Kuh
2052Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535)
2053
2054@item Ks7
2055Signed 7 bit integer (in the range @minus{}64 to 63)
2056
2057@item Ku7
2058Unsigned 7 bit integer (in the range 0 to 127)
2059
2060@item Ku5
2061Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31)
2062
2063@item Ks4
2064Signed 4 bit integer (in the range @minus{}8 to 7)
2065
2066@item Ks3
2067Signed 3 bit integer (in the range @minus{}3 to 4)
2068
2069@item Ku3
2070Unsigned 3 bit integer (in the range 0 to 7)
2071
2072@item P@var{n}
2073Constant @var{n}, where @var{n} is a single-digit constant in the range 0 to 4.
2074
2075@item PA
2076An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2077use with either accumulator.
2078
2079@item PB
2080An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2081use only with accumulator A1.
2082
2083@item M1
2084Constant 255.
2085
2086@item M2
2087Constant 65535.
2088
2089@item J
2090An integer constant with exactly a single bit set.
2091
2092@item L
2093An integer constant with all bits set except exactly one.
2094
2095@item H
2096
2097@item Q
2098Any SYMBOL_REF.
2099@end table
2100
2101@item CR16 Architecture---@file{config/cr16/cr16.h}
2102@table @code
2103
2104@item b
2105Registers from r0 to r14 (registers without stack pointer)
2106
2107@item t
2108Register from r0 to r11 (all 16-bit registers)
2109
2110@item p
2111Register from r12 to r15 (all 32-bit registers)
2112
2113@item I
2114Signed constant that fits in 4 bits
2115
2116@item J
2117Signed constant that fits in 5 bits
2118
2119@item K
2120Signed constant that fits in 6 bits
2121
2122@item L
2123Unsigned constant that fits in 4 bits
2124
2125@item M
2126Signed constant that fits in 32 bits
2127
2128@item N
2129Check for 64 bits wide constants for add/sub instructions
2130
2131@item G
2132Floating point constant that is legal for store immediate
2133@end table
2134
fbceb769
SL
2135@item C-SKY---@file{config/csky/constraints.md}
2136@table @code
2137
2138@item a
2139The mini registers r0 - r7.
2140
2141@item b
2142The low registers r0 - r15.
2143
2144@item c
2145C register.
2146
2147@item y
2148HI and LO registers.
2149
2150@item l
2151LO register.
2152
2153@item h
2154HI register.
2155
2156@item v
2157Vector registers.
2158
2159@item z
2160Stack pointer register (SP).
2161@end table
2162
2163@ifset INTERNALS
2164The C-SKY back end supports a large set of additional constraints
2165that are only useful for instruction selection or splitting rather
2166than inline asm, such as constraints representing constant integer
2167ranges accepted by particular instruction encodings.
2168Refer to the source code for details.
2169@end ifset
2170
feeeff5c
JR
2171@item Epiphany---@file{config/epiphany/constraints.md}
2172@table @code
2173@item U16
2174An unsigned 16-bit constant.
2175
2176@item K
2177An unsigned 5-bit constant.
2178
2179@item L
2180A signed 11-bit constant.
2181
2182@item Cm1
2183A signed 11-bit constant added to @minus{}1.
2184Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2185
2186@item Cl1
2187Left-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a block of leading ones, the rest
2188being a block of trailing zeroes.
2189Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2190
2191@item Cr1
2192Right-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a trailing block of ones, the
2193rest being zeroes. Or to put it another way, one less than a power of two.
2194Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2195
2196@item Cal
2197Constant for arithmetic/logical operations.
2198This is like @code{i}, except that for position independent code,
2199no symbols / expressions needing relocations are allowed.
2200
2201@item Csy
2202Symbolic constant for call/jump instruction.
2203
2204@item Rcs
2205The register class usable in short insns. This is a register class
2206constraint, and can thus drive register allocation.
2207This constraint won't match unless @option{-mprefer-short-insn-regs} is
2208in effect.
2209
2210@item Rsc
2211The the register class of registers that can be used to hold a
2212sibcall call address. I.e., a caller-saved register.
2213
2214@item Rct
2215Core control register class.
2216
2217@item Rgs
2218The register group usable in short insns.
2219This constraint does not use a register class, so that it only
2220passively matches suitable registers, and doesn't drive register allocation.
2221
2222@ifset INTERNALS
2223@item Car
2224Constant suitable for the addsi3_r pattern. This is a valid offset
2225For byte, halfword, or word addressing.
2226@end ifset
2227
2228@item Rra
2229Matches the return address if it can be replaced with the link register.
2230
2231@item Rcc
2232Matches the integer condition code register.
2233
2234@item Sra
2235Matches the return address if it is in a stack slot.
2236
2237@item Cfm
2238Matches control register values to switch fp mode, which are encapsulated in
2239@code{UNSPEC_FP_MODE}.
2240@end table
2241
b4fbcb1b 2242@item FRV---@file{config/frv/frv.h}
b25364a0 2243@table @code
b4fbcb1b
SL
2244@item a
2245Register in the class @code{ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
b25364a0
S
2246
2247@item b
b4fbcb1b
SL
2248Register in the class @code{EVEN_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2249
2250@item c
2251Register in the class @code{CC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3} and
2252@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
2253
2254@item d
2255Register in the class @code{GPR_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2256
2257@item e
2258Register in the class @code{EVEN_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2259Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2260mode larger than 4 bytes.
2261
2262@item f
2263Register in the class @code{FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2264
2265@item h
2266Register in the class @code{FEVEN_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2267Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2268mode larger than 4 bytes.
2269
2270@item l
2271Register in the class @code{LR_REG} (the @code{lr} register).
2272
2273@item q
2274Register in the class @code{QUAD_REGS} (@code{gr2} to @code{gr63}).
2275Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2276the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
b25364a0
S
2277
2278@item t
b4fbcb1b 2279Register in the class @code{ICC_REGS} (@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
b25364a0 2280
b4fbcb1b
SL
2281@item u
2282Register in the class @code{FCC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3}).
2283
2284@item v
2285Register in the class @code{ICR_REGS} (@code{cc4} to @code{cc7}).
2286
2287@item w
2288Register in the class @code{FCR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc3}).
2289
2290@item x
2291Register in the class @code{QUAD_FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2292Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2293the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
2294
2295@item z
2296Register in the class @code{SPR_REGS} (@code{lcr} and @code{lr}).
2297
2298@item A
2299Register in the class @code{QUAD_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2300
2301@item B
2302Register in the class @code{ACCG_REGS} (@code{accg0} to @code{accg7}).
2303
2304@item C
2305Register in the class @code{CR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc7}).
2306
2307@item G
2308Floating point constant zero
b25364a0
S
2309
2310@item I
b4fbcb1b 23116-bit signed integer constant
b25364a0
S
2312
2313@item J
b4fbcb1b 231410-bit signed integer constant
b25364a0
S
2315
2316@item L
b4fbcb1b 231716-bit signed integer constant
b25364a0
S
2318
2319@item M
b4fbcb1b 232016-bit unsigned integer constant
b25364a0
S
2321
2322@item N
b4fbcb1b
SL
232312-bit signed integer constant that is negative---i.e.@: in the
2324range of @minus{}2048 to @minus{}1
2325
2326@item O
2327Constant zero
2328
2329@item P
233012-bit signed integer constant that is greater than zero---i.e.@: in the
2331range of 1 to 2047.
b25364a0 2332
b25364a0
S
2333@end table
2334
fef939d6
JB
2335@item FT32---@file{config/ft32/constraints.md}
2336@table @code
2337@item A
2338An absolute address
2339
2340@item B
2341An offset address
2342
2343@item W
2344A register indirect memory operand
2345
2346@item e
2347An offset address.
2348
2349@item f
2350An offset address.
2351
2352@item O
2353The constant zero or one
2354
2355@item I
2356A 16-bit signed constant (@minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767)
2357
2358@item w
2359A bitfield mask suitable for bext or bins
2360
2361@item x
2362An inverted bitfield mask suitable for bext or bins
2363
2364@item L
2365A 16-bit unsigned constant, multiple of 4 (0 @dots{} 65532)
2366
2367@item S
2368A 20-bit signed constant (@minus{}524288 @dots{} 524287)
2369
2370@item b
2371A constant for a bitfield width (1 @dots{} 16)
2372
2373@item KA
2374A 10-bit signed constant (@minus{}512 @dots{} 511)
2375
2376@end table
2377
8119b4e4
JDA
2378@item Hewlett-Packard PA-RISC---@file{config/pa/pa.h}
2379@table @code
2380@item a
2381General register 1
2382
2383@item f
2384Floating point register
2385
2386@item q
2387Shift amount register
2388
2389@item x
2390Floating point register (deprecated)
2391
2392@item y
2393Upper floating point register (32-bit), floating point register (64-bit)
2394
2395@item Z
2396Any register
2397
2398@item I
2399Signed 11-bit integer constant
2400
2401@item J
2402Signed 14-bit integer constant
2403
2404@item K
2405Integer constant that can be deposited with a @code{zdepi} instruction
2406
2407@item L
2408Signed 5-bit integer constant
2409
2410@item M
2411Integer constant 0
2412
2413@item N
2414Integer constant that can be loaded with a @code{ldil} instruction
2415
2416@item O
2417Integer constant whose value plus one is a power of 2
2418
2419@item P
2420Integer constant that can be used for @code{and} operations in @code{depi}
2421and @code{extru} instructions
2422
2423@item S
2424Integer constant 31
2425
2426@item U
2427Integer constant 63
2428
2429@item G
2430Floating-point constant 0.0
2431
2432@item A
2433A @code{lo_sum} data-linkage-table memory operand
2434
2435@item Q
2436A memory operand that can be used as the destination operand of an
2437integer store instruction
2438
2439@item R
2440A scaled or unscaled indexed memory operand
2441
2442@item T
2443A memory operand for floating-point loads and stores
2444
2445@item W
2446A register indirect memory operand
2447@end table
2448
b4fbcb1b 2449@item Intel IA-64---@file{config/ia64/ia64.h}
03dda8e3 2450@table @code
b4fbcb1b
SL
2451@item a
2452General register @code{r0} to @code{r3} for @code{addl} instruction
03dda8e3 2453
b4fbcb1b
SL
2454@item b
2455Branch register
7a430e3b
SC
2456
2457@item c
2458Predicate register (@samp{c} as in ``conditional'')
2459
b4fbcb1b
SL
2460@item d
2461Application register residing in M-unit
0d4a78eb 2462
b4fbcb1b
SL
2463@item e
2464Application register residing in I-unit
0d4a78eb 2465
b4fbcb1b
SL
2466@item f
2467Floating-point register
3efd5670 2468
b4fbcb1b
SL
2469@item m
2470Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>},
2471the operand can have postincrement and postdecrement which
2472require printing with @samp{%Pn} on IA-64.
3efd5670 2473
b4fbcb1b
SL
2474@item G
2475Floating-point constant 0.0 or 1.0
0d4a78eb 2476
b4fbcb1b
SL
2477@item I
247814-bit signed integer constant
0d4a78eb
BS
2479
2480@item J
b4fbcb1b
SL
248122-bit signed integer constant
2482
2483@item K
24848-bit signed integer constant for logical instructions
0d4a78eb
BS
2485
2486@item L
b4fbcb1b 24878-bit adjusted signed integer constant for compare pseudo-ops
0d4a78eb 2488
b4fbcb1b
SL
2489@item M
24906-bit unsigned integer constant for shift counts
2491
2492@item N
24939-bit signed integer constant for load and store postincrements
2494
2495@item O
2496The constant zero
2497
2498@item P
24990 or @minus{}1 for @code{dep} instruction
0d4a78eb
BS
2500
2501@item Q
b4fbcb1b
SL
2502Non-volatile memory for floating-point loads and stores
2503
2504@item R
2505Integer constant in the range 1 to 4 for @code{shladd} instruction
2506
2507@item S
2508Memory operand except postincrement and postdecrement. This is
2509now roughly the same as @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<}
2510or @samp{>}.
0d4a78eb
BS
2511@end table
2512
74fe790b
ZW
2513@item M32C---@file{config/m32c/m32c.c}
2514@table @code
38b2d076
DD
2515@item Rsp
2516@itemx Rfb
2517@itemx Rsb
2518@samp{$sp}, @samp{$fb}, @samp{$sb}.
2519
2520@item Rcr
2521Any control register, when they're 16 bits wide (nothing if control
2522registers are 24 bits wide)
2523
2524@item Rcl
2525Any control register, when they're 24 bits wide.
2526
2527@item R0w
2528@itemx R1w
2529@itemx R2w
2530@itemx R3w
2531$r0, $r1, $r2, $r3.
2532
2533@item R02
2534$r0 or $r2, or $r2r0 for 32 bit values.
2535
2536@item R13
2537$r1 or $r3, or $r3r1 for 32 bit values.
2538
2539@item Rdi
2540A register that can hold a 64 bit value.
2541
2542@item Rhl
2543$r0 or $r1 (registers with addressable high/low bytes)
2544
2545@item R23
2546$r2 or $r3
2547
2548@item Raa
2549Address registers
2550
2551@item Raw
2552Address registers when they're 16 bits wide.
2553
2554@item Ral
2555Address registers when they're 24 bits wide.
2556
2557@item Rqi
2558Registers that can hold QI values.
2559
2560@item Rad
2561Registers that can be used with displacements ($a0, $a1, $sb).
2562
2563@item Rsi
2564Registers that can hold 32 bit values.
2565
2566@item Rhi
2567Registers that can hold 16 bit values.
2568
2569@item Rhc
2570Registers chat can hold 16 bit values, including all control
2571registers.
2572
2573@item Rra
2574$r0 through R1, plus $a0 and $a1.
2575
2576@item Rfl
2577The flags register.
2578
2579@item Rmm
2580The memory-based pseudo-registers $mem0 through $mem15.
2581
2582@item Rpi
2583Registers that can hold pointers (16 bit registers for r8c, m16c; 24
2584bit registers for m32cm, m32c).
2585
2586@item Rpa
2587Matches multiple registers in a PARALLEL to form a larger register.
2588Used to match function return values.
2589
2590@item Is3
8ad1dde7 2591@minus{}8 @dots{} 7
38b2d076
DD
2592
2593@item IS1
8ad1dde7 2594@minus{}128 @dots{} 127
38b2d076
DD
2595
2596@item IS2
8ad1dde7 2597@minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767
38b2d076
DD
2598
2599@item IU2
26000 @dots{} 65535
2601
2602@item In4
8ad1dde7 2603@minus{}8 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 8
38b2d076
DD
2604
2605@item In5
8ad1dde7 2606@minus{}16 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 16
38b2d076 2607
23fed240 2608@item In6
8ad1dde7 2609@minus{}32 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 32
38b2d076
DD
2610
2611@item IM2
8ad1dde7 2612@minus{}65536 @dots{} @minus{}1
38b2d076
DD
2613
2614@item Ilb
2615An 8 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2616
2617@item Ilw
2618A 16 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2619
2620@item Sd
2621The common src/dest memory addressing modes.
2622
2623@item Sa
2624Memory addressed using $a0 or $a1.
2625
2626@item Si
2627Memory addressed with immediate addresses.
2628
2629@item Ss
2630Memory addressed using the stack pointer ($sp).
2631
2632@item Sf
2633Memory addressed using the frame base register ($fb).
2634
2635@item Ss
2636Memory addressed using the small base register ($sb).
2637
2638@item S1
2639$r1h
e2491744
DD
2640@end table
2641
80920132
ME
2642@item MicroBlaze---@file{config/microblaze/constraints.md}
2643@table @code
2644@item d
2645A general register (@code{r0} to @code{r31}).
2646
2647@item z
2648A status register (@code{rmsr}, @code{$fcc1} to @code{$fcc7}).
e2491744 2649
74fe790b 2650@end table
38b2d076 2651
cbbb5b6d 2652@item MIPS---@file{config/mips/constraints.md}
4226378a
PK
2653@table @code
2654@item d
0cb14750
MR
2655A general-purpose register. This is equivalent to @code{r} unless
2656generating MIPS16 code, in which case the MIPS16 register set is used.
4226378a
PK
2657
2658@item f
cbbb5b6d 2659A floating-point register (if available).
4226378a
PK
2660
2661@item h
21dfc6dc 2662Formerly the @code{hi} register. This constraint is no longer supported.
4226378a
PK
2663
2664@item l
21dfc6dc
RS
2665The @code{lo} register. Use this register to store values that are
2666no bigger than a word.
4226378a
PK
2667
2668@item x
21dfc6dc
RS
2669The concatenated @code{hi} and @code{lo} registers. Use this register
2670to store doubleword values.
cbbb5b6d
RS
2671
2672@item c
2673A register suitable for use in an indirect jump. This will always be
2674@code{$25} for @option{-mabicalls}.
4226378a 2675
2feaae20
RS
2676@item v
2677Register @code{$3}. Do not use this constraint in new code;
2678it is retained only for compatibility with glibc.
2679
4226378a 2680@item y
cbbb5b6d 2681Equivalent to @code{r}; retained for backwards compatibility.
4226378a
PK
2682
2683@item z
cbbb5b6d 2684A floating-point condition code register.
4226378a
PK
2685
2686@item I
cbbb5b6d 2687A signed 16-bit constant (for arithmetic instructions).
4226378a
PK
2688
2689@item J
cbbb5b6d 2690Integer zero.
4226378a
PK
2691
2692@item K
cbbb5b6d 2693An unsigned 16-bit constant (for logic instructions).
4226378a
PK
2694
2695@item L
cbbb5b6d
RS
2696A signed 32-bit constant in which the lower 16 bits are zero.
2697Such constants can be loaded using @code{lui}.
4226378a
PK
2698
2699@item M
cbbb5b6d
RS
2700A constant that cannot be loaded using @code{lui}, @code{addiu}
2701or @code{ori}.
4226378a
PK
2702
2703@item N
8ad1dde7 2704A constant in the range @minus{}65535 to @minus{}1 (inclusive).
4226378a
PK
2705
2706@item O
cbbb5b6d 2707A signed 15-bit constant.
4226378a
PK
2708
2709@item P
cbbb5b6d 2710A constant in the range 1 to 65535 (inclusive).
4226378a
PK
2711
2712@item G
cbbb5b6d 2713Floating-point zero.
4226378a
PK
2714
2715@item R
cbbb5b6d 2716An address that can be used in a non-macro load or store.
22c4c869
CM
2717
2718@item ZC
047b52f6
MF
2719A memory operand whose address is formed by a base register and offset
2720that is suitable for use in instructions with the same addressing mode
2721as @code{ll} and @code{sc}.
22c4c869
CM
2722
2723@item ZD
82f84ecb
MF
2724An address suitable for a @code{prefetch} instruction, or for any other
2725instruction with the same addressing mode as @code{prefetch}.
4226378a
PK
2726@end table
2727
c47b0cb4 2728@item Motorola 680x0---@file{config/m68k/constraints.md}
03dda8e3
RK
2729@table @code
2730@item a
2731Address register
2732
2733@item d
2734Data register
2735
2736@item f
273768881 floating-point register, if available
2738
03dda8e3
RK
2739@item I
2740Integer in the range 1 to 8
2741
2742@item J
1e5f973d 274316-bit signed number
03dda8e3
RK
2744
2745@item K
2746Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x80
2747
2748@item L
630d3d5a 2749Integer in the range @minus{}8 to @minus{}1
03dda8e3
RK
2750
2751@item M
2752Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x100
2753
c47b0cb4
MK
2754@item N
2755Range 24 to 31, rotatert:SI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
2756
2757@item O
275816 (for rotate using swap)
2759
2760@item P
2761Range 8 to 15, rotatert:HI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
2762
2763@item R
2764Numbers that mov3q can handle
2765
03dda8e3
RK
2766@item G
2767Floating point constant that is not a 68881 constant
c47b0cb4
MK
2768
2769@item S
2770Operands that satisfy 'm' when -mpcrel is in effect
2771
2772@item T
2773Operands that satisfy 's' when -mpcrel is not in effect
2774
2775@item Q
2776Address register indirect addressing mode
2777
2778@item U
2779Register offset addressing
2780
2781@item W
2782const_call_operand
2783
2784@item Cs
2785symbol_ref or const
2786
2787@item Ci
2788const_int
2789
2790@item C0
2791const_int 0
2792
2793@item Cj
2794Range of signed numbers that don't fit in 16 bits
2795
2796@item Cmvq
2797Integers valid for mvq
2798
2799@item Capsw
2800Integers valid for a moveq followed by a swap
2801
2802@item Cmvz
2803Integers valid for mvz
2804
2805@item Cmvs
2806Integers valid for mvs
2807
2808@item Ap
2809push_operand
2810
2811@item Ac
2812Non-register operands allowed in clr
2813
03dda8e3
RK
2814@end table
2815
cceb575c
AG
2816@item Moxie---@file{config/moxie/constraints.md}
2817@table @code
2818@item A
2819An absolute address
2820
2821@item B
2822An offset address
2823
2824@item W
2825A register indirect memory operand
2826
2827@item I
2828A constant in the range of 0 to 255.
2829
2830@item N
8ad1dde7 2831A constant in the range of 0 to @minus{}255.
cceb575c
AG
2832
2833@end table
2834
f6a83b4a
DD
2835@item MSP430--@file{config/msp430/constraints.md}
2836@table @code
2837
2838@item R12
2839Register R12.
2840
2841@item R13
2842Register R13.
2843
2844@item K
2845Integer constant 1.
2846
2847@item L
2848Integer constant -1^20..1^19.
2849
2850@item M
2851Integer constant 1-4.
2852
2853@item Ya
2854Memory references which do not require an extended MOVX instruction.
2855
2856@item Yl
2857Memory reference, labels only.
2858
2859@item Ys
2860Memory reference, stack only.
2861
2862@end table
2863
9304f876
CJW
2864@item NDS32---@file{config/nds32/constraints.md}
2865@table @code
2866@item w
2867LOW register class $r0 to $r7 constraint for V3/V3M ISA.
2868@item l
2869LOW register class $r0 to $r7.
2870@item d
2871MIDDLE register class $r0 to $r11, $r16 to $r19.
2872@item h
2873HIGH register class $r12 to $r14, $r20 to $r31.
2874@item t
2875Temporary assist register $ta (i.e.@: $r15).
2876@item k
2877Stack register $sp.
2878@item Iu03
2879Unsigned immediate 3-bit value.
2880@item In03
2881Negative immediate 3-bit value in the range of @minus{}7--0.
2882@item Iu04
2883Unsigned immediate 4-bit value.
2884@item Is05
2885Signed immediate 5-bit value.
2886@item Iu05
2887Unsigned immediate 5-bit value.
2888@item In05
2889Negative immediate 5-bit value in the range of @minus{}31--0.
2890@item Ip05
2891Unsigned immediate 5-bit value for movpi45 instruction with range 16--47.
2892@item Iu06
2893Unsigned immediate 6-bit value constraint for addri36.sp instruction.
2894@item Iu08
2895Unsigned immediate 8-bit value.
2896@item Iu09
2897Unsigned immediate 9-bit value.
2898@item Is10
2899Signed immediate 10-bit value.
2900@item Is11
2901Signed immediate 11-bit value.
2902@item Is15
2903Signed immediate 15-bit value.
2904@item Iu15
2905Unsigned immediate 15-bit value.
2906@item Ic15
2907A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bclr instruction.
2908@item Ie15
2909A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bset instruction.
2910@item It15
2911A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for btgl instruction.
2912@item Ii15
2913A constant whose compliment value is in the range of imm15u
2914and ok for bitci instruction.
2915@item Is16
2916Signed immediate 16-bit value.
2917@item Is17
2918Signed immediate 17-bit value.
2919@item Is19
2920Signed immediate 19-bit value.
2921@item Is20
2922Signed immediate 20-bit value.
2923@item Ihig
2924The immediate value that can be simply set high 20-bit.
2925@item Izeb
2926The immediate value 0xff.
2927@item Izeh
2928The immediate value 0xffff.
2929@item Ixls
2930The immediate value 0x01.
2931@item Ix11
2932The immediate value 0x7ff.
2933@item Ibms
2934The immediate value with power of 2.
2935@item Ifex
2936The immediate value with power of 2 minus 1.
2937@item U33
2938Memory constraint for 333 format.
2939@item U45
2940Memory constraint for 45 format.
2941@item U37
2942Memory constraint for 37 format.
2943@end table
2944
e430824f
CLT
2945@item Nios II family---@file{config/nios2/constraints.md}
2946@table @code
2947
2948@item I
2949Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
2950instruction taking a signed 16-bit number. Range
2951@minus{}32768 to 32767.
2952
2953@item J
2954Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
2955instruction taking an unsigned 16-bit number. Range
29560 to 65535.
2957
2958@item K
2959Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
2960instruction taking only the upper 16-bits of a
296132-bit number. Range 32-bit numbers with the lower
296216-bits being 0.
2963
2964@item L
2965Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for a
2966shift instruction. Range 0 to 31.
2967
2968@item M
2969Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
2970only the value 0. Can be used in conjunction with
2971the format modifier @code{z} to use @code{r0}
2972instead of @code{0} in the assembly output.
2973
2974@item N
2975Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
2976a custom instruction opcode. Range 0 to 255.
2977
3bbbe009
SL
2978@item P
2979An immediate operand for R2 andchi/andci instructions.
2980
e430824f
CLT
2981@item S
2982Matches immediates which are addresses in the small
2983data section and therefore can be added to @code{gp}
2984as a 16-bit immediate to re-create their 32-bit value.
2985
524d2e49
SL
2986@item U
2987Matches constants suitable as an operand for the rdprs and
2988cache instructions.
2989
2990@item v
2991A memory operand suitable for Nios II R2 load/store
2992exclusive instructions.
2993
42e6ab74
SL
2994@item w
2995A memory operand suitable for load/store IO and cache
2996instructions.
2997
e430824f
CLT
2998@ifset INTERNALS
2999@item T
3000A @code{const} wrapped @code{UNSPEC} expression,
3001representing a supported PIC or TLS relocation.
3002@end ifset
3003
3004@end table
3005
5e426dd4
PK
3006@item PDP-11---@file{config/pdp11/constraints.md}
3007@table @code
3008@item a
3009Floating point registers AC0 through AC3. These can be loaded from/to
3010memory with a single instruction.
3011
3012@item d
868e54d1
PK
3013Odd numbered general registers (R1, R3, R5). These are used for
301416-bit multiply operations.
5e426dd4 3015
b4324a14
PK
3016@item D
3017A memory reference that is encoded within the opcode, but not
3018auto-increment or auto-decrement.
3019
5e426dd4
PK
3020@item f
3021Any of the floating point registers (AC0 through AC5).
3022
3023@item G
3024Floating point constant 0.
3025
b4324a14
PK
3026@item h
3027Floating point registers AC4 and AC5. These cannot be loaded from/to
3028memory with a single instruction.
3029
5e426dd4
PK
3030@item I
3031An integer constant that fits in 16 bits.
3032
b4fbcb1b
SL
3033@item J
3034An integer constant whose low order 16 bits are zero.
3035
3036@item K
3037An integer constant that does not meet the constraints for codes
3038@samp{I} or @samp{J}.
3039
3040@item L
3041The integer constant 1.
3042
3043@item M
3044The integer constant @minus{}1.
3045
3046@item N
3047The integer constant 0.
3048
3049@item O
b4324a14 3050Integer constants 0 through 3; shifts by these
b4fbcb1b
SL
3051amounts are handled as multiple single-bit shifts rather than a single
3052variable-length shift.
3053
3054@item Q
3055A memory reference which requires an additional word (address or
3056offset) after the opcode.
3057
3058@item R
3059A memory reference that is encoded within the opcode.
3060
3061@end table
3062
3063@item PowerPC and IBM RS6000---@file{config/rs6000/constraints.md}
3064@table @code
3065@item b
3066Address base register
3067
3068@item d
3069Floating point register (containing 64-bit value)
3070
3071@item f
3072Floating point register (containing 32-bit value)
3073
3074@item v
3075Altivec vector register
3076
3077@item wa
dc703d70 3078Any VSX register if the @option{-mvsx} option was used or NO_REGS.
b4fbcb1b 3079
6a116f14
MM
3080When using any of the register constraints (@code{wa}, @code{wd},
3081@code{wf}, @code{wg}, @code{wh}, @code{wi}, @code{wj}, @code{wk},
4e8a3a35
MM
3082@code{wl}, @code{wm}, @code{wo}, @code{wp}, @code{wq}, @code{ws},
3083@code{wt}, @code{wu}, @code{wv}, @code{ww}, or @code{wy})
c477a667
MM
3084that take VSX registers, you must use @code{%x<n>} in the template so
3085that the correct register is used. Otherwise the register number
3086output in the assembly file will be incorrect if an Altivec register
3087is an operand of a VSX instruction that expects VSX register
3088numbering.
6a116f14
MM
3089
3090@smallexample
dc703d70
SL
3091asm ("xvadddp %x0,%x1,%x2"
3092 : "=wa" (v1)
3093 : "wa" (v2), "wa" (v3));
6a116f14
MM
3094@end smallexample
3095
dc703d70 3096@noindent
6a116f14
MM
3097is correct, but:
3098
3099@smallexample
dc703d70
SL
3100asm ("xvadddp %0,%1,%2"
3101 : "=wa" (v1)
3102 : "wa" (v2), "wa" (v3));
6a116f14
MM
3103@end smallexample
3104
dc703d70 3105@noindent
6a116f14
MM
3106is not correct.
3107
dd551aa1
MM
3108If an instruction only takes Altivec registers, you do not want to use
3109@code{%x<n>}.
3110
3111@smallexample
dc703d70
SL
3112asm ("xsaddqp %0,%1,%2"
3113 : "=v" (v1)
3114 : "v" (v2), "v" (v3));
dd551aa1
MM
3115@end smallexample
3116
dc703d70 3117@noindent
dd551aa1
MM
3118is correct because the @code{xsaddqp} instruction only takes Altivec
3119registers, while:
3120
3121@smallexample
dc703d70
SL
3122asm ("xsaddqp %x0,%x1,%x2"
3123 : "=v" (v1)
3124 : "v" (v2), "v" (v3));
dd551aa1
MM
3125@end smallexample
3126
dc703d70 3127@noindent
dd551aa1
MM
3128is incorrect.
3129
d5906efc 3130@item wb
1610d410 3131Altivec register if @option{-mcpu=power9} is used or NO_REGS.
d5906efc 3132
b4fbcb1b
SL
3133@item wd
3134VSX vector register to hold vector double data or NO_REGS.
3135
dd551aa1 3136@item we
1610d410 3137VSX register if the @option{-mcpu=power9} and @option{-m64} options
d5906efc 3138were used or NO_REGS.
dd551aa1 3139
b4fbcb1b
SL
3140@item wf
3141VSX vector register to hold vector float data or NO_REGS.
3142
3143@item wg
3144If @option{-mmfpgpr} was used, a floating point register or NO_REGS.
3145
3146@item wh
3147Floating point register if direct moves are available, or NO_REGS.
3148
3149@item wi
3150FP or VSX register to hold 64-bit integers for VSX insns or NO_REGS.
3151
3152@item wj
3153FP or VSX register to hold 64-bit integers for direct moves or NO_REGS.
3154
3155@item wk
3156FP or VSX register to hold 64-bit doubles for direct moves or NO_REGS.
3157
3158@item wl
3159Floating point register if the LFIWAX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
3160
3161@item wm
3162VSX register if direct move instructions are enabled, or NO_REGS.
3163
3164@item wn
3165No register (NO_REGS).
3166
4e8a3a35
MM
3167@item wo
3168VSX register to use for ISA 3.0 vector instructions, or NO_REGS.
3169
c477a667
MM
3170@item wp
3171VSX register to use for IEEE 128-bit floating point TFmode, or NO_REGS.
3172
3173@item wq
3174VSX register to use for IEEE 128-bit floating point, or NO_REGS.
3175
b4fbcb1b
SL
3176@item wr
3177General purpose register if 64-bit instructions are enabled or NO_REGS.
3178
3179@item ws
3180VSX vector register to hold scalar double values or NO_REGS.
3181
3182@item wt
3183VSX vector register to hold 128 bit integer or NO_REGS.
3184
3185@item wu
3186Altivec register to use for float/32-bit int loads/stores or NO_REGS.
3187
3188@item wv
3189Altivec register to use for double loads/stores or NO_REGS.
3190
3191@item ww
3192FP or VSX register to perform float operations under @option{-mvsx} or NO_REGS.
3193
3194@item wx
3195Floating point register if the STFIWX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
3196
3197@item wy
3198FP or VSX register to perform ISA 2.07 float ops or NO_REGS.
3199
3200@item wz
3201Floating point register if the LFIWZX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
3202
99211352
AS
3203@item wA
3204Address base register if 64-bit instructions are enabled or NO_REGS.
3205
1a3c3ee9
MM
3206@item wB
3207Signed 5-bit constant integer that can be loaded into an altivec register.
3208
b4fbcb1b
SL
3209@item wD
3210Int constant that is the element number of the 64-bit scalar in a vector.
3211
50c78b9a
MM
3212@item wE
3213Vector constant that can be loaded with the XXSPLTIB instruction.
3214
dd551aa1
MM
3215@item wF
3216Memory operand suitable for power9 fusion load/stores.
3217
3218@item wG
3219Memory operand suitable for TOC fusion memory references.
3220
787c7a65
MM
3221@item wH
3222Altivec register if @option{-mvsx-small-integer}.
3223
3224@item wI
3225Floating point register if @option{-mvsx-small-integer}.
3226
3227@item wJ
3228FP register if @option{-mvsx-small-integer} and @option{-mpower9-vector}.
3229
3230@item wK
3231Altivec register if @option{-mvsx-small-integer} and @option{-mpower9-vector}.
3232
dd551aa1 3233@item wL
50c78b9a 3234Int constant that is the element number that the MFVSRLD instruction.
dd551aa1
MM
3235targets.
3236
50c78b9a
MM
3237@item wM
3238Match vector constant with all 1's if the XXLORC instruction is available.
3239
3fd2b007
MM
3240@item wO
3241A memory operand suitable for the ISA 3.0 vector d-form instructions.
3242
b4fbcb1b
SL
3243@item wQ
3244A memory address that will work with the @code{lq} and @code{stq}
3245instructions.
3246
50c78b9a
MM
3247@item wS
3248Vector constant that can be loaded with XXSPLTIB & sign extension.
3249
b4fbcb1b
SL
3250@item h
3251@samp{MQ}, @samp{CTR}, or @samp{LINK} register
3252
b4fbcb1b
SL
3253@item c
3254@samp{CTR} register
3255
3256@item l
3257@samp{LINK} register
3258
3259@item x
3260@samp{CR} register (condition register) number 0
3261
3262@item y
3263@samp{CR} register (condition register)
3264
3265@item z
3266@samp{XER[CA]} carry bit (part of the XER register)
3267
3268@item I
3269Signed 16-bit constant
3270
3271@item J
3272Unsigned 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits (use @samp{L} instead for
3273@code{SImode} constants)
3274
3275@item K
3276Unsigned 16-bit constant
3277
3278@item L
3279Signed 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits
3280
3281@item M
3282Constant larger than 31
3283
3284@item N
3285Exact power of 2
3286
3287@item O
3288Zero
3289
3290@item P
3291Constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit constant
3292
3293@item G
3294Floating point constant that can be loaded into a register with one
3295instruction per word
3296
3297@item H
3298Integer/Floating point constant that can be loaded into a register using
3299three instructions
3300
3301@item m
3302Memory operand.
3303Normally, @code{m} does not allow addresses that update the base register.
3304If @samp{<} or @samp{>} constraint is also used, they are allowed and
3305therefore on PowerPC targets in that case it is only safe
3306to use @samp{m<>} in an @code{asm} statement if that @code{asm} statement
3307accesses the operand exactly once. The @code{asm} statement must also
3308use @samp{%U@var{<opno>}} as a placeholder for the ``update'' flag in the
3309corresponding load or store instruction. For example:
3310
3311@smallexample
3312asm ("st%U0 %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3313@end smallexample
3314
3315is correct but:
3316
3317@smallexample
3318asm ("st %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3319@end smallexample
3320
3321is not.
3322
3323@item es
3324A ``stable'' memory operand; that is, one which does not include any
3325automodification of the base register. This used to be useful when
3326@samp{m} allowed automodification of the base register, but as those are now only
3327allowed when @samp{<} or @samp{>} is used, @samp{es} is basically the same
3328as @samp{m} without @samp{<} and @samp{>}.
3329
3330@item Q
3331Memory operand that is an offset from a register (it is usually better
3332to use @samp{m} or @samp{es} in @code{asm} statements)
3333
3334@item Z
3335Memory operand that is an indexed or indirect from a register (it is
3336usually better to use @samp{m} or @samp{es} in @code{asm} statements)
3337
3338@item R
3339AIX TOC entry
5e426dd4 3340
b4fbcb1b
SL
3341@item a
3342Address operand that is an indexed or indirect from a register (@samp{p} is
3343preferable for @code{asm} statements)
5e426dd4 3344
b4fbcb1b
SL
3345@item U
3346System V Release 4 small data area reference
5e426dd4 3347
b4fbcb1b
SL
3348@item W
3349Vector constant that does not require memory
5e426dd4 3350
b4fbcb1b
SL
3351@item j
3352Vector constant that is all zeros.
5e426dd4
PK
3353
3354@end table
3355
85b8555e
DD
3356@item RL78---@file{config/rl78/constraints.md}
3357@table @code
3358
3359@item Int3
3360An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 7.
3361@item Int8
3362An integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 255.
3363@item J
3364An integer constant in the range @minus{}255 @dots{} 0
3365@item K
3366The integer constant 1.
3367@item L
3368The integer constant -1.
3369@item M
3370The integer constant 0.
3371@item N
3372The integer constant 2.
3373@item O
3374The integer constant -2.
3375@item P
3376An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 15.
3377@item Qbi
3378The built-in compare types--eq, ne, gtu, ltu, geu, and leu.
3379@item Qsc
3380The synthetic compare types--gt, lt, ge, and le.
3381@item Wab
3382A memory reference with an absolute address.
3383@item Wbc
3384A memory reference using @code{BC} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3385@item Wca
3386A memory reference using @code{AX}, @code{BC}, @code{DE}, or @code{HL} for the address, for calls.
3387@item Wcv
3388A memory reference using any 16-bit register pair for the address, for calls.
3389@item Wd2
3390A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3391@item Wde
3392A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, without any offset.
3393@item Wfr
3394Any memory reference to an address in the far address space.
3395@item Wh1
3396A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3397@item Whb
3398A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with @code{B} or @code{C} as the index register.
3399@item Whl
3400A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, without any offset.
3401@item Ws1
3402A memory reference using @code{SP} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3403@item Y
3404Any memory reference to an address in the near address space.
3405@item A
3406The @code{AX} register.
3407@item B
3408The @code{BC} register.
3409@item D
3410The @code{DE} register.
3411@item R
3412@code{A} through @code{L} registers.
3413@item S
3414The @code{SP} register.
3415@item T
3416The @code{HL} register.
3417@item Z08W
3418The 16-bit @code{R8} register.
3419@item Z10W
3420The 16-bit @code{R10} register.
3421@item Zint
3422The registers reserved for interrupts (@code{R24} to @code{R31}).
3423@item a
3424The @code{A} register.
3425@item b
3426The @code{B} register.
3427@item c
3428The @code{C} register.
3429@item d
3430The @code{D} register.
3431@item e
3432The @code{E} register.
3433@item h
3434The @code{H} register.
3435@item l
3436The @code{L} register.
3437@item v
3438The virtual registers.
3439@item w
3440The @code{PSW} register.
3441@item x
3442The @code{X} register.
3443
3444@end table
09cae750
PD
3445
3446@item RISC-V---@file{config/riscv/constraints.md}
3447@table @code
3448
3449@item f
3450A floating-point register (if availiable).
3451
3452@item I
3453An I-type 12-bit signed immediate.
3454
3455@item J
3456Integer zero.
3457
3458@item K
3459A 5-bit unsigned immediate for CSR access instructions.
3460
3461@item A
3462An address that is held in a general-purpose register.
3463
3464@end table
85b8555e 3465
65a324b4
NC
3466@item RX---@file{config/rx/constraints.md}
3467@table @code
3468@item Q
3469An address which does not involve register indirect addressing or
3470pre/post increment/decrement addressing.
3471
3472@item Symbol
3473A symbol reference.
3474
3475@item Int08
3476A constant in the range @minus{}256 to 255, inclusive.
3477
3478@item Sint08
3479A constant in the range @minus{}128 to 127, inclusive.
3480
3481@item Sint16
3482A constant in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767, inclusive.
3483
3484@item Sint24
3485A constant in the range @minus{}8388608 to 8388607, inclusive.
3486
3487@item Uint04
3488A constant in the range 0 to 15, inclusive.
3489
3490@end table
3491
b4fbcb1b
SL
3492@item S/390 and zSeries---@file{config/s390/s390.h}
3493@table @code
3494@item a
3495Address register (general purpose register except r0)
3496
3497@item c
3498Condition code register
3499
3500@item d
3501Data register (arbitrary general purpose register)
3502
3503@item f
3504Floating-point register
3505
3506@item I
3507Unsigned 8-bit constant (0--255)
3508
3509@item J
3510Unsigned 12-bit constant (0--4095)
3511
3512@item K
3513Signed 16-bit constant (@minus{}32768--32767)
3514
3515@item L
3516Value appropriate as displacement.
3517@table @code
3518@item (0..4095)
3519for short displacement
3520@item (@minus{}524288..524287)
3521for long displacement
3522@end table
3523
3524@item M
3525Constant integer with a value of 0x7fffffff.
3526
3527@item N
3528Multiple letter constraint followed by 4 parameter letters.
3529@table @code
3530@item 0..9:
3531number of the part counting from most to least significant
3532@item H,Q:
3533mode of the part
3534@item D,S,H:
3535mode of the containing operand
3536@item 0,F:
3537value of the other parts (F---all bits set)
3538@end table
3539The constraint matches if the specified part of a constant
3540has a value different from its other parts.
3541
3542@item Q
3543Memory reference without index register and with short displacement.
3544
3545@item R
3546Memory reference with index register and short displacement.
3547
3548@item S
3549Memory reference without index register but with long displacement.
3550
3551@item T
3552Memory reference with index register and long displacement.
3553
3554@item U
3555Pointer with short displacement.
3556
3557@item W
3558Pointer with long displacement.
3559
3560@item Y
3561Shift count operand.
3562
3563@end table
3564
03dda8e3 3565@need 1000
74fe790b 3566@item SPARC---@file{config/sparc/sparc.h}
03dda8e3
RK
3567@table @code
3568@item f
53e5f173
EB
3569Floating-point register on the SPARC-V8 architecture and
3570lower floating-point register on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
03dda8e3
RK
3571
3572@item e
8a36672b 3573Floating-point register. It is equivalent to @samp{f} on the
53e5f173
EB
3574SPARC-V8 architecture and contains both lower and upper
3575floating-point registers on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
03dda8e3 3576
8a69f99f
EB
3577@item c
3578Floating-point condition code register.
3579
3580@item d
8a36672b 3581Lower floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9
53e5f173 3582architecture when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
8a69f99f
EB
3583
3584@item b
8a36672b 3585Floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9 architecture
53e5f173 3586when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
8a69f99f
EB
3587
3588@item h
358964-bit global or out register for the SPARC-V8+ architecture.
3590
923f9ded
DM
3591@item C
3592The constant all-ones, for floating-point.
3593
8b98b5fd
DM
3594@item A
3595Signed 5-bit constant
3596
66e62b49
KH
3597@item D
3598A vector constant
3599
03dda8e3 3600@item I
1e5f973d 3601Signed 13-bit constant
03dda8e3
RK
3602
3603@item J
3604Zero
3605
3606@item K
1e5f973d 360732-bit constant with the low 12 bits clear (a constant that can be
03dda8e3
RK
3608loaded with the @code{sethi} instruction)
3609
7d6040e8 3610@item L
923f9ded
DM
3611A constant in the range supported by @code{movcc} instructions (11-bit
3612signed immediate)
7d6040e8
AO
3613
3614@item M
923f9ded
DM
3615A constant in the range supported by @code{movrcc} instructions (10-bit
3616signed immediate)
7d6040e8
AO
3617
3618@item N
3619Same as @samp{K}, except that it verifies that bits that are not in the
57694e40 3620lower 32-bit range are all zero. Must be used instead of @samp{K} for
7d6040e8
AO
3621modes wider than @code{SImode}
3622
ef0139b1
EB
3623@item O
3624The constant 4096
3625
03dda8e3
RK
3626@item G
3627Floating-point zero
3628
3629@item H
1e5f973d 3630Signed 13-bit constant, sign-extended to 32 or 64 bits
03dda8e3 3631
923f9ded
DM
3632@item P
3633The constant -1
3634
03dda8e3 3635@item Q
62190128
DM
3636Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3637be moved into an integer register using a single sethi
3638instruction
3639
3640@item R
3641Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3642be moved into an integer register using a single mov
3643instruction
03dda8e3
RK
3644
3645@item S
62190128
DM
3646Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3647be moved into an integer register using a high/lo_sum
3648instruction sequence
03dda8e3
RK
3649
3650@item T
3651Memory address aligned to an 8-byte boundary
3652
aaa050aa
DM
3653@item U
3654Even register
3655
7a31a340 3656@item W
c75d6010
JM
3657Memory address for @samp{e} constraint registers
3658
923f9ded
DM
3659@item w
3660Memory address with only a base register
3661
c75d6010
JM
3662@item Y
3663Vector zero
7a31a340 3664
6ca30df6
MH
3665@end table
3666
85d9c13c
TS
3667@item SPU---@file{config/spu/spu.h}
3668@table @code
3669@item a
ff2ce160 3670An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
85d9c13c
TS
3671
3672@item c
ff2ce160 3673An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
85d9c13c
TS
3674
3675@item d
ff2ce160 3676An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
85d9c13c
TS
3677
3678@item f
ff2ce160 3679An immediate which can be loaded with @code{fsmbi}.
85d9c13c
TS
3680
3681@item A
ff2ce160 3682An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
85d9c13c 3683
b4fbcb1b
SL
3684@item B
3685An immediate for most arithmetic instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
9f339dde 3686
b4fbcb1b
SL
3687@item C
3688An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
9f339dde 3689
b4fbcb1b
SL
3690@item D
3691An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
9f339dde
GK
3692
3693@item I
b4fbcb1b 3694A constant in the range [@minus{}64, 63] for shift/rotate instructions.
9f339dde
GK
3695
3696@item J
b4fbcb1b 3697An unsigned 7-bit constant for conversion/nop/channel instructions.
9f339dde
GK
3698
3699@item K
b4fbcb1b 3700A signed 10-bit constant for most arithmetic instructions.
9f339dde
GK
3701
3702@item M
b4fbcb1b 3703A signed 16 bit immediate for @code{stop}.
9f339dde
GK
3704
3705@item N
b4fbcb1b 3706An unsigned 16-bit constant for @code{iohl} and @code{fsmbi}.
9f339dde
GK
3707
3708@item O
b4fbcb1b 3709An unsigned 7-bit constant whose 3 least significant bits are 0.
9f339dde
GK
3710
3711@item P
b4fbcb1b 3712An unsigned 3-bit constant for 16-byte rotates and shifts
9f339dde
GK
3713
3714@item R
b4fbcb1b 3715Call operand, reg, for indirect calls
9f339dde
GK
3716
3717@item S
b4fbcb1b 3718Call operand, symbol, for relative calls.
9f339dde
GK
3719
3720@item T
b4fbcb1b 3721Call operand, const_int, for absolute calls.
9f339dde
GK
3722
3723@item U
b4fbcb1b
SL
3724An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is sign extended to 128 bit.
3725
3726@item W
3727An immediate for shift and rotate instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3728
3729@item Y
3730An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is sign extended as a 128 bit.
9f339dde 3731
e2ce66a9 3732@item Z
b4fbcb1b 3733An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is sign extended to 128 bit.
e2ce66a9 3734
9f339dde
GK
3735@end table
3736
bcead286
BS
3737@item TI C6X family---@file{config/c6x/constraints.md}
3738@table @code
3739@item a
3740Register file A (A0--A31).
3741
3742@item b
3743Register file B (B0--B31).
3744
3745@item A
3746Predicate registers in register file A (A0--A2 on C64X and
3747higher, A1 and A2 otherwise).
3748
3749@item B
3750Predicate registers in register file B (B0--B2).
3751
3752@item C
3753A call-used register in register file B (B0--B9, B16--B31).
3754
3755@item Da
3756Register file A, excluding predicate registers (A3--A31,
3757plus A0 if not C64X or higher).
3758
3759@item Db
3760Register file B, excluding predicate registers (B3--B31).
3761
3762@item Iu4
3763Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 15.
3764
3765@item Iu5
3766Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31.
3767
3768@item In5
3769Integer constant in the range @minus{}31 @dots{} 0.
3770
3771@item Is5
3772Integer constant in the range @minus{}16 @dots{} 15.
3773
3774@item I5x
3775Integer constant that can be the operand of an ADDA or a SUBA insn.
3776
3777@item IuB
3778Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 65535.
3779
3780@item IsB
3781Integer constant in the range @minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767.
3782
3783@item IsC
3784Integer constant in the range @math{-2^{20}} @dots{} @math{2^{20} - 1}.
3785
3786@item Jc
3787Integer constant that is a valid mask for the clr instruction.
3788
3789@item Js
3790Integer constant that is a valid mask for the set instruction.
3791
3792@item Q
3793Memory location with A base register.
3794
3795@item R
3796Memory location with B base register.
3797
3798@ifset INTERNALS
3799@item S0
3800On C64x+ targets, a GP-relative small data reference.
3801
3802@item S1
3803Any kind of @code{SYMBOL_REF}, for use in a call address.
3804
3805@item Si
3806Any kind of immediate operand, unless it matches the S0 constraint.
3807
3808@item T
3809Memory location with B base register, but not using a long offset.
3810
3811@item W
fd250f0d 3812A memory operand with an address that cannot be used in an unaligned access.
bcead286
BS
3813
3814@end ifset
3815@item Z
3816Register B14 (aka DP).
3817
3818@end table
3819
dd552284
WL
3820@item TILE-Gx---@file{config/tilegx/constraints.md}
3821@table @code
3822@item R00
3823@itemx R01
3824@itemx R02
3825@itemx R03
3826@itemx R04
3827@itemx R05
3828@itemx R06
3829@itemx R07
3830@itemx R08
3831@itemx R09
655c5444 3832@itemx R10
dd552284
WL
3833Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
3834register, from r0 to r10.
3835
3836@item I
3837Signed 8-bit integer constant.
3838
3839@item J
3840Signed 16-bit integer constant.
3841
3842@item K
3843Unsigned 16-bit integer constant.
3844
3845@item L
3846Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
3847(@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
3848
3849@item m
3850Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
3851operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
3852and @samp{%in} on TILE-Gx. For example:
3853
3854@smallexample
3855asm ("st_add %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (*mem) : "r" (val));
3856@end smallexample
3857
3858@item M
3859A bit mask suitable for the BFINS instruction.
3860
3861@item N
3862Integer constant that is a byte tiled out eight times.
3863
3864@item O
3865The integer zero constant.
3866
3867@item P
3868Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as four shorts.
3869
3870@item Q
3871Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
3872(@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
3873
3874@item S
3875Integer constant that has all 1 bits consecutive and starting at bit 0.
3876
3877@item T
3878A 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative reference.
3879
3880@item U
3881Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
3882@samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
3883
3884@item W
3885An 8-element vector constant with identical elements.
3886
3887@item Y
3888A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
3889
3890@item Z0
3891The integer constant 0xffffffff.
3892
3893@item Z1
3894The integer constant 0xffffffff00000000.
3895
3896@end table
3897
3898@item TILEPro---@file{config/tilepro/constraints.md}
3899@table @code
3900@item R00
3901@itemx R01
3902@itemx R02
3903@itemx R03
3904@itemx R04
3905@itemx R05
3906@itemx R06
3907@itemx R07
3908@itemx R08
3909@itemx R09
655c5444 3910@itemx R10
dd552284
WL
3911Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
3912register, from r0 to r10.
3913
3914@item I
3915Signed 8-bit integer constant.
3916
3917@item J
3918Signed 16-bit integer constant.
3919
3920@item K
3921Nonzero integer constant with low 16 bits zero.
3922
3923@item L
3924Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
3925(@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
3926
3927@item m
3928Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
3929operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
3930and @samp{%in} on TILEPro. For example:
3931
3932@smallexample
3933asm ("swadd %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3934@end smallexample
3935
3936@item M
3937A bit mask suitable for the MM instruction.
3938
3939@item N
3940Integer constant that is a byte tiled out four times.
3941
3942@item O
3943The integer zero constant.
3944
3945@item P
3946Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as two shorts.
3947
3948@item Q
3949Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
3950(@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
3951
3952@item T
3953A symbolic operand, or a 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative
3954reference.
3955
3956@item U
3957Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
3958@samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
3959
3960@item W
3961A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
3962
3963@item Y
3964A 2-element vector constant with identical elements.
3965
3966@end table
3967
0969ec7d
EB
3968@item Visium---@file{config/visium/constraints.md}
3969@table @code
3970@item b
3971EAM register @code{mdb}
3972
3973@item c
3974EAM register @code{mdc}
3975
3976@item f
3977Floating point register
3978
3979@ifset INTERNALS
3980@item k
3981Register for sibcall optimization
3982@end ifset
3983
3984@item l
3985General register, but not @code{r29}, @code{r30} and @code{r31}
3986
3987@item t
3988Register @code{r1}
3989
3990@item u
3991Register @code{r2}
3992
3993@item v
3994Register @code{r3}
3995
3996@item G
3997Floating-point constant 0.0
3998
3999@item J
4000Integer constant in the range 0 .. 65535 (16-bit immediate)
4001
4002@item K
4003Integer constant in the range 1 .. 31 (5-bit immediate)
4004
4005@item L
4006Integer constant in the range @minus{}65535 .. @minus{}1 (16-bit negative immediate)
4007
4008@item M
4009Integer constant @minus{}1
4010
4011@item O
4012Integer constant 0
4013
4014@item P
4015Integer constant 32
4016@end table
4017
b4fbcb1b
SL
4018@item x86 family---@file{config/i386/constraints.md}
4019@table @code
4020@item R
4021Legacy register---the eight integer registers available on all
4022i386 processors (@code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d},
4023@code{si}, @code{di}, @code{bp}, @code{sp}).
4024
4025@item q
4026Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}l}. In 32-bit mode, @code{a},
4027@code{b}, @code{c}, and @code{d}; in 64-bit mode, any integer register.
4028
4029@item Q
4030Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}h}: @code{a}, @code{b},
4031@code{c}, and @code{d}.
4032
4033@ifset INTERNALS
4034@item l
4035Any register that can be used as the index in a base+index memory
4036access: that is, any general register except the stack pointer.
4037@end ifset
4038
4039@item a
4040The @code{a} register.
4041
4042@item b
4043The @code{b} register.
4044
4045@item c
4046The @code{c} register.
4047
4048@item d
4049The @code{d} register.
4050
4051@item S
4052The @code{si} register.
4053
4054@item D
4055The @code{di} register.
4056
4057@item A
4058The @code{a} and @code{d} registers. This class is used for instructions
4059that return double word results in the @code{ax:dx} register pair. Single
4060word values will be allocated either in @code{ax} or @code{dx}.
4061For example on i386 the following implements @code{rdtsc}:
4062
4063@smallexample
4064unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
4065@{
4066 unsigned long long tick;
4067 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=A"(tick));
4068 return tick;
4069@}
4070@end smallexample
4071
4072This is not correct on x86-64 as it would allocate tick in either @code{ax}
4073or @code{dx}. You have to use the following variant instead:
4074
4075@smallexample
4076unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
4077@{
4078 unsigned int tickl, tickh;
4079 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=a"(tickl),"=d"(tickh));
4080 return ((unsigned long long)tickh << 32)|tickl;
4081@}
4082@end smallexample
4083
de3fb1a6
SP
4084@item U
4085The call-clobbered integer registers.
b4fbcb1b
SL
4086
4087@item f
4088Any 80387 floating-point (stack) register.
4089
4090@item t
4091Top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(0)}).
4092
4093@item u
4094Second from top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(1)}).
4095
de3fb1a6
SP
4096@ifset INTERNALS
4097@item Yk
4098Any mask register that can be used as a predicate, i.e. @code{k1-k7}.
4099
4100@item k
4101Any mask register.
4102@end ifset
4103
b4fbcb1b
SL
4104@item y
4105Any MMX register.
4106
4107@item x
4108Any SSE register.
4109
de3fb1a6
SP
4110@item v
4111Any EVEX encodable SSE register (@code{%xmm0-%xmm31}).
4112
4113@ifset INTERNALS
4114@item w
4115Any bound register.
4116@end ifset
4117
b4fbcb1b
SL
4118@item Yz
4119First SSE register (@code{%xmm0}).
4120
4121@ifset INTERNALS
b4fbcb1b
SL
4122@item Yi
4123Any SSE register, when SSE2 and inter-unit moves are enabled.
4124
de3fb1a6
SP
4125@item Yj
4126Any SSE register, when SSE2 and inter-unit moves from vector registers are enabled.
4127
b4fbcb1b
SL
4128@item Ym
4129Any MMX register, when inter-unit moves are enabled.
de3fb1a6
SP
4130
4131@item Yn
4132Any MMX register, when inter-unit moves from vector registers are enabled.
4133
4134@item Yp
4135Any integer register when @code{TARGET_PARTIAL_REG_STALL} is disabled.
4136
4137@item Ya
4138Any integer register when zero extensions with @code{AND} are disabled.
4139
4140@item Yb
4141Any register that can be used as the GOT base when calling@*
4142@code{___tls_get_addr}: that is, any general register except @code{a}
4143and @code{sp} registers, for @option{-fno-plt} if linker supports it.
4144Otherwise, @code{b} register.
4145
4146@item Yf
4147Any x87 register when 80387 floating-point arithmetic is enabled.
4148
4149@item Yr
4150Lower SSE register when avoiding REX prefix and all SSE registers otherwise.
4151
4152@item Yv
4153For AVX512VL, any EVEX-encodable SSE register (@code{%xmm0-%xmm31}),
4154otherwise any SSE register.
4155
4156@item Yh
4157Any EVEX-encodable SSE register, that has number factor of four.
4158
4159@item Bf
4160Flags register operand.
4161
4162@item Bg
4163GOT memory operand.
4164
4165@item Bm
4166Vector memory operand.
4167
4168@item Bc
4169Constant memory operand.
4170
4171@item Bn
4172Memory operand without REX prefix.
4173
4174@item Bs
4175Sibcall memory operand.
4176
4177@item Bw
4178Call memory operand.
4179
4180@item Bz
4181Constant call address operand.
4182
4183@item BC
4184SSE constant -1 operand.
b4fbcb1b
SL
4185@end ifset
4186
4187@item I
4188Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31, for 32-bit shifts.
4189
4190@item J
4191Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 63, for 64-bit shifts.
4192
4193@item K
4194Signed 8-bit integer constant.
4195
4196@item L
4197@code{0xFF} or @code{0xFFFF}, for andsi as a zero-extending move.
4198
4199@item M
42000, 1, 2, or 3 (shifts for the @code{lea} instruction).
4201
4202@item N
4203Unsigned 8-bit integer constant (for @code{in} and @code{out}
4204instructions).
4205
4206@ifset INTERNALS
4207@item O
4208Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 127, for 128-bit shifts.
4209@end ifset
4210
4211@item G
4212Standard 80387 floating point constant.
4213
4214@item C
aec0b19e 4215SSE constant zero operand.
b4fbcb1b
SL
4216
4217@item e
421832-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4219to fit that range (for immediate operands in sign-extending x86-64
4220instructions).
4221
de3fb1a6
SP
4222@item We
422332-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4224to fit that range (for sign-extending conversion operations that
4225require non-@code{VOIDmode} immediate operands).
4226
4227@item Wz
422832-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4229to fit that range (for zero-extending conversion operations that
4230require non-@code{VOIDmode} immediate operands).
4231
4232@item Wd
4233128-bit integer constant where both the high and low 64-bit word
4234satisfy the @code{e} constraint.
4235
b4fbcb1b
SL
4236@item Z
423732-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4238to fit that range (for immediate operands in zero-extending x86-64
4239instructions).
4240
de3fb1a6
SP
4241@item Tv
4242VSIB address operand.
4243
4244@item Ts
4245Address operand without segment register.
4246
b4fbcb1b
SL
4247@end table
4248
4249@item Xstormy16---@file{config/stormy16/stormy16.h}
4250@table @code
4251@item a
4252Register r0.
4253
4254@item b
4255Register r1.
4256
4257@item c
4258Register r2.
4259
4260@item d
4261Register r8.
4262
4263@item e
4264Registers r0 through r7.
4265
4266@item t
4267Registers r0 and r1.
4268
4269@item y
4270The carry register.
4271
4272@item z
4273Registers r8 and r9.
4274
4275@item I
4276A constant between 0 and 3 inclusive.
4277
4278@item J
4279A constant that has exactly one bit set.
4280
4281@item K
4282A constant that has exactly one bit clear.
4283
4284@item L
4285A constant between 0 and 255 inclusive.
4286
4287@item M
4288A constant between @minus{}255 and 0 inclusive.
4289
4290@item N
4291A constant between @minus{}3 and 0 inclusive.
4292
4293@item O
4294A constant between 1 and 4 inclusive.
4295
4296@item P
4297A constant between @minus{}4 and @minus{}1 inclusive.
4298
4299@item Q
4300A memory reference that is a stack push.
4301
4302@item R
4303A memory reference that is a stack pop.
4304
4305@item S
4306A memory reference that refers to a constant address of known value.
4307
4308@item T
4309The register indicated by Rx (not implemented yet).
4310
4311@item U
4312A constant that is not between 2 and 15 inclusive.
4313
4314@item Z
4315The constant 0.
4316
4317@end table
4318
887af464 4319@item Xtensa---@file{config/xtensa/constraints.md}
03984308
BW
4320@table @code
4321@item a
4322General-purpose 32-bit register
4323
4324@item b
4325One-bit boolean register
4326
4327@item A
4328MAC16 40-bit accumulator register
4329
4330@item I
4331Signed 12-bit integer constant, for use in MOVI instructions
4332
4333@item J
4334Signed 8-bit integer constant, for use in ADDI instructions
4335
4336@item K
4337Integer constant valid for BccI instructions
4338
4339@item L
4340Unsigned constant valid for BccUI instructions
4341
4342@end table
4343
03dda8e3
RK
4344@end table
4345
7ac28727
AK
4346@ifset INTERNALS
4347@node Disable Insn Alternatives
4348@subsection Disable insn alternatives using the @code{enabled} attribute
4349@cindex enabled
4350
9840b2fa
RS
4351There are three insn attributes that may be used to selectively disable
4352instruction alternatives:
7ac28727 4353
9840b2fa
RS
4354@table @code
4355@item enabled
4356Says whether an alternative is available on the current subtarget.
7ac28727 4357
9840b2fa
RS
4358@item preferred_for_size
4359Says whether an enabled alternative should be used in code that is
4360optimized for size.
7ac28727 4361
9840b2fa
RS
4362@item preferred_for_speed
4363Says whether an enabled alternative should be used in code that is
4364optimized for speed.
4365@end table
4366
4367All these attributes should use @code{(const_int 1)} to allow an alternative
4368or @code{(const_int 0)} to disallow it. The attributes must be a static
4369property of the subtarget; they cannot for example depend on the
4370current operands, on the current optimization level, on the location
4371of the insn within the body of a loop, on whether register allocation
4372has finished, or on the current compiler pass.
4373
4374The @code{enabled} attribute is a correctness property. It tells GCC to act
4375as though the disabled alternatives were never defined in the first place.
4376This is useful when adding new instructions to an existing pattern in
4377cases where the new instructions are only available for certain cpu
4378architecture levels (typically mapped to the @code{-march=} command-line
4379option).
4380
4381In contrast, the @code{preferred_for_size} and @code{preferred_for_speed}
4382attributes are strong optimization hints rather than correctness properties.
4383@code{preferred_for_size} tells GCC which alternatives to consider when
4384adding or modifying an instruction that GCC wants to optimize for size.
4385@code{preferred_for_speed} does the same thing for speed. Note that things
4386like code motion can lead to cases where code optimized for size uses
4387alternatives that are not preferred for size, and similarly for speed.
4388
4389Although @code{define_insn}s can in principle specify the @code{enabled}
4390attribute directly, it is often clearer to have subsiduary attributes
4391for each architectural feature of interest. The @code{define_insn}s
4392can then use these subsiduary attributes to say which alternatives
4393require which features. The example below does this for @code{cpu_facility}.
7ac28727
AK
4394
4395E.g. the following two patterns could easily be merged using the @code{enabled}
4396attribute:
4397
4398@smallexample
4399
4400(define_insn "*movdi_old"
4401 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
4402 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d"))]
4403 "!TARGET_NEW"
4404 "lgr %0,%1")
4405
4406(define_insn "*movdi_new"
4407 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4408 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4409 "TARGET_NEW"
4410 "@@
4411 lgr %0,%1
4412 ldgr %0,%1
4413 lgdr %0,%1")
4414
4415@end smallexample
4416
4417to:
4418
4419@smallexample
4420
4421(define_insn "*movdi_combined"
4422 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4423 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4424 ""
4425 "@@
4426 lgr %0,%1
4427 ldgr %0,%1
4428 lgdr %0,%1"
4429 [(set_attr "cpu_facility" "*,new,new")])
4430
4431@end smallexample
4432
4433with the @code{enabled} attribute defined like this:
4434
4435@smallexample
4436
4437(define_attr "cpu_facility" "standard,new" (const_string "standard"))
4438
4439(define_attr "enabled" ""
4440 (cond [(eq_attr "cpu_facility" "standard") (const_int 1)
4441 (and (eq_attr "cpu_facility" "new")
4442 (ne (symbol_ref "TARGET_NEW") (const_int 0)))
4443 (const_int 1)]
4444 (const_int 0)))
4445
4446@end smallexample
4447
4448@end ifset
4449
03dda8e3 4450@ifset INTERNALS
f38840db
ZW
4451@node Define Constraints
4452@subsection Defining Machine-Specific Constraints
4453@cindex defining constraints
4454@cindex constraints, defining
4455
4456Machine-specific constraints fall into two categories: register and
4457non-register constraints. Within the latter category, constraints
4458which allow subsets of all possible memory or address operands should
4459be specially marked, to give @code{reload} more information.
4460
4461Machine-specific constraints can be given names of arbitrary length,
4462but they must be entirely composed of letters, digits, underscores
4463(@samp{_}), and angle brackets (@samp{< >}). Like C identifiers, they
ff2ce160 4464must begin with a letter or underscore.
f38840db
ZW
4465
4466In order to avoid ambiguity in operand constraint strings, no
4467constraint can have a name that begins with any other constraint's
4468name. For example, if @code{x} is defined as a constraint name,
4469@code{xy} may not be, and vice versa. As a consequence of this rule,
4470no constraint may begin with one of the generic constraint letters:
4471@samp{E F V X g i m n o p r s}.
4472
4473Register constraints correspond directly to register classes.
4474@xref{Register Classes}. There is thus not much flexibility in their
4475definitions.
4476
4477@deffn {MD Expression} define_register_constraint name regclass docstring
4478All three arguments are string constants.
4479@var{name} is the name of the constraint, as it will appear in
5be527d0
RG
4480@code{match_operand} expressions. If @var{name} is a multi-letter
4481constraint its length shall be the same for all constraints starting
4482with the same letter. @var{regclass} can be either the
f38840db
ZW
4483name of the corresponding register class (@pxref{Register Classes}),
4484or a C expression which evaluates to the appropriate register class.
4485If it is an expression, it must have no side effects, and it cannot
4486look at the operand. The usual use of expressions is to map some
4487register constraints to @code{NO_REGS} when the register class
4488is not available on a given subarchitecture.
4489
4490@var{docstring} is a sentence documenting the meaning of the
4491constraint. Docstrings are explained further below.
4492@end deffn
4493
4494Non-register constraints are more like predicates: the constraint
527a3750 4495definition gives a boolean expression which indicates whether the
f38840db
ZW
4496constraint matches.
4497
4498@deffn {MD Expression} define_constraint name docstring exp
4499The @var{name} and @var{docstring} arguments are the same as for
4500@code{define_register_constraint}, but note that the docstring comes
4501immediately after the name for these expressions. @var{exp} is an RTL
4502expression, obeying the same rules as the RTL expressions in predicate
4503definitions. @xref{Defining Predicates}, for details. If it
4504evaluates true, the constraint matches; if it evaluates false, it
4505doesn't. Constraint expressions should indicate which RTL codes they
4506might match, just like predicate expressions.
4507
4508@code{match_test} C expressions have access to the
4509following variables:
4510
4511@table @var
4512@item op
4513The RTL object defining the operand.
4514@item mode
4515The machine mode of @var{op}.
4516@item ival
4517@samp{INTVAL (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a @code{const_int}.
4518@item hval
4519@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4520@code{const_double}.
4521@item lval
4522@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4523@code{const_double}.
4524@item rval
4525@samp{CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a floating-point
3fa1b0e5 4526@code{const_double}.
f38840db
ZW
4527@end table
4528
4529The @var{*val} variables should only be used once another piece of the
4530expression has verified that @var{op} is the appropriate kind of RTL
4531object.
4532@end deffn
4533
4534Most non-register constraints should be defined with
4535@code{define_constraint}. The remaining two definition expressions
4536are only appropriate for constraints that should be handled specially
4537by @code{reload} if they fail to match.
4538
4539@deffn {MD Expression} define_memory_constraint name docstring exp
4540Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
4541operands: that is, @code{reload} can make them match by converting the
4542operand to the form @samp{@w{(mem (reg @var{X}))}}, where @var{X} is a
4543base register (from the register class specified by
4544@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}, @pxref{Register Classes}).
4545
4546For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
4547memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
4548register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined to represent a
4549memory address of this type. If @samp{Q} is defined with
4550@code{define_memory_constraint}, a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any
4551memory operand, because @code{reload} knows it can simply copy the
4552memory address into a base register if required. This is analogous to
e4ae5e77 4553the way an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
f38840db
ZW
4554
4555The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4556@code{define_constraint}.
4557@end deffn
4558
9eb1ca69
VM
4559@deffn {MD Expression} define_special_memory_constraint name docstring exp
4560Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
4561operands: that is, @code{reload} can not make them match by reloading
4562the address as it is described for @code{define_memory_constraint} or
4563such address reload is undesirable with the performance point of view.
4564
4565For example, @code{define_special_memory_constraint} can be useful if
4566specifically aligned memory is necessary or desirable for some insn
4567operand.
4568
4569The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4570@code{define_constraint}.
4571@end deffn
4572
f38840db
ZW
4573@deffn {MD Expression} define_address_constraint name docstring exp
4574Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all address
4575operands: that is, @code{reload} can make the constraint match by
4576converting the operand to the form @samp{@w{(reg @var{X})}}, again
4577with @var{X} a base register.
4578
4579Constraints defined with @code{define_address_constraint} can only be
4580used with the @code{address_operand} predicate, or machine-specific
4581predicates that work the same way. They are treated analogously to
4582the generic @samp{p} constraint.
4583
4584The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4585@code{define_constraint}.
4586@end deffn
4587
4588For historical reasons, names beginning with the letters @samp{G H}
4589are reserved for constraints that match only @code{const_double}s, and
4590names beginning with the letters @samp{I J K L M N O P} are reserved
4591for constraints that match only @code{const_int}s. This may change in
4592the future. For the time being, constraints with these names must be
4593written in a stylized form, so that @code{genpreds} can tell you did
4594it correctly:
4595
4596@smallexample
4597@group
4598(define_constraint "[@var{GHIJKLMNOP}]@dots{}"
4599 "@var{doc}@dots{}"
4600 (and (match_code "const_int") ; @r{@code{const_double} for G/H}
4601 @var{condition}@dots{})) ; @r{usually a @code{match_test}}
4602@end group
4603@end smallexample
4604@c the semicolons line up in the formatted manual
4605
4606It is fine to use names beginning with other letters for constraints
4607that match @code{const_double}s or @code{const_int}s.
4608
4609Each docstring in a constraint definition should be one or more complete
4610sentences, marked up in Texinfo format. @emph{They are currently unused.}
4611In the future they will be copied into the GCC manual, in @ref{Machine
4612Constraints}, replacing the hand-maintained tables currently found in
4613that section. Also, in the future the compiler may use this to give
4614more helpful diagnostics when poor choice of @code{asm} constraints
4615causes a reload failure.
4616
4617If you put the pseudo-Texinfo directive @samp{@@internal} at the
4618beginning of a docstring, then (in the future) it will appear only in
4619the internals manual's version of the machine-specific constraint tables.
4620Use this for constraints that should not appear in @code{asm} statements.
4621
4622@node C Constraint Interface
4623@subsection Testing constraints from C
4624@cindex testing constraints
4625@cindex constraints, testing
4626
4627It is occasionally useful to test a constraint from C code rather than
4628implicitly via the constraint string in a @code{match_operand}. The
4629generated file @file{tm_p.h} declares a few interfaces for working
8677664e
RS
4630with constraints. At present these are defined for all constraints
4631except @code{g} (which is equivalent to @code{general_operand}).
f38840db
ZW
4632
4633Some valid constraint names are not valid C identifiers, so there is a
4634mangling scheme for referring to them from C@. Constraint names that
4635do not contain angle brackets or underscores are left unchanged.
4636Underscores are doubled, each @samp{<} is replaced with @samp{_l}, and
4637each @samp{>} with @samp{_g}. Here are some examples:
4638
4639@c the @c's prevent double blank lines in the printed manual.
4640@example
4641@multitable {Original} {Mangled}
cccb0908 4642@item @strong{Original} @tab @strong{Mangled} @c
f38840db
ZW
4643@item @code{x} @tab @code{x} @c
4644@item @code{P42x} @tab @code{P42x} @c
4645@item @code{P4_x} @tab @code{P4__x} @c
4646@item @code{P4>x} @tab @code{P4_gx} @c
4647@item @code{P4>>} @tab @code{P4_g_g} @c
4648@item @code{P4_g>} @tab @code{P4__g_g} @c
4649@end multitable
4650@end example
4651
4652Throughout this section, the variable @var{c} is either a constraint
4653in the abstract sense, or a constant from @code{enum constraint_num};
4654the variable @var{m} is a mangled constraint name (usually as part of
4655a larger identifier).
4656
4657@deftp Enum constraint_num
8677664e 4658For each constraint except @code{g}, there is a corresponding
f38840db
ZW
4659enumeration constant: @samp{CONSTRAINT_} plus the mangled name of the
4660constraint. Functions that take an @code{enum constraint_num} as an
4661argument expect one of these constants.
f38840db
ZW
4662@end deftp
4663
4664@deftypefun {inline bool} satisfies_constraint_@var{m} (rtx @var{exp})
8677664e 4665For each non-register constraint @var{m} except @code{g}, there is
f38840db
ZW
4666one of these functions; it returns @code{true} if @var{exp} satisfies the
4667constraint. These functions are only visible if @file{rtl.h} was included
4668before @file{tm_p.h}.
4669@end deftypefun
4670
4671@deftypefun bool constraint_satisfied_p (rtx @var{exp}, enum constraint_num @var{c})
4672Like the @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}} functions, but the
4673constraint to test is given as an argument, @var{c}. If @var{c}
4674specifies a register constraint, this function will always return
4675@code{false}.
4676@end deftypefun
4677
2aeedf58 4678@deftypefun {enum reg_class} reg_class_for_constraint (enum constraint_num @var{c})
f38840db
ZW
4679Returns the register class associated with @var{c}. If @var{c} is not
4680a register constraint, or those registers are not available for the
4681currently selected subtarget, returns @code{NO_REGS}.
4682@end deftypefun
4683
4684Here is an example use of @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}}. In
4685peephole optimizations (@pxref{Peephole Definitions}), operand
4686constraint strings are ignored, so if there are relevant constraints,
4687they must be tested in the C condition. In the example, the
4688optimization is applied if operand 2 does @emph{not} satisfy the
4689@samp{K} constraint. (This is a simplified version of a peephole
4690definition from the i386 machine description.)
4691
4692@smallexample
4693(define_peephole2
4694 [(match_scratch:SI 3 "r")
4695 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
6ccde948
RW
4696 (mult:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")
4697 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "")))]
f38840db
ZW
4698
4699 "!satisfies_constraint_K (operands[2])"
4700
4701 [(set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 1))
4702 (set (match_dup 0) (mult:SI (match_dup 3) (match_dup 2)))]
4703
4704 "")
4705@end smallexample
4706
03dda8e3
RK
4707@node Standard Names
4708@section Standard Pattern Names For Generation
4709@cindex standard pattern names
4710@cindex pattern names
4711@cindex names, pattern
4712
4713Here is a table of the instruction names that are meaningful in the RTL
4714generation pass of the compiler. Giving one of these names to an
4715instruction pattern tells the RTL generation pass that it can use the
556e0f21 4716pattern to accomplish a certain task.
03dda8e3
RK
4717
4718@table @asis
4719@cindex @code{mov@var{m}} instruction pattern
4720@item @samp{mov@var{m}}
4bd0bee9 4721Here @var{m} stands for a two-letter machine mode name, in lowercase.
03dda8e3
RK
4722This instruction pattern moves data with that machine mode from operand
47231 to operand 0. For example, @samp{movsi} moves full-word data.
4724
4725If operand 0 is a @code{subreg} with mode @var{m} of a register whose
4726own mode is wider than @var{m}, the effect of this instruction is
4727to store the specified value in the part of the register that corresponds
8feb4e28
JL
4728to mode @var{m}. Bits outside of @var{m}, but which are within the
4729same target word as the @code{subreg} are undefined. Bits which are
4730outside the target word are left unchanged.
03dda8e3
RK
4731
4732This class of patterns is special in several ways. First of all, each
65945ec1
HPN
4733of these names up to and including full word size @emph{must} be defined,
4734because there is no other way to copy a datum from one place to another.
4735If there are patterns accepting operands in larger modes,
4736@samp{mov@var{m}} must be defined for integer modes of those sizes.
03dda8e3
RK
4737
4738Second, these patterns are not used solely in the RTL generation pass.
4739Even the reload pass can generate move insns to copy values from stack
4740slots into temporary registers. When it does so, one of the operands is
4741a hard register and the other is an operand that can need to be reloaded
4742into a register.
4743
4744@findex force_reg
4745Therefore, when given such a pair of operands, the pattern must generate
4746RTL which needs no reloading and needs no temporary registers---no
4747registers other than the operands. For example, if you support the
4748pattern with a @code{define_expand}, then in such a case the
4749@code{define_expand} mustn't call @code{force_reg} or any other such
4750function which might generate new pseudo registers.
4751
4752This requirement exists even for subword modes on a RISC machine where
4753fetching those modes from memory normally requires several insns and
39ed8974 4754some temporary registers.
03dda8e3
RK
4755
4756@findex change_address
4757During reload a memory reference with an invalid address may be passed
4758as an operand. Such an address will be replaced with a valid address
4759later in the reload pass. In this case, nothing may be done with the
4760address except to use it as it stands. If it is copied, it will not be
4761replaced with a valid address. No attempt should be made to make such
4762an address into a valid address and no routine (such as
4763@code{change_address}) that will do so may be called. Note that
4764@code{general_operand} will fail when applied to such an address.
4765
4766@findex reload_in_progress
4767The global variable @code{reload_in_progress} (which must be explicitly
4768declared if required) can be used to determine whether such special
4769handling is required.
4770
4771The variety of operands that have reloads depends on the rest of the
4772machine description, but typically on a RISC machine these can only be
4773pseudo registers that did not get hard registers, while on other
4774machines explicit memory references will get optional reloads.
4775
4776If a scratch register is required to move an object to or from memory,
f1db3576
JL
4777it can be allocated using @code{gen_reg_rtx} prior to life analysis.
4778
9c34dbbf 4779If there are cases which need scratch registers during or after reload,
8a99f6f9 4780you must provide an appropriate secondary_reload target hook.
03dda8e3 4781
ef4375b2
KZ
4782@findex can_create_pseudo_p
4783The macro @code{can_create_pseudo_p} can be used to determine if it
f1db3576
JL
4784is unsafe to create new pseudo registers. If this variable is nonzero, then
4785it is unsafe to call @code{gen_reg_rtx} to allocate a new pseudo.
4786
956d6950 4787The constraints on a @samp{mov@var{m}} must permit moving any hard
03dda8e3 4788register to any other hard register provided that
f939c3e6 4789@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} permits mode @var{m} in both registers and
de8f4b07
AS
4790@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their classes returns a value
4791of 2.
03dda8e3 4792
956d6950 4793It is obligatory to support floating point @samp{mov@var{m}}
03dda8e3
RK
4794instructions into and out of any registers that can hold fixed point
4795values, because unions and structures (which have modes @code{SImode} or
4796@code{DImode}) can be in those registers and they may have floating
4797point members.
4798
956d6950 4799There may also be a need to support fixed point @samp{mov@var{m}}
03dda8e3
RK
4800instructions in and out of floating point registers. Unfortunately, I
4801have forgotten why this was so, and I don't know whether it is still
f939c3e6 4802true. If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} rejects fixed point values in
03dda8e3 4803floating point registers, then the constraints of the fixed point
956d6950 4804@samp{mov@var{m}} instructions must be designed to avoid ever trying to
03dda8e3
RK
4805reload into a floating point register.
4806
4807@cindex @code{reload_in} instruction pattern
4808@cindex @code{reload_out} instruction pattern
4809@item @samp{reload_in@var{m}}
4810@itemx @samp{reload_out@var{m}}
8a99f6f9
R
4811These named patterns have been obsoleted by the target hook
4812@code{secondary_reload}.
4813
03dda8e3
RK
4814Like @samp{mov@var{m}}, but used when a scratch register is required to
4815move between operand 0 and operand 1. Operand 2 describes the scratch
4816register. See the discussion of the @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS}
4817macro in @pxref{Register Classes}.
4818
d989f648 4819There are special restrictions on the form of the @code{match_operand}s
f282ffb3 4820used in these patterns. First, only the predicate for the reload
560dbedd
RH
4821operand is examined, i.e., @code{reload_in} examines operand 1, but not
4822the predicates for operand 0 or 2. Second, there may be only one
d989f648
RH
4823alternative in the constraints. Third, only a single register class
4824letter may be used for the constraint; subsequent constraint letters
4825are ignored. As a special exception, an empty constraint string
4826matches the @code{ALL_REGS} register class. This may relieve ports
4827of the burden of defining an @code{ALL_REGS} constraint letter just
4828for these patterns.
4829
03dda8e3
RK
4830@cindex @code{movstrict@var{m}} instruction pattern
4831@item @samp{movstrict@var{m}}
4832Like @samp{mov@var{m}} except that if operand 0 is a @code{subreg}
4833with mode @var{m} of a register whose natural mode is wider,
4834the @samp{movstrict@var{m}} instruction is guaranteed not to alter
4835any of the register except the part which belongs to mode @var{m}.
4836
1e0598e2
RH
4837@cindex @code{movmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
4838@item @samp{movmisalign@var{m}}
4839This variant of a move pattern is designed to load or store a value
4840from a memory address that is not naturally aligned for its mode.
4841For a store, the memory will be in operand 0; for a load, the memory
4842will be in operand 1. The other operand is guaranteed not to be a
4843memory, so that it's easy to tell whether this is a load or store.
4844
4845This pattern is used by the autovectorizer, and when expanding a
4846@code{MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF} expression.
4847
03dda8e3
RK
4848@cindex @code{load_multiple} instruction pattern
4849@item @samp{load_multiple}
4850Load several consecutive memory locations into consecutive registers.
4851Operand 0 is the first of the consecutive registers, operand 1
4852is the first memory location, and operand 2 is a constant: the
4853number of consecutive registers.
4854
4855Define this only if the target machine really has such an instruction;
4856do not define this if the most efficient way of loading consecutive
4857registers from memory is to do them one at a time.
4858
4859On some machines, there are restrictions as to which consecutive
4860registers can be stored into memory, such as particular starting or
4861ending register numbers or only a range of valid counts. For those
4862machines, use a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
4863and make the pattern fail if the restrictions are not met.
4864
4865Write the generated insn as a @code{parallel} with elements being a
4866@code{set} of one register from the appropriate memory location (you may
4867also need @code{use} or @code{clobber} elements). Use a
4868@code{match_parallel} (@pxref{RTL Template}) to recognize the insn. See
c9693e96 4869@file{rs6000.md} for examples of the use of this insn pattern.
03dda8e3
RK
4870
4871@cindex @samp{store_multiple} instruction pattern
4872@item @samp{store_multiple}
4873Similar to @samp{load_multiple}, but store several consecutive registers
4874into consecutive memory locations. Operand 0 is the first of the
4875consecutive memory locations, operand 1 is the first register, and
4876operand 2 is a constant: the number of consecutive registers.
4877
272c6793
RS
4878@cindex @code{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4879@item @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4880Perform an interleaved load of several vectors from memory operand 1
4881into register operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}. The register
4882operand is viewed as holding consecutive vectors of mode @var{n},
4883while the memory operand is a flat array that contains the same number
4884of elements. The operation is equivalent to:
4885
4886@smallexample
4887int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4888for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4889 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4890 operand0[i][j] = operand1[j * c + i];
4891@end smallexample
4892
4893For example, @samp{vec_load_lanestiv4hi} loads 8 16-bit values
4894from memory into a register of mode @samp{TI}@. The register
4895contains two consecutive vectors of mode @samp{V4HI}@.
4896
4897This pattern can only be used if:
4898@smallexample
4899TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (@var{n}, @var{c})
4900@end smallexample
4901is true. GCC assumes that, if a target supports this kind of
4902instruction for some mode @var{n}, it also supports unaligned
4903loads for vectors of mode @var{n}.
4904
a54a5997
RS
4905This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4906
7e11fc7f
RS
4907@cindex @code{vec_mask_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4908@item @samp{vec_mask_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4909Like @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an additional
4910mask operand (operand 2) that specifies which elements of the destination
4911vectors should be loaded. Other elements of the destination
4912vectors are set to zero. The operation is equivalent to:
4913
4914@smallexample
4915int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4916for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4917 if (operand2[j])
4918 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4919 operand0[i][j] = operand1[j * c + i];
4920 else
4921 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4922 operand0[i][j] = 0;
4923@end smallexample
4924
4925This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4926
272c6793
RS
4927@cindex @code{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4928@item @samp{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4929Equivalent to @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, with the memory
4930and register operands reversed. That is, the instruction is
4931equivalent to:
4932
4933@smallexample
4934int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4935for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4936 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4937 operand0[j * c + i] = operand1[i][j];
4938@end smallexample
4939
4940for a memory operand 0 and register operand 1.
4941
a54a5997
RS
4942This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4943
7e11fc7f
RS
4944@cindex @code{vec_mask_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4945@item @samp{vec_mask_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4946Like @samp{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an additional
4947mask operand (operand 2) that specifies which elements of the source
4948vectors should be stored. The operation is equivalent to:
4949
4950@smallexample
4951int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4952for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4953 if (operand2[j])
4954 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4955 operand0[j * c + i] = operand1[i][j];
4956@end smallexample
4957
4958This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4959
bfaa08b7
RS
4960@cindex @code{gather_load@var{m}} instruction pattern
4961@item @samp{gather_load@var{m}}
4962Load several separate memory locations into a vector of mode @var{m}.
4963Operand 1 is a scalar base address and operand 2 is a vector of
4964offsets from that base. Operand 0 is a destination vector with the
4965same number of elements as the offset. For each element index @var{i}:
4966
4967@itemize @bullet
4968@item
4969extend the offset element @var{i} to address width, using zero
4970extension if operand 3 is 1 and sign extension if operand 3 is zero;
4971@item
4972multiply the extended offset by operand 4;
4973@item
4974add the result to the base; and
4975@item
4976load the value at that address into element @var{i} of operand 0.
4977@end itemize
4978
4979The value of operand 3 does not matter if the offsets are already
4980address width.
4981
4982@cindex @code{mask_gather_load@var{m}} instruction pattern
4983@item @samp{mask_gather_load@var{m}}
4984Like @samp{gather_load@var{m}}, but takes an extra mask operand as
4985operand 5. Bit @var{i} of the mask is set if element @var{i}
4986of the result should be loaded from memory and clear if element @var{i}
4987of the result should be set to zero.
4988
f307441a
RS
4989@cindex @code{scatter_store@var{m}} instruction pattern
4990@item @samp{scatter_store@var{m}}
4991Store a vector of mode @var{m} into several distinct memory locations.
4992Operand 0 is a scalar base address and operand 1 is a vector of offsets
4993from that base. Operand 4 is the vector of values that should be stored,
4994which has the same number of elements as the offset. For each element
4995index @var{i}:
4996
4997@itemize @bullet
4998@item
4999extend the offset element @var{i} to address width, using zero
5000extension if operand 2 is 1 and sign extension if operand 2 is zero;
5001@item
5002multiply the extended offset by operand 3;
5003@item
5004add the result to the base; and
5005@item
5006store element @var{i} of operand 4 to that address.
5007@end itemize
5008
5009The value of operand 2 does not matter if the offsets are already
5010address width.
5011
5012@cindex @code{mask_scatter_store@var{m}} instruction pattern
5013@item @samp{mask_scatter_store@var{m}}
5014Like @samp{scatter_store@var{m}}, but takes an extra mask operand as
5015operand 5. Bit @var{i} of the mask is set if element @var{i}
5016of the result should be stored to memory.
5017
ef1140a9
JH
5018@cindex @code{vec_set@var{m}} instruction pattern
5019@item @samp{vec_set@var{m}}
5020Set given field in the vector value. Operand 0 is the vector to modify,
5021operand 1 is new value of field and operand 2 specify the field index.
5022
ff03930a
JJ
5023@cindex @code{vec_extract@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5024@item @samp{vec_extract@var{m}@var{n}}
ef1140a9 5025Extract given field from the vector value. Operand 1 is the vector, operand 2
ff03930a
JJ
5026specify field index and operand 0 place to store value into. The
5027@var{n} mode is the mode of the field or vector of fields that should be
5028extracted, should be either element mode of the vector mode @var{m}, or
5029a vector mode with the same element mode and smaller number of elements.
5030If @var{n} is a vector mode, the index is counted in units of that mode.
5031
5032@cindex @code{vec_init@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5033@item @samp{vec_init@var{m}@var{n}}
425a2bde 5034Initialize the vector to given values. Operand 0 is the vector to initialize
ff03930a
JJ
5035and operand 1 is parallel containing values for individual fields. The
5036@var{n} mode is the mode of the elements, should be either element mode of
5037the vector mode @var{m}, or a vector mode with the same element mode and
5038smaller number of elements.
ef1140a9 5039
be4c1d4a
RS
5040@cindex @code{vec_duplicate@var{m}} instruction pattern
5041@item @samp{vec_duplicate@var{m}}
5042Initialize vector output operand 0 so that each element has the value given
5043by scalar input operand 1. The vector has mode @var{m} and the scalar has
5044the mode appropriate for one element of @var{m}.
5045
5046This pattern only handles duplicates of non-constant inputs. Constant
5047vectors go through the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern instead.
5048
5049This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5050
9adab579
RS
5051@cindex @code{vec_series@var{m}} instruction pattern
5052@item @samp{vec_series@var{m}}
5053Initialize vector output operand 0 so that element @var{i} is equal to
5054operand 1 plus @var{i} times operand 2. In other words, create a linear
5055series whose base value is operand 1 and whose step is operand 2.
5056
5057The vector output has mode @var{m} and the scalar inputs have the mode
5058appropriate for one element of @var{m}. This pattern is not used for
5059floating-point vectors, in order to avoid having to specify the
5060rounding behavior for @var{i} > 1.
5061
5062This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5063
7cfb4d93
RS
5064@cindex @code{while_ult@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5065@item @code{while_ult@var{m}@var{n}}
5066Set operand 0 to a mask that is true while incrementing operand 1
5067gives a value that is less than operand 2. Operand 0 has mode @var{n}
5068and operands 1 and 2 are scalar integers of mode @var{m}.
5069The operation is equivalent to:
5070
5071@smallexample
5072operand0[0] = operand1 < operand2;
5073for (i = 1; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); i++)
5074 operand0[i] = operand0[i - 1] && (operand1 + i < operand2);
5075@end smallexample
5076
12fb875f
IE
5077@cindex @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5078@item @samp{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}}
5079Output a vector comparison. Operand 0 of mode @var{n} is the destination for
5080predicate in operand 1 which is a signed vector comparison with operands of
5081mode @var{m} in operands 2 and 3. Predicate is computed by element-wise
5082evaluation of the vector comparison with a truth value of all-ones and a false
5083value of all-zeros.
5084
5085@cindex @code{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5086@item @samp{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}}
5087Similar to @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} but perform unsigned vector comparison.
5088
96592eed
JJ
5089@cindex @code{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5090@item @samp{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}}
5091Similar to @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} but perform equality or non-equality
5092vector comparison only. If @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}}
5093or @code{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern is supported,
5094it will be preferred over @code{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}}, so there is
5095no need to define this instruction pattern if the others are supported.
5096
e9e1d143
RG
5097@cindex @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5098@item @samp{vcond@var{m}@var{n}}
5099Output a conditional vector move. Operand 0 is the destination to
5100receive a combination of operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode @var{m},
12fb875f 5101dependent on the outcome of the predicate in operand 3 which is a signed
e9e1d143
RG
5102vector comparison with operands of mode @var{n} in operands 4 and 5. The
5103modes @var{m} and @var{n} should have the same size. Operand 0
5104will be set to the value @var{op1} & @var{msk} | @var{op2} & ~@var{msk}
5105where @var{msk} is computed by element-wise evaluation of the vector
5106comparison with a truth value of all-ones and a false value of all-zeros.
5107
12fb875f
IE
5108@cindex @code{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5109@item @samp{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}}
5110Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but performs unsigned vector
5111comparison.
5112
96592eed
JJ
5113@cindex @code{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5114@item @samp{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}}
5115Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but performs equality or
5116non-equality vector comparison only. If @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}}
5117or @code{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern is supported,
5118it will be preferred over @code{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}}, so there is
5119no need to define this instruction pattern if the others are supported.
5120
12fb875f
IE
5121@cindex @code{vcond_mask_@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5122@item @samp{vcond_mask_@var{m}@var{n}}
5123Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but operand 3 holds a pre-computed
5124result of vector comparison.
5125
5126@cindex @code{maskload@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5127@item @samp{maskload@var{m}@var{n}}
5128Perform a masked load of vector from memory operand 1 of mode @var{m}
5129into register operand 0. Mask is provided in register operand 2 of
5130mode @var{n}.
5131
a54a5997
RS
5132This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5133
12fb875f 5134@cindex @code{maskstore@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
a54a5997 5135@item @samp{maskstore@var{m}@var{n}}
12fb875f
IE
5136Perform a masked store of vector from register operand 1 of mode @var{m}
5137into memory operand 0. Mask is provided in register operand 2 of
5138mode @var{n}.
5139
a54a5997
RS
5140This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5141
2205ed25
RH
5142@cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5143@item @samp{vec_perm@var{m}}
5144Output a (variable) vector permutation. Operand 0 is the destination
5145to receive elements from operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode
5146@var{m}. Operand 3 is the @dfn{selector}. It is an integral mode
5147vector of the same width and number of elements as mode @var{m}.
5148
5149The input elements are numbered from 0 in operand 1 through
5150@math{2*@var{N}-1} in operand 2. The elements of the selector must
5151be computed modulo @math{2*@var{N}}. Note that if
5152@code{rtx_equal_p(operand1, operand2)}, this can be implemented
5153with just operand 1 and selector elements modulo @var{N}.
5154
d7943c8b
RH
5155In order to make things easy for a number of targets, if there is no
5156@samp{vec_perm} pattern for mode @var{m}, but there is for mode @var{q}
5157where @var{q} is a vector of @code{QImode} of the same width as @var{m},
5158the middle-end will lower the mode @var{m} @code{VEC_PERM_EXPR} to
5159mode @var{q}.
5160
f151c9e1
RS
5161See also @code{TARGET_VECTORIZER_VEC_PERM_CONST}, which performs
5162the analogous operation for constant selectors.
2205ed25 5163
759915ca
EC
5164@cindex @code{push@var{m}1} instruction pattern
5165@item @samp{push@var{m}1}
299c5111 5166Output a push instruction. Operand 0 is value to push. Used only when
38f4324c
JH
5167@code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined. For historical reason, this pattern may be
5168missing and in such case an @code{mov} expander is used instead, with a
6e9aac46 5169@code{MEM} expression forming the push operation. The @code{mov} expander
38f4324c
JH
5170method is deprecated.
5171
03dda8e3
RK
5172@cindex @code{add@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5173@item @samp{add@var{m}3}
5174Add operand 2 and operand 1, storing the result in operand 0. All operands
5175must have mode @var{m}. This can be used even on two-address machines, by
5176means of constraints requiring operands 1 and 0 to be the same location.
5177
0f996086
CF
5178@cindex @code{ssadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5179@cindex @code{usadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3 5180@cindex @code{sub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
5181@cindex @code{sssub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5182@cindex @code{ussub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3 5183@cindex @code{mul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
5184@cindex @code{ssmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5185@cindex @code{usmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3 5186@cindex @code{div@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086 5187@cindex @code{ssdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3 5188@cindex @code{udiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086 5189@cindex @code{usdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
5190@cindex @code{mod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5191@cindex @code{umod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
5192@cindex @code{umin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5193@cindex @code{umax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5194@cindex @code{and@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5195@cindex @code{ior@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5196@cindex @code{xor@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086 5197@item @samp{ssadd@var{m}3}, @samp{usadd@var{m}3}
f457c50c
AS
5198@itemx @samp{sub@var{m}3}, @samp{sssub@var{m}3}, @samp{ussub@var{m}3}
5199@itemx @samp{mul@var{m}3}, @samp{ssmul@var{m}3}, @samp{usmul@var{m}3}
0f996086
CF
5200@itemx @samp{div@var{m}3}, @samp{ssdiv@var{m}3}
5201@itemx @samp{udiv@var{m}3}, @samp{usdiv@var{m}3}
7ae4d8d4
RH
5202@itemx @samp{mod@var{m}3}, @samp{umod@var{m}3}
5203@itemx @samp{umin@var{m}3}, @samp{umax@var{m}3}
03dda8e3
RK
5204@itemx @samp{and@var{m}3}, @samp{ior@var{m}3}, @samp{xor@var{m}3}
5205Similar, for other arithmetic operations.
7ae4d8d4 5206
481efdd9
EB
5207@cindex @code{addv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5208@item @samp{addv@var{m}4}
5209Like @code{add@var{m}3} but takes a @code{code_label} as operand 3 and
5210emits code to jump to it if signed overflow occurs during the addition.
5211This pattern is used to implement the built-in functions performing
5212signed integer addition with overflow checking.
5213
5214@cindex @code{subv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5215@cindex @code{mulv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5216@item @samp{subv@var{m}4}, @samp{mulv@var{m}4}
5217Similar, for other signed arithmetic operations.
5218
cde9d596
RH
5219@cindex @code{uaddv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5220@item @samp{uaddv@var{m}4}
5221Like @code{addv@var{m}4} but for unsigned addition. That is to
5222say, the operation is the same as signed addition but the jump
481efdd9
EB
5223is taken only on unsigned overflow.
5224
cde9d596
RH
5225@cindex @code{usubv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5226@cindex @code{umulv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5227@item @samp{usubv@var{m}4}, @samp{umulv@var{m}4}
5228Similar, for other unsigned arithmetic operations.
5229
481efdd9
EB
5230@cindex @code{addptr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5231@item @samp{addptr@var{m}3}
5232Like @code{add@var{m}3} but is guaranteed to only be used for address
5233calculations. The expanded code is not allowed to clobber the
5234condition code. It only needs to be defined if @code{add@var{m}3}
5235sets the condition code. If adds used for address calculations and
5236normal adds are not compatible it is required to expand a distinct
5237pattern (e.g. using an unspec). The pattern is used by LRA to emit
5238address calculations. @code{add@var{m}3} is used if
5239@code{addptr@var{m}3} is not defined.
5240
1b1562a5
MM
5241@cindex @code{fma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5242@item @samp{fma@var{m}4}
5243Multiply operand 2 and operand 1, then add operand 3, storing the
d6373302
KZ
5244result in operand 0 without doing an intermediate rounding step. All
5245operands must have mode @var{m}. This pattern is used to implement
5246the @code{fma}, @code{fmaf}, and @code{fmal} builtin functions from
5247the ISO C99 standard.
1b1562a5 5248
16949072
RG
5249@cindex @code{fms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5250@item @samp{fms@var{m}4}
5251Like @code{fma@var{m}4}, except operand 3 subtracted from the
5252product instead of added to the product. This is represented
5253in the rtl as
5254
5255@smallexample
5256(fma:@var{m} @var{op1} @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
5257@end smallexample
5258
5259@cindex @code{fnma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5260@item @samp{fnma@var{m}4}
5261Like @code{fma@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
5262is negated before being added to operand 3. This is represented
5263in the rtl as
5264
5265@smallexample
5266(fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} @var{op3})
5267@end smallexample
5268
5269@cindex @code{fnms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5270@item @samp{fnms@var{m}4}
5271Like @code{fms@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
5272is negated before subtracting operand 3. This is represented
5273in the rtl as
5274
5275@smallexample
5276(fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
5277@end smallexample
5278
b71b019a
JH
5279@cindex @code{min@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5280@cindex @code{max@var{m}3} instruction pattern
7ae4d8d4
RH
5281@item @samp{smin@var{m}3}, @samp{smax@var{m}3}
5282Signed minimum and maximum operations. When used with floating point,
5283if both operands are zeros, or if either operand is @code{NaN}, then
5284it is unspecified which of the two operands is returned as the result.
03dda8e3 5285
ccb57bb0
DS
5286@cindex @code{fmin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5287@cindex @code{fmax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5288@item @samp{fmin@var{m}3}, @samp{fmax@var{m}3}
5289IEEE-conformant minimum and maximum operations. If one operand is a quiet
5290@code{NaN}, then the other operand is returned. If both operands are quiet
5291@code{NaN}, then a quiet @code{NaN} is returned. In the case when gcc supports
18ea359a 5292signaling @code{NaN} (-fsignaling-nans) an invalid floating point exception is
ccb57bb0
DS
5293raised and a quiet @code{NaN} is returned.
5294
a54a5997
RS
5295All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5296floating-point mode. These patterns are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5297
d43a252e
AL
5298@cindex @code{reduc_smin_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5299@cindex @code{reduc_smax_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5300@item @samp{reduc_smin_scal_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_smax_scal_@var{m}}
5301Find the signed minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
5302operand 1, and operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of
5303the elements of the input vector.
5304
5305@cindex @code{reduc_umin_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5306@cindex @code{reduc_umax_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5307@item @samp{reduc_umin_scal_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_umax_scal_@var{m}}
5308Find the unsigned minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
5309operand 1, and operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of
5310the elements of the input vector.
5311
5312@cindex @code{reduc_plus_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5313@item @samp{reduc_plus_scal_@var{m}}
5314Compute the sum of the elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1, and
5315operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of the elements of
5316the input vector.
61abee65 5317
898f07b0
RS
5318@cindex @code{reduc_and_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5319@item @samp{reduc_and_scal_@var{m}}
5320@cindex @code{reduc_ior_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5321@itemx @samp{reduc_ior_scal_@var{m}}
5322@cindex @code{reduc_xor_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5323@itemx @samp{reduc_xor_scal_@var{m}}
5324Compute the bitwise @code{AND}/@code{IOR}/@code{XOR} reduction of the elements
5325of a vector of mode @var{m}. Operand 1 is the vector input and operand 0
5326is the scalar result. The mode of the scalar result is the same as one
5327element of @var{m}.
5328
bfe1bb57
RS
5329@cindex @code{extract_last_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5330@item @code{extract_last_@var{m}}
5331Find the last set bit in mask operand 1 and extract the associated element
5332of vector operand 2. Store the result in scalar operand 0. Operand 2
5333has vector mode @var{m} while operand 0 has the mode appropriate for one
5334element of @var{m}. Operand 1 has the usual mask mode for vectors of mode
5335@var{m}; see @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
5336
bb6c2b68
RS
5337@cindex @code{fold_extract_last_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5338@item @code{fold_extract_last_@var{m}}
5339If any bits of mask operand 2 are set, find the last set bit, extract
5340the associated element from vector operand 3, and store the result
5341in operand 0. Store operand 1 in operand 0 otherwise. Operand 3
5342has mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 1 have the mode appropriate for
5343one element of @var{m}. Operand 2 has the usual mask mode for vectors
5344of mode @var{m}; see @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
5345
b781a135
RS
5346@cindex @code{fold_left_plus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5347@item @code{fold_left_plus_@var{m}}
5348Take scalar operand 1 and successively add each element from vector
5349operand 2. Store the result in scalar operand 0. The vector has
5350mode @var{m} and the scalars have the mode appropriate for one
5351element of @var{m}. The operation is strictly in-order: there is
5352no reassociation.
5353
20f06221
DN
5354@cindex @code{sdot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
5355@item @samp{sdot_prod@var{m}}
5356@cindex @code{udot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
544aee0d 5357@itemx @samp{udot_prod@var{m}}
ff2ce160
MS
5358Compute the sum of the products of two signed/unsigned elements.
5359Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their product, which is of a
5360wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode equal or
20f06221 5361wider than the mode of the product. The result is placed in operand 0, which
ff2ce160 5362is of the same mode as operand 3.
20f06221 5363
79d652a5
CH
5364@cindex @code{ssad@var{m}} instruction pattern
5365@item @samp{ssad@var{m}}
5366@cindex @code{usad@var{m}} instruction pattern
5367@item @samp{usad@var{m}}
5368Compute the sum of absolute differences of two signed/unsigned elements.
5369Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their absolute difference, which
5370is of a wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode
5371equal or wider than the mode of the absolute difference. The result is placed
5372in operand 0, which is of the same mode as operand 3.
5373
97532d1a
MC
5374@cindex @code{widen_ssum@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5375@item @samp{widen_ssum@var{m3}}
5376@cindex @code{widen_usum@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5377@itemx @samp{widen_usum@var{m3}}
ff2ce160 5378Operands 0 and 2 are of the same mode, which is wider than the mode of
20f06221
DN
5379operand 1. Add operand 1 to operand 2 and place the widened result in
5380operand 0. (This is used express accumulation of elements into an accumulator
5381of a wider mode.)
5382
f1739b48
RS
5383@cindex @code{vec_shl_insert_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5384@item @samp{vec_shl_insert_@var{m}}
5385Shift the elements in vector input operand 1 left one element (i.e.
5386away from element 0) and fill the vacated element 0 with the scalar
5387in operand 2. Store the result in vector output operand 0. Operands
53880 and 1 have mode @var{m} and operand 2 has the mode appropriate for
5389one element of @var{m}.
5390
61abee65 5391@cindex @code{vec_shr_@var{m}} instruction pattern
e29dfbf0 5392@item @samp{vec_shr_@var{m}}
729ff76e 5393Whole vector right shift in bits, i.e. towards element 0.
61abee65 5394Operand 1 is a vector to be shifted.
759915ca 5395Operand 2 is an integer shift amount in bits.
61abee65
DN
5396Operand 0 is where the resulting shifted vector is stored.
5397The output and input vectors should have the same modes.
5398
8115817b
UB
5399@cindex @code{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5400@item @samp{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}}
5401Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
5402are vectors of the same mode having N integral or floating point elements
0ee2ea09 5403of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which 2*N elements of
8115817b
UB
5404size N/2 are concatenated after narrowing them down using truncation.
5405
89d67cca
DN
5406@cindex @code{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5407@cindex @code{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
8115817b
UB
5408@item @samp{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}}
5409Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
5410are vectors of the same mode having N integral elements of size S.
89d67cca 5411Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which the elements of the two input
8115817b
UB
5412vectors are concatenated after narrowing them down using signed/unsigned
5413saturating arithmetic.
89d67cca 5414
d9987fb4
UB
5415@cindex @code{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5416@cindex @code{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5417@item @samp{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}}
5418Narrow, convert to signed/unsigned integral type and merge the elements
5419of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors of the same mode having N
0ee2ea09 5420floating point elements of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector
d9987fb4
UB
5421in which 2*N elements of size N/2 are concatenated.
5422
1bda738b
JJ
5423@cindex @code{vec_packs_float_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5424@cindex @code{vec_packu_float_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5425@item @samp{vec_packs_float_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_packu_float_@var{m}}
5426Narrow, convert to floating point type and merge the elements
5427of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors of the same mode having N
5428signed/unsigned integral elements of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector
5429in which 2*N elements of size N/2 are concatenated.
5430
89d67cca
DN
5431@cindex @code{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5432@cindex @code{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
8115817b
UB
5433@item @samp{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}}
5434Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of signed
5435integral or floating point elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N
0ee2ea09 5436elements of size S@. Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector
8115817b
UB
5437using signed or floating point extension and place the resulting N/2
5438values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
5439
89d67cca
DN
5440@cindex @code{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5441@cindex @code{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
8115817b
UB
5442@item @samp{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}}
5443Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of unsigned
5444integral elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N elements of size S.
5445Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector using zero extension and
5446place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
89d67cca 5447
d9987fb4
UB
5448@cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5449@cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5450@cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5451@cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5452@item @samp{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}}
5453@itemx @samp{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}}
5454Extract, convert to floating point type and widen the high/low part of a
5455vector of signed/unsigned integral elements. The input vector (operand 1)
0ee2ea09 5456has N elements of size S@. Convert the high/low elements of the vector using
d9987fb4
UB
5457floating point conversion and place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in
5458the output vector (operand 0).
5459
1bda738b
JJ
5460@cindex @code{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5461@cindex @code{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5462@cindex @code{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5463@cindex @code{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5464@item @samp{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_hi_@var{m}},
5465@itemx @samp{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_lo_@var{m}}
5466@itemx @samp{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_hi_@var{m}}
5467@itemx @samp{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_lo_@var{m}}
5468Extract, convert to signed/unsigned integer type and widen the high/low part of a
5469vector of floating point elements. The input vector (operand 1)
5470has N elements of size S@. Convert the high/low elements of the vector
5471to integers and place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in
5472the output vector (operand 0).
5473
89d67cca 5474@cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
3f30a9a6 5475@cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
89d67cca
DN
5476@cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5477@cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
3f30a9a6
RH
5478@cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5479@cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5480@cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5481@cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
d9987fb4
UB
5482@item @samp{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}}
5483@itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}}
3f30a9a6
RH
5484@itemx @samp{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}}
5485@itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}}
8115817b 5486Signed/Unsigned widening multiplication. The two inputs (operands 1 and 2)
0ee2ea09 5487are vectors with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Multiply the high/low
3f30a9a6 5488or even/odd elements of the two vectors, and put the N/2 products of size 2*S
4a271b7e
BM
5489in the output vector (operand 0). A target shouldn't implement even/odd pattern
5490pair if it is less efficient than lo/hi one.
89d67cca 5491
36ba4aae
IR
5492@cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5493@cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5494@cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5495@cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5496@item @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}}
5497@itemx @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}}
5498Signed/Unsigned widening shift left. The first input (operand 1) is a vector
5499with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Operand 2 is a constant. Shift
5500the high/low elements of operand 1, and put the N/2 results of size 2*S in the
5501output vector (operand 0).
5502
03dda8e3
RK
5503@cindex @code{mulhisi3} instruction pattern
5504@item @samp{mulhisi3}
5505Multiply operands 1 and 2, which have mode @code{HImode}, and store
5506a @code{SImode} product in operand 0.
5507
5508@cindex @code{mulqihi3} instruction pattern
5509@cindex @code{mulsidi3} instruction pattern
5510@item @samp{mulqihi3}, @samp{mulsidi3}
5511Similar widening-multiplication instructions of other widths.
5512
5513@cindex @code{umulqihi3} instruction pattern
5514@cindex @code{umulhisi3} instruction pattern
5515@cindex @code{umulsidi3} instruction pattern
5516@item @samp{umulqihi3}, @samp{umulhisi3}, @samp{umulsidi3}
5517Similar widening-multiplication instructions that do unsigned
5518multiplication.
5519
8b44057d
BS
5520@cindex @code{usmulqihi3} instruction pattern
5521@cindex @code{usmulhisi3} instruction pattern
5522@cindex @code{usmulsidi3} instruction pattern
5523@item @samp{usmulqihi3}, @samp{usmulhisi3}, @samp{usmulsidi3}
5524Similar widening-multiplication instructions that interpret the first
5525operand as unsigned and the second operand as signed, then do a signed
5526multiplication.
5527
03dda8e3 5528@cindex @code{smul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
759c58af 5529@item @samp{smul@var{m}3_highpart}
03dda8e3
RK
5530Perform a signed multiplication of operands 1 and 2, which have mode
5531@var{m}, and store the most significant half of the product in operand 0.
5532The least significant half of the product is discarded.
5533
5534@cindex @code{umul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
5535@item @samp{umul@var{m}3_highpart}
5536Similar, but the multiplication is unsigned.
5537
7f9844ca
RS
5538@cindex @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5539@item @samp{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5540Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, add
5541operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
5542have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
0f996086 5543Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
7f9844ca
RS
5544the size of @var{m}.
5545
5546In other words, @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
5547@code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also adds operand 3.
5548
5549These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5550
5551@cindex @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5552@item @samp{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5553Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
5554operands instead of sign-extending them.
5555
0f996086
CF
5556@cindex @code{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5557@item @samp{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5558Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5559signed-saturating.
5560
5561@cindex @code{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5562@item @samp{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5563Like @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5564unsigned-saturating.
5565
14661f36
CF
5566@cindex @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5567@item @samp{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5568Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, subtract the
5569result from operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
5570have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
0f996086 5571Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
14661f36
CF
5572the size of @var{m}.
5573
5574In other words, @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
5575@code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also subtracts the result
5576from operand 3.
5577
5578These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5579
5580@cindex @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5581@item @samp{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5582Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
5583operands instead of sign-extending them.
5584
0f996086
CF
5585@cindex @code{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5586@item @samp{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5587Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5588signed-saturating.
5589
5590@cindex @code{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5591@item @samp{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5592Like @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5593unsigned-saturating.
5594
03dda8e3
RK
5595@cindex @code{divmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5596@item @samp{divmod@var{m}4}
5597Signed division that produces both a quotient and a remainder.
5598Operand 1 is divided by operand 2 to produce a quotient stored
5599in operand 0 and a remainder stored in operand 3.
5600
5601For machines with an instruction that produces both a quotient and a
5602remainder, provide a pattern for @samp{divmod@var{m}4} but do not
5603provide patterns for @samp{div@var{m}3} and @samp{mod@var{m}3}. This
5604allows optimization in the relatively common case when both the quotient
5605and remainder are computed.
5606
5607If an instruction that just produces a quotient or just a remainder
5608exists and is more efficient than the instruction that produces both,
5609write the output routine of @samp{divmod@var{m}4} to call
5610@code{find_reg_note} and look for a @code{REG_UNUSED} note on the
5611quotient or remainder and generate the appropriate instruction.
5612
5613@cindex @code{udivmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5614@item @samp{udivmod@var{m}4}
5615Similar, but does unsigned division.
5616
273a2526 5617@anchor{shift patterns}
03dda8e3 5618@cindex @code{ashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
5619@cindex @code{ssashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5620@cindex @code{usashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5621@item @samp{ashl@var{m}3}, @samp{ssashl@var{m}3}, @samp{usashl@var{m}3}
03dda8e3
RK
5622Arithmetic-shift operand 1 left by a number of bits specified by operand
56232, and store the result in operand 0. Here @var{m} is the mode of
5624operand 0 and operand 1; operand 2's mode is specified by the
5625instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that
78250306
JJ
5626mode before generating the instruction. The shift or rotate expander
5627or instruction pattern should explicitly specify the mode of the operand 2,
5628it should never be @code{VOIDmode}. The meaning of out-of-range shift
273a2526 5629counts can optionally be specified by @code{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}.
71d46ca5 5630@xref{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
03dda8e3
RK
5631
5632@cindex @code{ashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5633@cindex @code{lshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5634@cindex @code{rotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5635@cindex @code{rotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5636@item @samp{ashr@var{m}3}, @samp{lshr@var{m}3}, @samp{rotl@var{m}3}, @samp{rotr@var{m}3}
5637Other shift and rotate instructions, analogous to the
71d46ca5
MM
5638@code{ashl@var{m}3} instructions. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
5639
5640@cindex @code{vashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5641@cindex @code{vashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5642@cindex @code{vlshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5643@cindex @code{vrotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5644@cindex @code{vrotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5645@item @samp{vashl@var{m}3}, @samp{vashr@var{m}3}, @samp{vlshr@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotl@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotr@var{m}3}
5646Vector shift and rotate instructions that take vectors as operand 2
5647instead of a scalar type.
03dda8e3 5648
0267732b
RS
5649@cindex @code{avg@var{m}3_floor} instruction pattern
5650@cindex @code{uavg@var{m}3_floor} instruction pattern
5651@item @samp{avg@var{m}3_floor}
5652@itemx @samp{uavg@var{m}3_floor}
5653Signed and unsigned average instructions. These instructions add
5654operands 1 and 2 without truncation, divide the result by 2,
5655round towards -Inf, and store the result in operand 0. This is
5656equivalent to the C code:
5657@smallexample
5658narrow op0, op1, op2;
5659@dots{}
5660op0 = (narrow) (((wide) op1 + (wide) op2) >> 1);
5661@end smallexample
5662where the sign of @samp{narrow} determines whether this is a signed
5663or unsigned operation.
5664
5665@cindex @code{avg@var{m}3_ceil} instruction pattern
5666@cindex @code{uavg@var{m}3_ceil} instruction pattern
5667@item @samp{avg@var{m}3_ceil}
5668@itemx @samp{uavg@var{m}3_ceil}
5669Like @samp{avg@var{m}3_floor} and @samp{uavg@var{m}3_floor}, but round
5670towards +Inf. This is equivalent to the C code:
5671@smallexample
5672narrow op0, op1, op2;
5673@dots{}
5674op0 = (narrow) (((wide) op1 + (wide) op2 + 1) >> 1);
5675@end smallexample
5676
ac868f29
EB
5677@cindex @code{bswap@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5678@item @samp{bswap@var{m}2}
5679Reverse the order of bytes of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5680
03dda8e3 5681@cindex @code{neg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
5682@cindex @code{ssneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5683@cindex @code{usneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5684@item @samp{neg@var{m}2}, @samp{ssneg@var{m}2}, @samp{usneg@var{m}2}
03dda8e3
RK
5685Negate operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5686
481efdd9
EB
5687@cindex @code{negv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5688@item @samp{negv@var{m}3}
5689Like @code{neg@var{m}2} but takes a @code{code_label} as operand 2 and
5690emits code to jump to it if signed overflow occurs during the negation.
5691
03dda8e3
RK
5692@cindex @code{abs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5693@item @samp{abs@var{m}2}
5694Store the absolute value of operand 1 into operand 0.
5695
5696@cindex @code{sqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5697@item @samp{sqrt@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5698Store the square root of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5699mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
03dda8e3 5700
a54a5997 5701This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
e7b489c8 5702
ee62a5a6
RS
5703@cindex @code{rsqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5704@item @samp{rsqrt@var{m}2}
5705Store the reciprocal of the square root of operand 1 into operand 0.
a54a5997
RS
5706Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5707floating-point mode.
5708
ee62a5a6
RS
5709On most architectures this pattern is only approximate, so either
5710its C condition or the @code{TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P} hook should
5711check for the appropriate math flags. (Using the C condition is
5712more direct, but using @code{TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P} can be useful
5713if a target-specific built-in also uses the @samp{rsqrt@var{m}2}
5714pattern.)
5715
5716This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5717
17b98269
UB
5718@cindex @code{fmod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5719@item @samp{fmod@var{m}3}
5720Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
a54a5997
RS
5721operand 0, rounded towards zero to an integer. All operands have
5722mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
17b98269 5723
a54a5997 5724This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
17b98269
UB
5725
5726@cindex @code{remainder@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5727@item @samp{remainder@var{m}3}
5728Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
a54a5997
RS
5729operand 0, rounded to the nearest integer. All operands have
5730mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5731
5732This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5733
5734@cindex @code{scalb@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5735@item @samp{scalb@var{m}3}
5736Raise @code{FLT_RADIX} to the power of operand 2, multiply it by
5737operand 1, and store the result in operand 0. All operands have
5738mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
17b98269 5739
a54a5997
RS
5740This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5741
5742@cindex @code{ldexp@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5743@item @samp{ldexp@var{m}3}
5744Raise 2 to the power of operand 2, multiply it by operand 1, and store
5745the result in operand 0. Operands 0 and 1 have mode @var{m}, which is
5746a scalar or vector floating-point mode. Operand 2's mode has
5747the same number of elements as @var{m} and each element is wide
5748enough to store an @code{int}. The integers are signed.
5749
5750This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
17b98269 5751
e7b489c8
RS
5752@cindex @code{cos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5753@item @samp{cos@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5754Store the cosine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5755mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
e7b489c8 5756
a54a5997 5757This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
e7b489c8
RS
5758
5759@cindex @code{sin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5760@item @samp{sin@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5761Store the sine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5762mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
e7b489c8 5763
a54a5997 5764This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
e7b489c8 5765
6d1f6aff
OE
5766@cindex @code{sincos@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5767@item @samp{sincos@var{m}3}
6ba9e401 5768Store the cosine of operand 2 into operand 0 and the sine of
a54a5997
RS
5769operand 2 into operand 1. All operands have mode @var{m},
5770which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6d1f6aff 5771
6d1f6aff
OE
5772Targets that can calculate the sine and cosine simultaneously can
5773implement this pattern as opposed to implementing individual
5774@code{sin@var{m}2} and @code{cos@var{m}2} patterns. The @code{sin}
5775and @code{cos} built-in functions will then be expanded to the
5776@code{sincos@var{m}3} pattern, with one of the output values
5777left unused.
5778
a54a5997
RS
5779@cindex @code{tan@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5780@item @samp{tan@var{m}2}
5781Store the tangent of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5782mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5783
5784This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5785
5786@cindex @code{asin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5787@item @samp{asin@var{m}2}
5788Store the arc sine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5789mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5790
5791This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5792
5793@cindex @code{acos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5794@item @samp{acos@var{m}2}
5795Store the arc cosine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5796mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5797
5798This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5799
5800@cindex @code{atan@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5801@item @samp{atan@var{m}2}
5802Store the arc tangent of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5803mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5804
5805This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5806
e7b489c8
RS
5807@cindex @code{exp@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5808@item @samp{exp@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5809Raise e (the base of natural logarithms) to the power of operand 1
5810and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m},
5811which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5812
5813This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5814
5815@cindex @code{expm1@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5816@item @samp{expm1@var{m}2}
5817Raise e (the base of natural logarithms) to the power of operand 1,
5818subtract 1, and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have
5819mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5820
5821For inputs close to zero, the pattern is expected to be more
5822accurate than a separate @code{exp@var{m}2} and @code{sub@var{m}3}
5823would be.
5824
5825This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5826
5827@cindex @code{exp10@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5828@item @samp{exp10@var{m}2}
5829Raise 10 to the power of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5830Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5831floating-point mode.
5832
5833This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5834
5835@cindex @code{exp2@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5836@item @samp{exp2@var{m}2}
5837Raise 2 to the power of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5838Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5839floating-point mode.
e7b489c8 5840
a54a5997 5841This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
e7b489c8
RS
5842
5843@cindex @code{log@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5844@item @samp{log@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5845Store the natural logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
5846have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5847
5848This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5849
5850@cindex @code{log1p@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5851@item @samp{log1p@var{m}2}
5852Add 1 to operand 1, compute the natural logarithm, and store
5853the result in operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is
5854a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5855
5856For inputs close to zero, the pattern is expected to be more
5857accurate than a separate @code{add@var{m}3} and @code{log@var{m}2}
5858would be.
5859
5860This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5861
5862@cindex @code{log10@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5863@item @samp{log10@var{m}2}
5864Store the base-10 logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
5865have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5866
5867This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5868
5869@cindex @code{log2@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5870@item @samp{log2@var{m}2}
5871Store the base-2 logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
5872have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
e7b489c8 5873
a54a5997
RS
5874This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5875
5876@cindex @code{logb@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5877@item @samp{logb@var{m}2}
5878Store the base-@code{FLT_RADIX} logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0.
5879Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5880floating-point mode.
5881
5882This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5883
5884@cindex @code{significand@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5885@item @samp{significand@var{m}2}
5886Store the significand of floating-point operand 1 in operand 0.
5887Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5888floating-point mode.
5889
5890This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
03dda8e3 5891
b5e01d4b
RS
5892@cindex @code{pow@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5893@item @samp{pow@var{m}3}
5894Store the value of operand 1 raised to the exponent operand 2
a54a5997
RS
5895into operand 0. All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar
5896or vector floating-point mode.
b5e01d4b 5897
a54a5997 5898This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
b5e01d4b
RS
5899
5900@cindex @code{atan2@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5901@item @samp{atan2@var{m}3}
5902Store the arc tangent (inverse tangent) of operand 1 divided by
5903operand 2 into operand 0, using the signs of both arguments to
a54a5997
RS
5904determine the quadrant of the result. All operands have mode
5905@var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
b5e01d4b 5906
a54a5997 5907This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
b5e01d4b 5908
4977bab6
ZW
5909@cindex @code{floor@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5910@item @samp{floor@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5911Store the largest integral value not greater than operand 1 in operand 0.
5912Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
0d2f700f
JM
5913floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in
5914effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
5915operands; otherwise, it may not.
4977bab6 5916
a54a5997 5917This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4977bab6 5918
10553f10
UB
5919@cindex @code{btrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5920@item @samp{btrunc@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5921Round operand 1 to an integer, towards zero, and store the result in
5922operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or
0d2f700f
JM
5923vector floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is
5924in effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
5925operands; otherwise, it may not.
4977bab6 5926
a54a5997 5927This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4977bab6
ZW
5928
5929@cindex @code{round@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5930@item @samp{round@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5931Round operand 1 to the nearest integer, rounding away from zero in the
5932event of a tie, and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have
0d2f700f
JM
5933mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode. If
5934@option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in effect, the ``inexact''
5935exception may be raised for noninteger operands; otherwise, it may
5936not.
4977bab6 5937
a54a5997 5938This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4977bab6
ZW
5939
5940@cindex @code{ceil@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5941@item @samp{ceil@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5942Store the smallest integral value not less than operand 1 in operand 0.
5943Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
0d2f700f
JM
5944floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in
5945effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
5946operands; otherwise, it may not.
4977bab6 5947
a54a5997 5948This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4977bab6
ZW
5949
5950@cindex @code{nearbyint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5951@item @samp{nearbyint@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5952Round operand 1 to an integer, using the current rounding mode, and
5953store the result in operand 0. Do not raise an inexact condition when
5954the result is different from the argument. Both operands have mode
5955@var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
4977bab6 5956
a54a5997 5957This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4977bab6 5958
10553f10
UB
5959@cindex @code{rint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5960@item @samp{rint@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
5961Round operand 1 to an integer, using the current rounding mode, and
5962store the result in operand 0. Raise an inexact condition when
5963the result is different from the argument. Both operands have mode
5964@var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
10553f10 5965
a54a5997 5966This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
10553f10 5967
bb7f0423
RG
5968@cindex @code{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
5969@item @samp{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
5970Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5971point mode @var{n} as a signed number according to the current
5972rounding mode and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5973
4d81bf84 5974@cindex @code{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
e0d4c0b3 5975@item @samp{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
4d81bf84
RG
5976Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5977point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding to nearest and away
5978from zero and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5979
c3a4177f 5980@cindex @code{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
e0d4c0b3 5981@item @samp{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
c3a4177f
RG
5982Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5983point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding down and store in
5984operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5985
5986@cindex @code{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
e0d4c0b3 5987@item @samp{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
c3a4177f
RG
5988Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5989point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding up and store in
5990operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5991
d35a40fc
DE
5992@cindex @code{copysign@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5993@item @samp{copysign@var{m}3}
5994Store a value with the magnitude of operand 1 and the sign of operand
a54a5997
RS
59952 into operand 0. All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or
5996vector floating-point mode.
d35a40fc 5997
a54a5997 5998This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
d35a40fc 5999
03dda8e3
RK
6000@cindex @code{ffs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6001@item @samp{ffs@var{m}2}
6002Store into operand 0 one plus the index of the least significant 1-bit
a54a5997 6003of operand 1. If operand 1 is zero, store zero.
03dda8e3 6004
a54a5997
RS
6005@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6006operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6007integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6008conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6009to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6010operands must have mode @var{m}.
6011
6012This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
03dda8e3 6013
e7a45277
KT
6014@cindex @code{clrsb@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6015@item @samp{clrsb@var{m}2}
6016Count leading redundant sign bits.
6017Store into operand 0 the number of redundant sign bits in operand 1, starting
6018at the most significant bit position.
6019A redundant sign bit is defined as any sign bit after the first. As such,
6020this count will be one less than the count of leading sign bits.
6021
a54a5997
RS
6022@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6023operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6024integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6025conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6026to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6027operands must have mode @var{m}.
6028
6029This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6030
2928cd7a
RH
6031@cindex @code{clz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6032@item @samp{clz@var{m}2}
e7a45277
KT
6033Store into operand 0 the number of leading 0-bits in operand 1, starting
6034at the most significant bit position. If operand 1 is 0, the
2a6627c2
JN
6035@code{CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
6036the result is undefined or has a useful value.
a54a5997
RS
6037
6038@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6039operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6040integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6041conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6042to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6043operands must have mode @var{m}.
6044
6045This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
2928cd7a
RH
6046
6047@cindex @code{ctz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6048@item @samp{ctz@var{m}2}
e7a45277
KT
6049Store into operand 0 the number of trailing 0-bits in operand 1, starting
6050at the least significant bit position. If operand 1 is 0, the
2a6627c2
JN
6051@code{CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
6052the result is undefined or has a useful value.
a54a5997
RS
6053
6054@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6055operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6056integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6057conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6058to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6059operands must have mode @var{m}.
6060
6061This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
2928cd7a
RH
6062
6063@cindex @code{popcount@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6064@item @samp{popcount@var{m}2}
a54a5997
RS
6065Store into operand 0 the number of 1-bits in operand 1.
6066
6067@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6068operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6069integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6070conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6071to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6072operands must have mode @var{m}.
6073
6074This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
2928cd7a
RH
6075
6076@cindex @code{parity@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6077@item @samp{parity@var{m}2}
e7a45277 6078Store into operand 0 the parity of operand 1, i.e.@: the number of 1-bits
a54a5997
RS
6079in operand 1 modulo 2.
6080
6081@var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6082operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6083integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6084conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6085to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6086operands must have mode @var{m}.
6087
6088This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
2928cd7a 6089
03dda8e3
RK
6090@cindex @code{one_cmpl@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6091@item @samp{one_cmpl@var{m}2}
6092Store the bitwise-complement of operand 1 into operand 0.
6093
70128ad9
AO
6094@cindex @code{movmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6095@item @samp{movmem@var{m}}
beed8fc0
AO
6096Block move instruction. The destination and source blocks of memory
6097are the first two operands, and both are @code{mem:BLK}s with an
6098address in mode @code{Pmode}.
e5e809f4 6099
03dda8e3 6100The number of bytes to move is the third operand, in mode @var{m}.
5689294c 6101Usually, you specify @code{Pmode} for @var{m}. However, if you can
e5e809f4 6102generate better code knowing the range of valid lengths is smaller than
5689294c
L
6103those representable in a full Pmode pointer, you should provide
6104a pattern with a
e5e809f4
JL
6105mode corresponding to the range of values you can handle efficiently
6106(e.g., @code{QImode} for values in the range 0--127; note we avoid numbers
5689294c 6107that appear negative) and also a pattern with @code{Pmode}.
03dda8e3
RK
6108
6109The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
6110destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
6111compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
6112it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
6113
079a182e
JH
6114Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
6115respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
6116in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
9946ca2d
RA
6117all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
6118Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
079a182e 6119
70128ad9 6120Descriptions of multiple @code{movmem@var{m}} patterns can only be
4693911f 6121beneficial if the patterns for smaller modes have fewer restrictions
8c01d9b6 6122on their first, second and fourth operands. Note that the mode @var{m}
70128ad9 6123in @code{movmem@var{m}} does not impose any restriction on the mode of
8c01d9b6
JL
6124individually moved data units in the block.
6125
03dda8e3
RK
6126These patterns need not give special consideration to the possibility
6127that the source and destination strings might overlap.
6128
beed8fc0
AO
6129@cindex @code{movstr} instruction pattern
6130@item @samp{movstr}
6131String copy instruction, with @code{stpcpy} semantics. Operand 0 is
6132an output operand in mode @code{Pmode}. The addresses of the
6133destination and source strings are operands 1 and 2, and both are
6134@code{mem:BLK}s with addresses in mode @code{Pmode}. The execution of
6135the expansion of this pattern should store in operand 0 the address in
6136which the @code{NUL} terminator was stored in the destination string.
6137
3918b108
JH
6138This patern has also several optional operands that are same as in
6139@code{setmem}.
6140
57e84f18
AS
6141@cindex @code{setmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6142@item @samp{setmem@var{m}}
6143Block set instruction. The destination string is the first operand,
beed8fc0 6144given as a @code{mem:BLK} whose address is in mode @code{Pmode}. The
57e84f18
AS
6145number of bytes to set is the second operand, in mode @var{m}. The value to
6146initialize the memory with is the third operand. Targets that only support the
6147clearing of memory should reject any value that is not the constant 0. See
beed8fc0 6148@samp{movmem@var{m}} for a discussion of the choice of mode.
03dda8e3 6149
57e84f18 6150The fourth operand is the known alignment of the destination, in the form
03dda8e3
RK
6151of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the compiler knows that the
6152destination is word-aligned, it may provide the value 4 for this
6153operand.
6154
079a182e
JH
6155Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
6156respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
6157in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
9946ca2d
RA
6158all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
6159Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
3918b108
JH
6160Operand 7 is the minimal size of the block and operand 8 is the
6161maximal size of the block (NULL if it can not be represented as CONST_INT).
82bb7d4e
JH
6162Operand 9 is the probable maximal size (i.e. we can not rely on it for correctness,
6163but it can be used for choosing proper code sequence for a given size).
079a182e 6164
57e84f18 6165The use for multiple @code{setmem@var{m}} is as for @code{movmem@var{m}}.
8c01d9b6 6166
40c1d5f8
AS
6167@cindex @code{cmpstrn@var{m}} instruction pattern
6168@item @samp{cmpstrn@var{m}}
358b8f01 6169String compare instruction, with five operands. Operand 0 is the output;
03dda8e3 6170it has mode @var{m}. The remaining four operands are like the operands
70128ad9 6171of @samp{movmem@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
5cc2f4f3
KG
6172byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
6173string. The instruction is not allowed to prefetch more than one byte
6174at a time since either string may end in the first byte and reading past
6175that may access an invalid page or segment and cause a fault. The
9b0f6f5e
NC
6176comparison terminates early if the fetched bytes are different or if
6177they are equal to zero. The effect of the instruction is to store a
6178value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the result of the comparison.
03dda8e3 6179
40c1d5f8
AS
6180@cindex @code{cmpstr@var{m}} instruction pattern
6181@item @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
6182String compare instruction, without known maximum length. Operand 0 is the
6183output; it has mode @var{m}. The second and third operand are the blocks of
6184memory to be compared; both are @code{mem:BLK} with an address in mode
6185@code{Pmode}.
6186
6187The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
6188destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
6189compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
6190it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
6191
6192The two memory blocks specified are compared byte by byte in lexicographic
6193order starting at the beginning of each string. The instruction is not allowed
6194to prefetch more than one byte at a time since either string may end in the
6195first byte and reading past that may access an invalid page or segment and
9b0f6f5e
NC
6196cause a fault. The comparison will terminate when the fetched bytes
6197are different or if they are equal to zero. The effect of the
6198instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the
6199result of the comparison.
40c1d5f8 6200
358b8f01
JJ
6201@cindex @code{cmpmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6202@item @samp{cmpmem@var{m}}
6203Block compare instruction, with five operands like the operands
6204of @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
6205byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
6206block. Unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}} the instruction can prefetch
9b0f6f5e
NC
6207any bytes in the two memory blocks. Also unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
6208the comparison will not stop if both bytes are zero. The effect of
6209the instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates
6210the result of the comparison.
358b8f01 6211
03dda8e3
RK
6212@cindex @code{strlen@var{m}} instruction pattern
6213@item @samp{strlen@var{m}}
6214Compute the length of a string, with three operands.
6215Operand 0 is the result (of mode @var{m}), operand 1 is
6216a @code{mem} referring to the first character of the string,
6217operand 2 is the character to search for (normally zero),
6218and operand 3 is a constant describing the known alignment
6219of the beginning of the string.
6220
e0d4c0b3 6221@cindex @code{float@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6222@item @samp{float@var{m}@var{n}2}
6223Convert signed integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m}) to
6224floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
6225@var{n}).
6226
e0d4c0b3 6227@cindex @code{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6228@item @samp{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6229Convert unsigned integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m})
6230to floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
6231@var{n}).
6232
e0d4c0b3 6233@cindex @code{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6234@item @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2}
6235Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6236point mode @var{n} as a signed number and store in operand 0 (which
6237has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when
6238the value of operand 1 is an integer.
6239
0e1d7f32
AH
6240If the machine description defines this pattern, it also needs to
6241define the @code{ftrunc} pattern.
6242
e0d4c0b3 6243@cindex @code{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6244@item @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6245Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6246point mode @var{n} as an unsigned number and store in operand 0 (which
6247has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when the
6248value of operand 1 is an integer.
6249
6250@cindex @code{ftrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6251@item @samp{ftrunc@var{m}2}
6252Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to an
6253integer value, still represented in floating point mode @var{m}, and
6254store it in operand 0 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}).
6255
e0d4c0b3 6256@cindex @code{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6257@item @samp{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6258Like @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point value
6259of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
6260
e0d4c0b3 6261@cindex @code{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6262@item @samp{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6263Like @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point
6264value of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
6265
e0d4c0b3 6266@cindex @code{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6267@item @samp{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6268Truncate operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6269store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6270point or both floating point.
6271
e0d4c0b3 6272@cindex @code{extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6273@item @samp{extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
6274Sign-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6275store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6276point or both floating point.
6277
e0d4c0b3 6278@cindex @code{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
03dda8e3
RK
6279@item @samp{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
6280Zero-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6281store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6282point.
6283
e0d4c0b3 6284@cindex @code{fract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
6285@item @samp{fract@var{m}@var{n}2}
6286Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6287operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6288could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
6289fixed-point to signed integer, floating-point to fixed-point,
6290or fixed-point to floating-point.
6291When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
6292
e0d4c0b3 6293@cindex @code{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
6294@item @samp{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2}
6295Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6296operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6297could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
6298or floating-point to fixed-point.
6299When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
6300results to the maximum or the minimum.
6301
e0d4c0b3 6302@cindex @code{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
6303@item @samp{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6304Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6305operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6306could be unsigned integer to fixed-point, or
6307fixed-point to unsigned integer.
6308When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
6309
e0d4c0b3 6310@cindex @code{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
0f996086
CF
6311@item @samp{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6312Convert unsigned integer operand 1 of mode @var{m} to fixed-point mode
6313@var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6314When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
6315results to the maximum or the minimum.
6316
d2eeb2d1
RS
6317@cindex @code{extv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6318@item @samp{extv@var{m}}
6319Extract a bit-field from register operand 1, sign-extend it, and store
6320it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width of the field in bits
6321and operand 3 the starting bit, which counts from the most significant
6322bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN} is true and from the least significant bit
6323otherwise.
6324
6325Operands 0 and 1 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 2 and 3 have a
6326target-specific mode.
6327
6328@cindex @code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6329@item @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}}
6330Extract a bit-field from memory operand 1, sign extend it, and store
6331it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3
6332the starting bit. The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of
6333operand 1; it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6334is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6335
6336Operand 0 has mode @var{m} while operand 1 has @code{BLK} mode.
6337Operands 2 and 3 have a target-specific mode.
6338
6339The instruction must not read beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
6340
6341@cindex @code{extzv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6342@item @samp{extzv@var{m}}
6343Like @samp{extv@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
6344
6345@cindex @code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6346@item @samp{extzvmisalign@var{m}}
6347Like @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is
6348zero-extended.
6349
6350@cindex @code{insv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6351@item @samp{insv@var{m}}
6352Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of register operand 0. Operand 1
6353specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit,
6354which counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6355is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6356
6357Operands 0 and 3 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 1 and 2 have a
6358target-specific mode.
6359
6360@cindex @code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6361@item @samp{insvmisalign@var{m}}
6362Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of memory operand 0. Operand 1
6363specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit.
6364The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of operand 0;
6365it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6366is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6367
6368Operand 3 has mode @var{m} while operand 0 has @code{BLK} mode.
6369Operands 1 and 2 have a target-specific mode.
6370
6371The instruction must not read or write beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
6372
03dda8e3
RK
6373@cindex @code{extv} instruction pattern
6374@item @samp{extv}
c771326b 6375Extract a bit-field from operand 1 (a register or memory operand), where
03dda8e3
RK
6376operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3 the starting bit,
6377and store it in operand 0. Operand 0 must have mode @code{word_mode}.
6378Operand 1 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or @code{word_mode}; often
6379@code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers. Operands 2 and 3 must
6380be valid for @code{word_mode}.
6381
6382The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
3ab997e8 6383for operands 2 and 3 and the constant is never zero for operand 2.
03dda8e3
RK
6384
6385The bit-field value is sign-extended to a full word integer
6386before it is stored in operand 0.
6387
d2eeb2d1
RS
6388This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extv@var{m}} and
6389@code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6390
03dda8e3
RK
6391@cindex @code{extzv} instruction pattern
6392@item @samp{extzv}
6393Like @samp{extv} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
6394
d2eeb2d1
RS
6395This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extzv@var{m}} and
6396@code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6397
03dda8e3
RK
6398@cindex @code{insv} instruction pattern
6399@item @samp{insv}
c771326b
JM
6400Store operand 3 (which must be valid for @code{word_mode}) into a
6401bit-field in operand 0, where operand 1 specifies the width in bits and
03dda8e3
RK
6402operand 2 the starting bit. Operand 0 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or
6403@code{word_mode}; often @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers.
6404Operands 1 and 2 must be valid for @code{word_mode}.
6405
6406The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
3ab997e8 6407for operands 1 and 2 and the constant is never zero for operand 1.
03dda8e3 6408
d2eeb2d1
RS
6409This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{insv@var{m}} and
6410@code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6411
03dda8e3
RK
6412@cindex @code{mov@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6413@item @samp{mov@var{mode}cc}
6414Conditionally move operand 2 or operand 3 into operand 0 according to the
6415comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, operand 2 is moved
6416into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6417
6418The mode of the operands being compared need not be the same as the operands
6419being moved. Some machines, sparc64 for example, have instructions that
6420conditionally move an integer value based on the floating point condition
6421codes and vice versa.
6422
6423If the machine does not have conditional move instructions, do not
6424define these patterns.
6425
068f5dea 6426@cindex @code{add@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
4b5cc2b3 6427@item @samp{add@var{mode}cc}
068f5dea
JH
6428Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional addition. Conditionally
6429move operand 2 or (operands 2 + operand 3) into operand 0 according to the
5285c21c 6430comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is false, operand 2 is moved into
4b5cc2b3 6431operand 0, otherwise (operand 2 + operand 3) is moved.
068f5dea 6432
0972596e
RS
6433@cindex @code{cond_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6434@cindex @code{cond_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6c4fd4a9
RS
6435@cindex @code{cond_mul@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6436@cindex @code{cond_div@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6437@cindex @code{cond_udiv@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6438@cindex @code{cond_mod@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6439@cindex @code{cond_umod@var{mode}} instruction pattern
0972596e
RS
6440@cindex @code{cond_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6441@cindex @code{cond_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6442@cindex @code{cond_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6443@cindex @code{cond_smin@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6444@cindex @code{cond_smax@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6445@cindex @code{cond_umin@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6446@cindex @code{cond_umax@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6447@item @samp{cond_add@var{mode}}
6448@itemx @samp{cond_sub@var{mode}}
6c4fd4a9
RS
6449@itemx @samp{cond_mul@var{mode}}
6450@itemx @samp{cond_div@var{mode}}
6451@itemx @samp{cond_udiv@var{mode}}
6452@itemx @samp{cond_mod@var{mode}}
6453@itemx @samp{cond_umod@var{mode}}
0972596e
RS
6454@itemx @samp{cond_and@var{mode}}
6455@itemx @samp{cond_ior@var{mode}}
6456@itemx @samp{cond_xor@var{mode}}
6457@itemx @samp{cond_smin@var{mode}}
6458@itemx @samp{cond_smax@var{mode}}
6459@itemx @samp{cond_umin@var{mode}}
6460@itemx @samp{cond_umax@var{mode}}
9d4ac06e
RS
6461When operand 1 is true, perform an operation on operands 2 and 3 and
6462store the result in operand 0, otherwise store operand 4 in operand 0.
6463The operation works elementwise if the operands are vectors.
6464
6465The scalar case is equivalent to:
6466
6467@smallexample
6468op0 = op1 ? op2 @var{op} op3 : op4;
6469@end smallexample
6470
6471while the vector case is equivalent to:
0972596e
RS
6472
6473@smallexample
9d4ac06e
RS
6474for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{m}); i++)
6475 op0[i] = op1[i] ? op2[i] @var{op} op3[i] : op4[i];
0972596e
RS
6476@end smallexample
6477
6478where, for example, @var{op} is @code{+} for @samp{cond_add@var{mode}}.
6479
6480When defined for floating-point modes, the contents of @samp{op3[i]}
6481are not interpreted if @var{op1[i]} is false, just like they would not
6482be in a normal C @samp{?:} condition.
6483
9d4ac06e
RS
6484Operands 0, 2, 3 and 4 all have mode @var{m}. Operand 1 is a scalar
6485integer if @var{m} is scalar, otherwise it has the mode returned by
6486@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
0972596e 6487
b41d1f6e
RS
6488@cindex @code{cond_fma@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6489@cindex @code{cond_fms@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6490@cindex @code{cond_fnma@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6491@cindex @code{cond_fnms@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6492@item @samp{cond_fma@var{mode}}
6493@itemx @samp{cond_fms@var{mode}}
6494@itemx @samp{cond_fnma@var{mode}}
6495@itemx @samp{cond_fnms@var{mode}}
6496Like @samp{cond_add@var{m}}, except that the conditional operation
6497takes 3 operands rather than two. For example, the vector form of
6498@samp{cond_fma@var{mode}} is equivalent to:
6499
6500@smallexample
6501for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{m}); i++)
6502 op0[i] = op1[i] ? fma (op2[i], op3[i], op4[i]) : op5[i];
6503@end smallexample
6504
ce68b5cf
KT
6505@cindex @code{neg@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6506@item @samp{neg@var{mode}cc}
6507Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional negation. Conditionally
6508move the negation of operand 2 or the unchanged operand 3 into operand 0
6509according to the comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, the negation
6510of operand 2 is moved into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6511
6512@cindex @code{not@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6513@item @samp{not@var{mode}cc}
6514Similar to @samp{neg@var{mode}cc} but for conditional complement.
6515Conditionally move the bitwise complement of operand 2 or the unchanged
6516operand 3 into operand 0 according to the comparison in operand 1.
6517If the comparison is true, the complement of operand 2 is moved into
6518operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6519
f90b7a5a
PB
6520@cindex @code{cstore@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
6521@item @samp{cstore@var{mode}4}
6522Store zero or nonzero in operand 0 according to whether a comparison
6523is true. Operand 1 is a comparison operator. Operand 2 and operand 3
6524are the first and second operand of the comparison, respectively.
6525You specify the mode that operand 0 must have when you write the
6526@code{match_operand} expression. The compiler automatically sees which
6527mode you have used and supplies an operand of that mode.
03dda8e3
RK
6528
6529The value stored for a true condition must have 1 as its low bit, or
6530else must be negative. Otherwise the instruction is not suitable and
6531you should omit it from the machine description. You describe to the
6532compiler exactly which value is stored by defining the macro
6533@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} (@pxref{Misc}). If a description cannot be
ac5eda13
PB
6534found that can be used for all the possible comparison operators, you
6535should pick one and use a @code{define_expand} to map all results
6536onto the one you chose.
6537
6538These operations may @code{FAIL}, but should do so only in relatively
6539uncommon cases; if they would @code{FAIL} for common cases involving
6540integer comparisons, it is best to restrict the predicates to not
6541allow these operands. Likewise if a given comparison operator will
6542always fail, independent of the operands (for floating-point modes, the
6543@code{ordered_comparison_operator} predicate is often useful in this case).
6544
6545If this pattern is omitted, the compiler will generate a conditional
6546branch---for example, it may copy a constant one to the target and branching
6547around an assignment of zero to the target---or a libcall. If the predicate
6548for operand 1 only rejects some operators, it will also try reordering the
6549operands and/or inverting the result value (e.g.@: by an exclusive OR).
6550These possibilities could be cheaper or equivalent to the instructions
6551used for the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern followed by those required
6552to convert a positive result from @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} to 1; in this
6553case, you can and should make operand 1's predicate reject some operators
6554in the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern, or remove the pattern altogether
6555from the machine description.
03dda8e3 6556
66c87bae
KH
6557@cindex @code{cbranch@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
6558@item @samp{cbranch@var{mode}4}
6559Conditional branch instruction combined with a compare instruction.
6560Operand 0 is a comparison operator. Operand 1 and operand 2 are the
6561first and second operands of the comparison, respectively. Operand 3
481efdd9 6562is the @code{code_label} to jump to.
66c87bae 6563
d26eedb6
HPN
6564@cindex @code{jump} instruction pattern
6565@item @samp{jump}
6566A jump inside a function; an unconditional branch. Operand 0 is the
481efdd9
EB
6567@code{code_label} to jump to. This pattern name is mandatory on all
6568machines.
d26eedb6 6569
03dda8e3
RK
6570@cindex @code{call} instruction pattern
6571@item @samp{call}
6572Subroutine call instruction returning no value. Operand 0 is the
6573function to call; operand 1 is the number of bytes of arguments pushed
f5963e61
JL
6574as a @code{const_int}; operand 2 is the number of registers used as
6575operands.
03dda8e3
RK
6576
6577On most machines, operand 2 is not actually stored into the RTL
6578pattern. It is supplied for the sake of some RISC machines which need
6579to put this information into the assembler code; they can put it in
6580the RTL instead of operand 1.
6581
6582Operand 0 should be a @code{mem} RTX whose address is the address of the
6583function. Note, however, that this address can be a @code{symbol_ref}
6584expression even if it would not be a legitimate memory address on the
6585target machine. If it is also not a valid argument for a call
6586instruction, the pattern for this operation should be a
6587@code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) that places the
6588address into a register and uses that register in the call instruction.
6589
6590@cindex @code{call_value} instruction pattern
6591@item @samp{call_value}
6592Subroutine call instruction returning a value. Operand 0 is the hard
6593register in which the value is returned. There are three more
6594operands, the same as the three operands of the @samp{call}
6595instruction (but with numbers increased by one).
6596
6597Subroutines that return @code{BLKmode} objects use the @samp{call}
6598insn.
6599
6600@cindex @code{call_pop} instruction pattern
6601@cindex @code{call_value_pop} instruction pattern
6602@item @samp{call_pop}, @samp{call_value_pop}
6603Similar to @samp{call} and @samp{call_value}, except used if defined and
df2a54e9 6604if @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is nonzero. They should emit a @code{parallel}
03dda8e3
RK
6605that contains both the function call and a @code{set} to indicate the
6606adjustment made to the frame pointer.
6607
df2a54e9 6608For machines where @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} can be nonzero, the use of these
03dda8e3
RK
6609patterns increases the number of functions for which the frame pointer
6610can be eliminated, if desired.
6611
6612@cindex @code{untyped_call} instruction pattern
6613@item @samp{untyped_call}
6614Subroutine call instruction returning a value of any type. Operand 0 is
6615the function to call; operand 1 is a memory location where the result of
6616calling the function is to be stored; operand 2 is a @code{parallel}
6617expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
6618the saving of a function return value into the result block.
6619
6620This instruction pattern should be defined to support
6621@code{__builtin_apply} on machines where special instructions are needed
6622to call a subroutine with arbitrary arguments or to save the value
6623returned. This instruction pattern is required on machines that have
e979f9e8
JM
6624multiple registers that can hold a return value
6625(i.e.@: @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} is true for more than one register).
03dda8e3
RK
6626
6627@cindex @code{return} instruction pattern
6628@item @samp{return}
6629Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
6630defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
6631from a function.
6632
6633Like the @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, this pattern is also used after the
6634RTL generation phase. In this case it is to support machines where
6635multiple instructions are usually needed to return from a function, but
6636some class of functions only requires one instruction to implement a
6637return. Normally, the applicable functions are those which do not need
6638to save any registers or allocate stack space.
6639
26898771
BS
6640It is valid for this pattern to expand to an instruction using
6641@code{simple_return} if no epilogue is required.
6642
6643@cindex @code{simple_return} instruction pattern
6644@item @samp{simple_return}
6645Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
6646defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
6647from a function on a path where no epilogue is required. This pattern
6648is very similar to the @code{return} instruction pattern, but it is emitted
6649only by the shrink-wrapping optimization on paths where the function
6650prologue has not been executed, and a function return should occur without
6651any of the effects of the epilogue. Additional uses may be introduced on
6652paths where both the prologue and the epilogue have executed.
6653
03dda8e3
RK
6654@findex reload_completed
6655@findex leaf_function_p
6656For such machines, the condition specified in this pattern should only
df2a54e9 6657be true when @code{reload_completed} is nonzero and the function's
03dda8e3
RK
6658epilogue would only be a single instruction. For machines with register
6659windows, the routine @code{leaf_function_p} may be used to determine if
6660a register window push is required.
6661
6662Machines that have conditional return instructions should define patterns
6663such as
6664
6665@smallexample
6666(define_insn ""
6667 [(set (pc)
6668 (if_then_else (match_operator
6669 0 "comparison_operator"
6670 [(cc0) (const_int 0)])
6671 (return)
6672 (pc)))]
6673 "@var{condition}"
6674 "@dots{}")
6675@end smallexample
6676
6677where @var{condition} would normally be the same condition specified on the
6678named @samp{return} pattern.
6679
6680@cindex @code{untyped_return} instruction pattern
6681@item @samp{untyped_return}
6682Untyped subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern should
6683be defined to support @code{__builtin_return} on machines where special
6684instructions are needed to return a value of any type.
6685
6686Operand 0 is a memory location where the result of calling a function
6687with @code{__builtin_apply} is stored; operand 1 is a @code{parallel}
6688expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
6689the restoring of a function return value from the result block.
6690
6691@cindex @code{nop} instruction pattern
6692@item @samp{nop}
6693No-op instruction. This instruction pattern name should always be defined
6694to output a no-op in assembler code. @code{(const_int 0)} will do as an
6695RTL pattern.
6696
6697@cindex @code{indirect_jump} instruction pattern
6698@item @samp{indirect_jump}
6699An instruction to jump to an address which is operand zero.
6700This pattern name is mandatory on all machines.
6701
6702@cindex @code{casesi} instruction pattern
6703@item @samp{casesi}
6704Instruction to jump through a dispatch table, including bounds checking.
6705This instruction takes five operands:
6706
6707@enumerate
6708@item
6709The index to dispatch on, which has mode @code{SImode}.
6710
6711@item
6712The lower bound for indices in the table, an integer constant.
6713
6714@item
6715The total range of indices in the table---the largest index
6716minus the smallest one (both inclusive).
6717
6718@item
6719A label that precedes the table itself.
6720
6721@item
6722A label to jump to if the index has a value outside the bounds.
03dda8e3
RK
6723@end enumerate
6724
e4ae5e77 6725The table is an @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec} inside of a
da5c6bde 6726@code{jump_table_data}. The number of elements in the table is one plus the
03dda8e3
RK
6727difference between the upper bound and the lower bound.
6728
6729@cindex @code{tablejump} instruction pattern
6730@item @samp{tablejump}
6731Instruction to jump to a variable address. This is a low-level
6732capability which can be used to implement a dispatch table when there
6733is no @samp{casesi} pattern.
6734
6735This pattern requires two operands: the address or offset, and a label
6736which should immediately precede the jump table. If the macro
f1f5f142
JL
6737@code{CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE} evaluates to a nonzero value then the first
6738operand is an offset which counts from the address of the table; otherwise,
6739it is an absolute address to jump to. In either case, the first operand has
03dda8e3
RK
6740mode @code{Pmode}.
6741
6742The @samp{tablejump} insn is always the last insn before the jump
6743table it uses. Its assembler code normally has no need to use the
6744second operand, but you should incorporate it in the RTL pattern so
6745that the jump optimizer will not delete the table as unreachable code.
6746
6e4fcc95 6747
6e4fcc95
MH
6748@cindex @code{doloop_end} instruction pattern
6749@item @samp{doloop_end}
1d0216c8
RS
6750Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and
6751jumps if the register is nonzero. Operand 0 is the register to
6752decrement and test; operand 1 is the label to jump to if the
6753register is nonzero.
5c25e11d 6754@xref{Looping Patterns}.
6e4fcc95
MH
6755
6756This optional instruction pattern should be defined for machines with
6757low-overhead looping instructions as the loop optimizer will try to
1d0216c8
RS
6758modify suitable loops to utilize it. The target hook
6759@code{TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P} controls the conditions under which
6760low-overhead loops can be used.
6e4fcc95
MH
6761
6762@cindex @code{doloop_begin} instruction pattern
6763@item @samp{doloop_begin}
6764Companion instruction to @code{doloop_end} required for machines that
1d0216c8
RS
6765need to perform some initialization, such as loading a special counter
6766register. Operand 1 is the associated @code{doloop_end} pattern and
6767operand 0 is the register that it decrements.
6e4fcc95 6768
1d0216c8
RS
6769If initialization insns do not always need to be emitted, use a
6770@code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) and make it fail.
6e4fcc95 6771
03dda8e3
RK
6772@cindex @code{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare} instruction pattern
6773@item @samp{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare}
6774Canonicalize the function pointer in operand 1 and store the result
6775into operand 0.
6776
6777Operand 0 is always a @code{reg} and has mode @code{Pmode}; operand 1
6778may be a @code{reg}, @code{mem}, @code{symbol_ref}, @code{const_int}, etc
6779and also has mode @code{Pmode}.
6780
6781Canonicalization of a function pointer usually involves computing
6782the address of the function which would be called if the function
6783pointer were used in an indirect call.
6784
6785Only define this pattern if function pointers on the target machine
6786can have different values but still call the same function when
6787used in an indirect call.
6788
6789@cindex @code{save_stack_block} instruction pattern
6790@cindex @code{save_stack_function} instruction pattern
6791@cindex @code{save_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
6792@cindex @code{restore_stack_block} instruction pattern
6793@cindex @code{restore_stack_function} instruction pattern
6794@cindex @code{restore_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
6795@item @samp{save_stack_block}
6796@itemx @samp{save_stack_function}
6797@itemx @samp{save_stack_nonlocal}
6798@itemx @samp{restore_stack_block}
6799@itemx @samp{restore_stack_function}
6800@itemx @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal}
6801Most machines save and restore the stack pointer by copying it to or
6802from an object of mode @code{Pmode}. Do not define these patterns on
6803such machines.
6804
6805Some machines require special handling for stack pointer saves and
6806restores. On those machines, define the patterns corresponding to the
6807non-standard cases by using a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander
6808Definitions}) that produces the required insns. The three types of
6809saves and restores are:
6810
6811@enumerate
6812@item
6813@samp{save_stack_block} saves the stack pointer at the start of a block
6814that allocates a variable-sized object, and @samp{restore_stack_block}
6815restores the stack pointer when the block is exited.
6816
6817@item
6818@samp{save_stack_function} and @samp{restore_stack_function} do a
6819similar job for the outermost block of a function and are used when the
6820function allocates variable-sized objects or calls @code{alloca}. Only
6821the epilogue uses the restored stack pointer, allowing a simpler save or
6822restore sequence on some machines.
6823
6824@item
6825@samp{save_stack_nonlocal} is used in functions that contain labels
6826branched to by nested functions. It saves the stack pointer in such a
6827way that the inner function can use @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} to
6828restore the stack pointer. The compiler generates code to restore the
6829frame and argument pointer registers, but some machines require saving
6830and restoring additional data such as register window information or
6831stack backchains. Place insns in these patterns to save and restore any
6832such required data.
6833@end enumerate
6834
6835When saving the stack pointer, operand 0 is the save area and operand 1
73c8090f
DE
6836is the stack pointer. The mode used to allocate the save area defaults
6837to @code{Pmode} but you can override that choice by defining the
7e390c9d 6838@code{STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE} macro (@pxref{Storage Layout}). You must
73c8090f
DE
6839specify an integral mode, or @code{VOIDmode} if no save area is needed
6840for a particular type of save (either because no save is needed or
6841because a machine-specific save area can be used). Operand 0 is the
6842stack pointer and operand 1 is the save area for restore operations. If
6843@samp{save_stack_block} is defined, operand 0 must not be
6844@code{VOIDmode} since these saves can be arbitrarily nested.
03dda8e3
RK
6845
6846A save area is a @code{mem} that is at a constant offset from
6847@code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx} when the stack pointer is saved for use by
6848nonlocal gotos and a @code{reg} in the other two cases.
6849
6850@cindex @code{allocate_stack} instruction pattern
6851@item @samp{allocate_stack}
72938a4c 6852Subtract (or add if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is undefined) operand 1 from
03dda8e3
RK
6853the stack pointer to create space for dynamically allocated data.
6854
72938a4c
MM
6855Store the resultant pointer to this space into operand 0. If you
6856are allocating space from the main stack, do this by emitting a
6857move insn to copy @code{virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx} to operand 0.
6858If you are allocating the space elsewhere, generate code to copy the
6859location of the space to operand 0. In the latter case, you must
956d6950 6860ensure this space gets freed when the corresponding space on the main
72938a4c
MM
6861stack is free.
6862
03dda8e3
RK
6863Do not define this pattern if all that must be done is the subtraction.
6864Some machines require other operations such as stack probes or
6865maintaining the back chain. Define this pattern to emit those
6866operations in addition to updating the stack pointer.
6867
861bb6c1
JL
6868@cindex @code{check_stack} instruction pattern
6869@item @samp{check_stack}
507d0069
EB
6870If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) cannot be done on your system by
6871probing the stack, define this pattern to perform the needed check and signal
6872an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the address in
6873the stack farthest from the current stack pointer that you need to validate.
6874Normally, on platforms where this pattern is needed, you would obtain the
6875stack limit from a global or thread-specific variable or register.
d809253a 6876
7b84aac0
EB
6877@cindex @code{probe_stack_address} instruction pattern
6878@item @samp{probe_stack_address}
6879If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
6880probing the stack but without the need to actually access it, define this
6881pattern and signal an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand
6882is the memory address in the stack that needs to be probed.
6883
d809253a
EB
6884@cindex @code{probe_stack} instruction pattern
6885@item @samp{probe_stack}
507d0069
EB
6886If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
6887probing the stack but doing it with a ``store zero'' instruction is not valid
6888or optimal, define this pattern to do the probing differently and signal an
6889error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the memory reference
6890in the stack that needs to be probed.
861bb6c1 6891
03dda8e3
RK
6892@cindex @code{nonlocal_goto} instruction pattern
6893@item @samp{nonlocal_goto}
6894Emit code to generate a non-local goto, e.g., a jump from one function
6895to a label in an outer function. This pattern has four arguments,
6896each representing a value to be used in the jump. The first
45bb86fd 6897argument is to be loaded into the frame pointer, the second is
03dda8e3
RK
6898the address to branch to (code to dispatch to the actual label),
6899the third is the address of a location where the stack is saved,
6900and the last is the address of the label, to be placed in the
6901location for the incoming static chain.
6902
f0523f02 6903On most machines you need not define this pattern, since GCC will
03dda8e3
RK
6904already generate the correct code, which is to load the frame pointer
6905and static chain, restore the stack (using the
6906@samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} pattern, if defined), and jump indirectly
6907to the dispatcher. You need only define this pattern if this code will
6908not work on your machine.
6909
6910@cindex @code{nonlocal_goto_receiver} instruction pattern
6911@item @samp{nonlocal_goto_receiver}
6912This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the target of a
161d7b59 6913nonlocal goto after the code already generated by GCC@. You will not
03dda8e3
RK
6914normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you might
6915need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global table,
c30ddbc9 6916must be restored when the frame pointer is restored. Note that a nonlocal
89bcce1b 6917goto only occurs within a unit-of-translation, so a global table pointer
c30ddbc9
RH
6918that is shared by all functions of a given module need not be restored.
6919There are no arguments.
861bb6c1
JL
6920
6921@cindex @code{exception_receiver} instruction pattern
6922@item @samp{exception_receiver}
6923This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of an
6924exception handler that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
6925will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
6926might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
6927table, must be restored after control flow is branched to the handler of
6928an exception. There are no arguments.
c85f7c16 6929
c30ddbc9
RH
6930@cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_setup} instruction pattern
6931@item @samp{builtin_setjmp_setup}
6932This pattern, if defined, contains additional code needed to initialize
6933the @code{jmp_buf}. You will not normally need to define this pattern.
6934A typical reason why you might need this pattern is if some value, such
6935as a pointer to a global table, must be restored. Though it is
6936preferred that the pointer value be recalculated if possible (given the
6937address of a label for instance). The single argument is a pointer to
6938the @code{jmp_buf}. Note that the buffer is five words long and that
6939the first three are normally used by the generic mechanism.
6940
c85f7c16
JL
6941@cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_receiver} instruction pattern
6942@item @samp{builtin_setjmp_receiver}
e4ae5e77 6943This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of a
c771326b 6944built-in setjmp that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
c85f7c16
JL
6945will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
6946might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
c30ddbc9 6947table, must be restored. It takes one argument, which is the label
073a8998 6948to which builtin_longjmp transferred control; this pattern may be emitted
c30ddbc9
RH
6949at a small offset from that label.
6950
6951@cindex @code{builtin_longjmp} instruction pattern
6952@item @samp{builtin_longjmp}
6953This pattern, if defined, performs the entire action of the longjmp.
6954You will not normally need to define this pattern unless you also define
6955@code{builtin_setjmp_setup}. The single argument is a pointer to the
6956@code{jmp_buf}.
f69864aa 6957
52a11cbf
RH
6958@cindex @code{eh_return} instruction pattern
6959@item @samp{eh_return}
f69864aa 6960This pattern, if defined, affects the way @code{__builtin_eh_return},
52a11cbf
RH
6961and thence the call frame exception handling library routines, are
6962built. It is intended to handle non-trivial actions needed along
6963the abnormal return path.
6964
34dc173c 6965The address of the exception handler to which the function should return
daf2f129 6966is passed as operand to this pattern. It will normally need to copied by
34dc173c
UW
6967the pattern to some special register or memory location.
6968If the pattern needs to determine the location of the target call
6969frame in order to do so, it may use @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX},
6970if defined; it will have already been assigned.
6971
6972If this pattern is not defined, the default action will be to simply
6973copy the return address to @code{EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX}. Either
6974that macro or this pattern needs to be defined if call frame exception
6975handling is to be used.
0b433de6
JL
6976
6977@cindex @code{prologue} instruction pattern
17b53c33 6978@anchor{prologue instruction pattern}
0b433de6
JL
6979@item @samp{prologue}
6980This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for entry to a function. The function
b192711e 6981entry is responsible for setting up the stack frame, initializing the frame
0b433de6
JL
6982pointer register, saving callee saved registers, etc.
6983
6984Using a prologue pattern is generally preferred over defining
17b53c33 6985@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} to emit assembly code for the prologue.
0b433de6
JL
6986
6987The @code{prologue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
6988instruction scheduling.
6989
12c5ffe5
EB
6990@cindex @code{window_save} instruction pattern
6991@anchor{window_save instruction pattern}
6992@item @samp{window_save}
6993This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for a register window save. It should
6994be defined if the target machine has register windows but the window events
6995are decoupled from calls to subroutines. The canonical example is the SPARC
6996architecture.
6997
0b433de6 6998@cindex @code{epilogue} instruction pattern
17b53c33 6999@anchor{epilogue instruction pattern}
0b433de6 7000@item @samp{epilogue}
396ad517 7001This pattern emits RTL for exit from a function. The function
b192711e 7002exit is responsible for deallocating the stack frame, restoring callee saved
0b433de6
JL
7003registers and emitting the return instruction.
7004
7005Using an epilogue pattern is generally preferred over defining
17b53c33 7006@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to emit assembly code for the epilogue.
0b433de6
JL
7007
7008The @code{epilogue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
7009instruction scheduling or which have delay slots for their return instruction.
7010
7011@cindex @code{sibcall_epilogue} instruction pattern
7012@item @samp{sibcall_epilogue}
7013This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for exit from a function without the final
7014branch back to the calling function. This pattern will be emitted before any
7015sibling call (aka tail call) sites.
7016
7017The @code{sibcall_epilogue} pattern must not clobber any arguments used for
7018parameter passing or any stack slots for arguments passed to the current
ebb48a4d 7019function.
a157febd
GK
7020
7021@cindex @code{trap} instruction pattern
7022@item @samp{trap}
7023This pattern, if defined, signals an error, typically by causing some
4b1ea1f3 7024kind of signal to be raised.
a157febd 7025
f90b7a5a
PB
7026@cindex @code{ctrap@var{MM}4} instruction pattern
7027@item @samp{ctrap@var{MM}4}
a157febd 7028Conditional trap instruction. Operand 0 is a piece of RTL which
f90b7a5a
PB
7029performs a comparison, and operands 1 and 2 are the arms of the
7030comparison. Operand 3 is the trap code, an integer.
a157febd 7031
f90b7a5a 7032A typical @code{ctrap} pattern looks like
a157febd
GK
7033
7034@smallexample
f90b7a5a 7035(define_insn "ctrapsi4"
ebb48a4d 7036 [(trap_if (match_operator 0 "trap_operator"
f90b7a5a 7037 [(match_operand 1 "register_operand")
73b8bfe1 7038 (match_operand 2 "immediate_operand")])
f90b7a5a 7039 (match_operand 3 "const_int_operand" "i"))]
a157febd
GK
7040 ""
7041 "@dots{}")
7042@end smallexample
7043
e83d297b
JJ
7044@cindex @code{prefetch} instruction pattern
7045@item @samp{prefetch}
e83d297b
JJ
7046This pattern, if defined, emits code for a non-faulting data prefetch
7047instruction. Operand 0 is the address of the memory to prefetch. Operand 1
7048is a constant 1 if the prefetch is preparing for a write to the memory
7049address, or a constant 0 otherwise. Operand 2 is the expected degree of
7050temporal locality of the data and is a value between 0 and 3, inclusive; 0
7051means that the data has no temporal locality, so it need not be left in the
7052cache after the access; 3 means that the data has a high degree of temporal
7053locality and should be left in all levels of cache possible; 1 and 2 mean,
7054respectively, a low or moderate degree of temporal locality.
7055
7056Targets that do not support write prefetches or locality hints can ignore
7057the values of operands 1 and 2.
7058
b6bd3371
DE
7059@cindex @code{blockage} instruction pattern
7060@item @samp{blockage}
b6bd3371 7061This pattern defines a pseudo insn that prevents the instruction
adddc347
HPN
7062scheduler and other passes from moving instructions and using register
7063equivalences across the boundary defined by the blockage insn.
7064This needs to be an UNSPEC_VOLATILE pattern or a volatile ASM.
b6bd3371 7065
51ced7e4
UB
7066@cindex @code{memory_blockage} instruction pattern
7067@item @samp{memory_blockage}
7068This pattern, if defined, represents a compiler memory barrier, and will be
7069placed at points across which RTL passes may not propagate memory accesses.
7070This instruction needs to read and write volatile BLKmode memory. It does
7071not need to generate any machine instruction. If this pattern is not defined,
7072the compiler falls back to emitting an instruction corresponding
7073to @code{asm volatile ("" ::: "memory")}.
7074
48ae6c13
RH
7075@cindex @code{memory_barrier} instruction pattern
7076@item @samp{memory_barrier}
48ae6c13
RH
7077If the target memory model is not fully synchronous, then this pattern
7078should be defined to an instruction that orders both loads and stores
7079before the instruction with respect to loads and stores after the instruction.
7080This pattern has no operands.
7081
425fc685
RE
7082@cindex @code{speculation_barrier} instruction pattern
7083@item @samp{speculation_barrier}
7084If the target can support speculative execution, then this pattern should
7085be defined to an instruction that will block subsequent execution until
7086any prior speculation conditions has been resolved. The pattern must also
7087ensure that the compiler cannot move memory operations past the barrier,
7088so it needs to be an UNSPEC_VOLATILE pattern. The pattern has no
7089operands.
7090
7091If this pattern is not defined then the default expansion of
7092@code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value} will emit a warning. You can
7093suppress this warning by defining this pattern with a final condition
7094of @code{0} (zero), which tells the compiler that a speculation
7095barrier is not needed for this target.
7096
48ae6c13
RH
7097@cindex @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7098@item @samp{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
48ae6c13
RH
7099This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
7100operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7101performed. Operand 2 is the ``old'' value to be compared against the
7102current contents of the memory location. Operand 3 is the ``new'' value
7103to store in the memory if the compare succeeds. Operand 0 is the result
915167f5
GK
7104of the operation; it should contain the contents of the memory
7105before the operation. If the compare succeeds, this should obviously be
7106a copy of operand 2.
48ae6c13
RH
7107
7108This pattern must show that both operand 0 and operand 1 are modified.
7109
915167f5
GK
7110This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7111memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7112operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7113after the atomic operation.
48ae6c13 7114
4a77c72b 7115For targets where the success or failure of the compare-and-swap
f90b7a5a
PB
7116operation is available via the status flags, it is possible to
7117avoid a separate compare operation and issue the subsequent
7118branch or store-flag operation immediately after the compare-and-swap.
7119To this end, GCC will look for a @code{MODE_CC} set in the
7120output of @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}; if the machine
7121description includes such a set, the target should also define special
7122@code{cbranchcc4} and/or @code{cstorecc4} instructions. GCC will then
7123be able to take the destination of the @code{MODE_CC} set and pass it
7124to the @code{cbranchcc4} or @code{cstorecc4} pattern as the first
7125operand of the comparison (the second will be @code{(const_int 0)}).
48ae6c13 7126
cedb4a1a
RH
7127For targets where the operating system may provide support for this
7128operation via library calls, the @code{sync_compare_and_swap_optab}
7129may be initialized to a function with the same interface as the
7130@code{__sync_val_compare_and_swap_@var{n}} built-in. If the entire
7131set of @var{__sync} builtins are supported via library calls, the
7132target can initialize all of the optabs at once with
7133@code{init_sync_libfuncs}.
7134For the purposes of C++11 @code{std::atomic::is_lock_free}, it is
7135assumed that these library calls do @emph{not} use any kind of
7136interruptable locking.
7137
48ae6c13
RH
7138@cindex @code{sync_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7139@cindex @code{sync_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7140@cindex @code{sync_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7141@cindex @code{sync_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7142@cindex @code{sync_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7143@cindex @code{sync_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7144@item @samp{sync_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_sub@var{mode}}
7145@itemx @samp{sync_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_and@var{mode}}
7146@itemx @samp{sync_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_nand@var{mode}}
48ae6c13
RH
7147These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory.
7148Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is performed.
7149Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7150
915167f5
GK
7151This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7152memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7153operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7154after the atomic operation.
48ae6c13
RH
7155
7156If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
7157from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7158
7159@cindex @code{sync_old_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7160@cindex @code{sync_old_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7161@cindex @code{sync_old_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7162@cindex @code{sync_old_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7163@cindex @code{sync_old_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7164@cindex @code{sync_old_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7165@item @samp{sync_old_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_sub@var{mode}}
7166@itemx @samp{sync_old_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_and@var{mode}}
7167@itemx @samp{sync_old_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_nand@var{mode}}
c29c1030 7168These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory,
48ae6c13
RH
7169and return the value that the memory contained before the operation.
7170Operand 0 is the result value, operand 1 is the memory on which the
7171atomic operation is performed, and operand 2 is the second operand
7172to the binary operator.
7173
915167f5
GK
7174This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7175memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7176operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7177after the atomic operation.
48ae6c13
RH
7178
7179If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
7180from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7181
7182@cindex @code{sync_new_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7183@cindex @code{sync_new_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7184@cindex @code{sync_new_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7185@cindex @code{sync_new_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7186@cindex @code{sync_new_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7187@cindex @code{sync_new_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7188@item @samp{sync_new_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_sub@var{mode}}
7189@itemx @samp{sync_new_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_and@var{mode}}
7190@itemx @samp{sync_new_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_nand@var{mode}}
48ae6c13
RH
7191These patterns are like their @code{sync_old_@var{op}} counterparts,
7192except that they return the value that exists in the memory location
7193after the operation, rather than before the operation.
7194
7195@cindex @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7196@item @samp{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}
48ae6c13
RH
7197This pattern takes two forms, based on the capabilities of the target.
7198In either case, operand 0 is the result of the operand, operand 1 is
7199the memory on which the atomic operation is performed, and operand 2
7200is the value to set in the lock.
7201
7202In the ideal case, this operation is an atomic exchange operation, in
7203which the previous value in memory operand is copied into the result
7204operand, and the value operand is stored in the memory operand.
7205
7206For less capable targets, any value operand that is not the constant 1
7207should be rejected with @code{FAIL}. In this case the target may use
7208an atomic test-and-set bit operation. The result operand should contain
72091 if the bit was previously set and 0 if the bit was previously clear.
7210The true contents of the memory operand are implementation defined.
7211
7212This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
915167f5
GK
7213pattern as a whole acts as an acquire barrier, that is all memory
7214operations after the pattern do not occur until the lock is acquired.
48ae6c13
RH
7215
7216If this pattern is not defined, the operation will be constructed from
7217a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7218
7219@cindex @code{sync_lock_release@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7220@item @samp{sync_lock_release@var{mode}}
48ae6c13
RH
7221This pattern, if defined, releases a lock set by
7222@code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}. Operand 0 is the memory
8635a919
GK
7223that contains the lock; operand 1 is the value to store in the lock.
7224
7225If the target doesn't implement full semantics for
7226@code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}, any value operand which is not
7227the constant 0 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}, and the true contents
7228of the memory operand are implementation defined.
48ae6c13
RH
7229
7230This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
915167f5
GK
7231pattern as a whole acts as a release barrier, that is the lock is
7232released only after all previous memory operations have completed.
48ae6c13
RH
7233
7234If this pattern is not defined, then a @code{memory_barrier} pattern
8635a919 7235will be emitted, followed by a store of the value to the memory operand.
48ae6c13 7236
86951993
AM
7237@cindex @code{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7238@item @samp{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
7239This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
7240operation with memory model semantics. Operand 2 is the memory on which
7241the atomic operation is performed. Operand 0 is an output operand which
7242is set to true or false based on whether the operation succeeded. Operand
72431 is an output operand which is set to the contents of the memory before
7244the operation was attempted. Operand 3 is the value that is expected to
7245be in memory. Operand 4 is the value to put in memory if the expected
7246value is found there. Operand 5 is set to 1 if this compare and swap is to
7247be treated as a weak operation. Operand 6 is the memory model to be used
7248if the operation is a success. Operand 7 is the memory model to be used
7249if the operation fails.
7250
7251If memory referred to in operand 2 contains the value in operand 3, then
7252operand 4 is stored in memory pointed to by operand 2 and fencing based on
7253the memory model in operand 6 is issued.
7254
7255If memory referred to in operand 2 does not contain the value in operand 3,
7256then fencing based on the memory model in operand 7 is issued.
7257
7258If a target does not support weak compare-and-swap operations, or the port
7259elects not to implement weak operations, the argument in operand 5 can be
7260ignored. Note a strong implementation must be provided.
7261
7262If this pattern is not provided, the @code{__atomic_compare_exchange}
7263built-in functions will utilize the legacy @code{sync_compare_and_swap}
7264pattern with an @code{__ATOMIC_SEQ_CST} memory model.
7265
7266@cindex @code{atomic_load@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7267@item @samp{atomic_load@var{mode}}
7268This pattern implements an atomic load operation with memory model
7269semantics. Operand 1 is the memory address being loaded from. Operand 0
7270is the result of the load. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
7271the load operation.
7272
7273If not present, the @code{__atomic_load} built-in function will either
7274resort to a normal load with memory barriers, or a compare-and-swap
7275operation if a normal load would not be atomic.
7276
7277@cindex @code{atomic_store@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7278@item @samp{atomic_store@var{mode}}
7279This pattern implements an atomic store operation with memory model
7280semantics. Operand 0 is the memory address being stored to. Operand 1
7281is the value to be written. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
7282the operation.
7283
7284If not present, the @code{__atomic_store} built-in function will attempt to
7285perform a normal store and surround it with any required memory fences. If
7286the store would not be atomic, then an @code{__atomic_exchange} is
7287attempted with the result being ignored.
7288
7289@cindex @code{atomic_exchange@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7290@item @samp{atomic_exchange@var{mode}}
7291This pattern implements an atomic exchange operation with memory model
7292semantics. Operand 1 is the memory location the operation is performed on.
7293Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to the original value contained
7294in the memory pointed to by operand 1. Operand 2 is the value to be
7295stored. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used.
7296
7297If this pattern is not present, the built-in function
7298@code{__atomic_exchange} will attempt to preform the operation with a
7299compare and swap loop.
7300
7301@cindex @code{atomic_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7302@cindex @code{atomic_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7303@cindex @code{atomic_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7304@cindex @code{atomic_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7305@cindex @code{atomic_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7306@cindex @code{atomic_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7307@item @samp{atomic_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub@var{mode}}
7308@itemx @samp{atomic_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and@var{mode}}
7309@itemx @samp{atomic_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand@var{mode}}
86951993
AM
7310These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7311model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7312performed. Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7313Operand 2 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7314
7315If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
c29c1030 7316@code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return a result. If
86951993
AM
7317none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be used.
7318
7319@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7320@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7321@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7322@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7323@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7324@cindex @code{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7325@item @samp{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}}
7326@itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}}
7327@itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}}
86951993
AM
7328These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7329model semantics, and return the original value. Operand 0 is an output
7330operand which contains the value of the memory location before the
7331operation was performed. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic
7332operation is performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary
7333operator. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7334
7335If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
7336@code{sync} patterns. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap
7337loop will be used.
7338
7339@cindex @code{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7340@cindex @code{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7341@cindex @code{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7342@cindex @code{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7343@cindex @code{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7344@cindex @code{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7345@item @samp{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}}
7346@itemx @samp{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}}
7347@itemx @samp{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}}
86951993
AM
7348These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7349model semantics and return the result after the operation is performed.
7350Operand 0 is an output operand which contains the value after the
7351operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7352performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7353Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7354
7355If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
c29c1030 7356@code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return the result before
86951993
AM
7357the operation followed by the arithmetic operation required to produce the
7358result. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be
7359used.
7360
f8a27aa6
RH
7361@cindex @code{atomic_test_and_set} instruction pattern
7362@item @samp{atomic_test_and_set}
f8a27aa6
RH
7363This pattern emits code for @code{__builtin_atomic_test_and_set}.
7364Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to true if the previous
7365previous contents of the byte was "set", and false otherwise. Operand 1
7366is the @code{QImode} memory to be modified. Operand 2 is the memory
7367model to be used.
7368
7369The specific value that defines "set" is implementation defined, and
7370is normally based on what is performed by the native atomic test and set
7371instruction.
7372
adedd5c1
JJ
7373@cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7374@cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7375@cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7376@item @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}}
7377@itemx @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}}
7378@itemx @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}}
7379These patterns emit code for an atomic bitwise operation on memory with memory
7380model semantics, and return the original value of the specified bit.
7381Operand 0 is an output operand which contains the value of the specified bit
7382from the memory location before the operation was performed. Operand 1 is the
7383memory on which the atomic operation is performed. Operand 2 is the bit within
7384the operand, starting with least significant bit. Operand 3 is the memory model
7385to be used by the operation. Operand 4 is a flag - it is @code{const1_rtx}
7386if operand 0 should contain the original value of the specified bit in the
7387least significant bit of the operand, and @code{const0_rtx} if the bit should
7388be in its original position in the operand.
7389@code{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}} atomically sets the specified bit after
7390remembering its original value, @code{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}}
7391inverts the specified bit and @code{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}} clears
7392the specified bit.
7393
7394If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use
7395@code{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}}, @code{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}} or
7396@code{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}} instruction patterns, or their @code{sync}
7397counterparts. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap
7398loop will be used.
7399
5e5ccf0d
AM
7400@cindex @code{mem_thread_fence} instruction pattern
7401@item @samp{mem_thread_fence}
86951993
AM
7402This pattern emits code required to implement a thread fence with
7403memory model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory model to be used.
7404
5e5ccf0d
AM
7405For the @code{__ATOMIC_RELAXED} model no instructions need to be issued
7406and this expansion is not invoked.
7407
7408The compiler always emits a compiler memory barrier regardless of what
7409expanding this pattern produced.
7410
7411If this pattern is not defined, the compiler falls back to expanding the
7412@code{memory_barrier} pattern, then to emitting @code{__sync_synchronize}
7413library call, and finally to just placing a compiler memory barrier.
86951993 7414
f959607b
CLT
7415@cindex @code{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7416@cindex @code{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7417@item @samp{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
7418@itemx @samp{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
7419These patterns emit code that reads/sets the TLS thread pointer. Currently,
7420these are only needed if the target needs to support the
7421@code{__builtin_thread_pointer} and @code{__builtin_set_thread_pointer}
7422builtins.
7423
7424The get/set patterns have a single output/input operand respectively,
7425with @var{mode} intended to be @code{Pmode}.
7426
7d69de61
RH
7427@cindex @code{stack_protect_set} instruction pattern
7428@item @samp{stack_protect_set}
a8b2130a
TP
7429This pattern, if defined, moves a @code{ptr_mode} value from the memory
7430in operand 1 to the memory in operand 0 without leaving the value in
7431a register afterward. This is to avoid leaking the value some place
7432that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot after
7433having clobbered it.
7d69de61
RH
7434
7435If this pattern is not defined, then a plain move pattern is generated.
7436
7437@cindex @code{stack_protect_test} instruction pattern
7438@item @samp{stack_protect_test}
643e867f 7439This pattern, if defined, compares a @code{ptr_mode} value from the
a8b2130a
TP
7440memory in operand 1 with the memory in operand 0 without leaving the
7441value in a register afterward and branches to operand 2 if the values
7442were equal.
7d69de61 7443
3aebbe5f
JJ
7444If this pattern is not defined, then a plain compare pattern and
7445conditional branch pattern is used.
7d69de61 7446
677feb77
DD
7447@cindex @code{clear_cache} instruction pattern
7448@item @samp{clear_cache}
677feb77
DD
7449This pattern, if defined, flushes the instruction cache for a region of
7450memory. The region is bounded to by the Pmode pointers in operand 0
7451inclusive and operand 1 exclusive.
7452
7453If this pattern is not defined, a call to the library function
7454@code{__clear_cache} is used.
7455
03dda8e3
RK
7456@end table
7457
a5249a21
HPN
7458@end ifset
7459@c Each of the following nodes are wrapped in separate
7460@c "@ifset INTERNALS" to work around memory limits for the default
7461@c configuration in older tetex distributions. Known to not work:
7462@c tetex-1.0.7, known to work: tetex-2.0.2.
7463@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
7464@node Pattern Ordering
7465@section When the Order of Patterns Matters
7466@cindex Pattern Ordering
7467@cindex Ordering of Patterns
7468
7469Sometimes an insn can match more than one instruction pattern. Then the
7470pattern that appears first in the machine description is the one used.
7471Therefore, more specific patterns (patterns that will match fewer things)
7472and faster instructions (those that will produce better code when they
7473do match) should usually go first in the description.
7474
7475In some cases the effect of ordering the patterns can be used to hide
7476a pattern when it is not valid. For example, the 68000 has an
7477instruction for converting a fullword to floating point and another
7478for converting a byte to floating point. An instruction converting
7479an integer to floating point could match either one. We put the
7480pattern to convert the fullword first to make sure that one will
7481be used rather than the other. (Otherwise a large integer might
7482be generated as a single-byte immediate quantity, which would not work.)
7483Instead of using this pattern ordering it would be possible to make the
7484pattern for convert-a-byte smart enough to deal properly with any
7485constant value.
7486
a5249a21
HPN
7487@end ifset
7488@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
7489@node Dependent Patterns
7490@section Interdependence of Patterns
7491@cindex Dependent Patterns
7492@cindex Interdependence of Patterns
7493
03dda8e3
RK
7494In some cases machines support instructions identical except for the
7495machine mode of one or more operands. For example, there may be
7496``sign-extend halfword'' and ``sign-extend byte'' instructions whose
7497patterns are
7498
3ab51846 7499@smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7500(set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
7501 (extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 @dots{})))
7502
7503(set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
7504 (extend:SI (match_operand:QI 1 @dots{})))
3ab51846 7505@end smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7506
7507@noindent
7508Constant integers do not specify a machine mode, so an instruction to
7509extend a constant value could match either pattern. The pattern it
7510actually will match is the one that appears first in the file. For correct
7511results, this must be the one for the widest possible mode (@code{HImode},
7512here). If the pattern matches the @code{QImode} instruction, the results
7513will be incorrect if the constant value does not actually fit that mode.
7514
7515Such instructions to extend constants are rarely generated because they are
7516optimized away, but they do occasionally happen in nonoptimized
7517compilations.
7518
7519If a constraint in a pattern allows a constant, the reload pass may
7520replace a register with a constant permitted by the constraint in some
7521cases. Similarly for memory references. Because of this substitution,
7522you should not provide separate patterns for increment and decrement
7523instructions. Instead, they should be generated from the same pattern
7524that supports register-register add insns by examining the operands and
7525generating the appropriate machine instruction.
7526
a5249a21
HPN
7527@end ifset
7528@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
7529@node Jump Patterns
7530@section Defining Jump Instruction Patterns
7531@cindex jump instruction patterns
7532@cindex defining jump instruction patterns
7533
f90b7a5a
PB
7534GCC does not assume anything about how the machine realizes jumps.
7535The machine description should define a single pattern, usually
7536a @code{define_expand}, which expands to all the required insns.
7537
7538Usually, this would be a comparison insn to set the condition code
7539and a separate branch insn testing the condition code and branching
7540or not according to its value. For many machines, however,
7541separating compares and branches is limiting, which is why the
7542more flexible approach with one @code{define_expand} is used in GCC.
7543The machine description becomes clearer for architectures that
7544have compare-and-branch instructions but no condition code. It also
7545works better when different sets of comparison operators are supported
7546by different kinds of conditional branches (e.g. integer vs. floating-point),
7547or by conditional branches with respect to conditional stores.
7548
7549Two separate insns are always used if the machine description represents
7550a condition code register using the legacy RTL expression @code{(cc0)},
7551and on most machines that use a separate condition code register
7552(@pxref{Condition Code}). For machines that use @code{(cc0)}, in
7553fact, the set and use of the condition code must be separate and
7554adjacent@footnote{@code{note} insns can separate them, though.}, thus
7555allowing flags in @code{cc_status} to be used (@pxref{Condition Code}) and
7556so that the comparison and branch insns could be located from each other
7557by using the functions @code{prev_cc0_setter} and @code{next_cc0_user}.
7558
7559Even in this case having a single entry point for conditional branches
7560is advantageous, because it handles equally well the case where a single
7561comparison instruction records the results of both signed and unsigned
7562comparison of the given operands (with the branch insns coming in distinct
7563signed and unsigned flavors) as in the x86 or SPARC, and the case where
7564there are distinct signed and unsigned compare instructions and only
7565one set of conditional branch instructions as in the PowerPC.
03dda8e3 7566
a5249a21
HPN
7567@end ifset
7568@ifset INTERNALS
6e4fcc95
MH
7569@node Looping Patterns
7570@section Defining Looping Instruction Patterns
7571@cindex looping instruction patterns
7572@cindex defining looping instruction patterns
7573
05713b80 7574Some machines have special jump instructions that can be utilized to
6e4fcc95
MH
7575make loops more efficient. A common example is the 68000 @samp{dbra}
7576instruction which performs a decrement of a register and a branch if the
7577result was greater than zero. Other machines, in particular digital
7578signal processors (DSPs), have special block repeat instructions to
7579provide low-overhead loop support. For example, the TI TMS320C3x/C4x
7580DSPs have a block repeat instruction that loads special registers to
7581mark the top and end of a loop and to count the number of loop
7582iterations. This avoids the need for fetching and executing a
c771326b 7583@samp{dbra}-like instruction and avoids pipeline stalls associated with
6e4fcc95
MH
7584the jump.
7585
f9adcdec
PK
7586GCC has two special named patterns to support low overhead looping.
7587They are @samp{doloop_begin} and @samp{doloop_end}. These are emitted
7588by the loop optimizer for certain well-behaved loops with a finite
7589number of loop iterations using information collected during strength
7590reduction.
6e4fcc95
MH
7591
7592The @samp{doloop_end} pattern describes the actual looping instruction
7593(or the implicit looping operation) and the @samp{doloop_begin} pattern
c21cd8b1 7594is an optional companion pattern that can be used for initialization
6e4fcc95
MH
7595needed for some low-overhead looping instructions.
7596
7597Note that some machines require the actual looping instruction to be
7598emitted at the top of the loop (e.g., the TMS320C3x/C4x DSPs). Emitting
7599the true RTL for a looping instruction at the top of the loop can cause
7600problems with flow analysis. So instead, a dummy @code{doloop} insn is
7601emitted at the end of the loop. The machine dependent reorg pass checks
7602for the presence of this @code{doloop} insn and then searches back to
7603the top of the loop, where it inserts the true looping insn (provided
7604there are no instructions in the loop which would cause problems). Any
7605additional labels can be emitted at this point. In addition, if the
7606desired special iteration counter register was not allocated, this
7607machine dependent reorg pass could emit a traditional compare and jump
7608instruction pair.
7609
f9adcdec
PK
7610For the @samp{doloop_end} pattern, the loop optimizer allocates an
7611additional pseudo register as an iteration counter. This pseudo
7612register cannot be used within the loop (i.e., general induction
7613variables cannot be derived from it), however, in many cases the loop
7614induction variable may become redundant and removed by the flow pass.
7615
7616The @samp{doloop_end} pattern must have a specific structure to be
7617handled correctly by GCC. The example below is taken (slightly
7618simplified) from the PDP-11 target:
7619
7620@smallexample
7621@group
7622(define_insn "doloop_end"
7623 [(set (pc)
7624 (if_then_else
7625 (ne (match_operand:HI 0 "nonimmediate_operand" "+r,!m")
7626 (const_int 1))
7627 (label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
7628 (pc)))
7629 (set (match_dup 0)
7630 (plus:HI (match_dup 0)
7631 (const_int -1)))]
7632 ""
7633
7634 @{
7635 if (which_alternative == 0)
7636 return "sob %0,%l1";
7637
7638 /* emulate sob */
7639 output_asm_insn ("dec %0", operands);
7640 return "bne %l1";
7641 @})
7642@end group
7643@end smallexample
7644
7645The first part of the pattern describes the branch condition. GCC
7646supports three cases for the way the target machine handles the loop
7647counter:
7648@itemize @bullet
7649@item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to zero. This
7650is represented by a @code{ne} comparison of the register (its old value)
7651with constant 1 (as in the example above).
7652@item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to @minus{}1.
7653This is represented by a @code{ne} comparison of the register with
7654constant zero.
7655@item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to a negative
7656value. This is represented by a @code{ge} comparison of the register
7657with constant zero. For this case, GCC will attach a @code{REG_NONNEG}
7658note to the @code{doloop_end} insn if it can determine that the register
7659will be non-negative.
7660@end itemize
6e4fcc95 7661
f9adcdec
PK
7662Since the @code{doloop_end} insn is a jump insn that also has an output,
7663the reload pass does not handle the output operand. Therefore, the
7664constraint must allow for that operand to be in memory rather than a
7665register. In the example shown above, that is handled by using a loop
7666instruction sequence that can handle memory operands when the memory
7667alternative appears.
6e4fcc95 7668
a5249a21
HPN
7669@end ifset
7670@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
7671@node Insn Canonicalizations
7672@section Canonicalization of Instructions
7673@cindex canonicalization of instructions
7674@cindex insn canonicalization
7675
7676There are often cases where multiple RTL expressions could represent an
7677operation performed by a single machine instruction. This situation is
7678most commonly encountered with logical, branch, and multiply-accumulate
7679instructions. In such cases, the compiler attempts to convert these
7680multiple RTL expressions into a single canonical form to reduce the
7681number of insn patterns required.
7682
7683In addition to algebraic simplifications, following canonicalizations
7684are performed:
7685
7686@itemize @bullet
7687@item
7688For commutative and comparison operators, a constant is always made the
7689second operand. If a machine only supports a constant as the second
7690operand, only patterns that match a constant in the second operand need
7691be supplied.
7692
e3d6e740
GK
7693@item
7694For associative operators, a sequence of operators will always chain
7695to the left; for instance, only the left operand of an integer @code{plus}
7696can itself be a @code{plus}. @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor},
7697@code{plus}, @code{mult}, @code{smin}, @code{smax}, @code{umin}, and
7698@code{umax} are associative when applied to integers, and sometimes to
7699floating-point.
7700
7701@item
03dda8e3
RK
7702@cindex @code{neg}, canonicalization of
7703@cindex @code{not}, canonicalization of
7704@cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
7705@cindex @code{plus}, canonicalization of
7706@cindex @code{minus}, canonicalization of
7707For these operators, if only one operand is a @code{neg}, @code{not},
7708@code{mult}, @code{plus}, or @code{minus} expression, it will be the
7709first operand.
7710
16823694
GK
7711@item
7712In combinations of @code{neg}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, and
7713@code{minus}, the @code{neg} operations (if any) will be moved inside
daf2f129 7714the operations as far as possible. For instance,
16823694 7715@code{(neg (mult A B))} is canonicalized as @code{(mult (neg A) B)}, but
9302a061 7716@code{(plus (mult (neg B) C) A)} is canonicalized as
16823694
GK
7717@code{(minus A (mult B C))}.
7718
03dda8e3
RK
7719@cindex @code{compare}, canonicalization of
7720@item
7721For the @code{compare} operator, a constant is always the second operand
f90b7a5a 7722if the first argument is a condition code register or @code{(cc0)}.
03dda8e3 7723
81ad201a
UB
7724@item
7725For instructions that inherently set a condition code register, the
7726@code{compare} operator is always written as the first RTL expression of
7727the @code{parallel} instruction pattern. For example,
7728
7729@smallexample
7730(define_insn ""
7731 [(set (reg:CCZ FLAGS_REG)
7732 (compare:CCZ
7733 (plus:SI
7734 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "%r")
7735 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))
7736 (const_int 0)))
7737 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
7738 (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
7739 ""
7740 "addl %0, %1, %2")
7741@end smallexample
7742
f90b7a5a 7743@item
03dda8e3
RK
7744An operand of @code{neg}, @code{not}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or
7745@code{minus} is made the first operand under the same conditions as
7746above.
7747
921c4418
RIL
7748@item
7749@code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{b})} is converted to
7750@code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{a})}. Likewise with @code{geu} instead
7751of @code{ltu}.
7752
03dda8e3
RK
7753@item
7754@code{(minus @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))} is converted to
7755@code{(plus @var{x} (const_int @var{-n}))}.
7756
7757@item
7758Within address computations (i.e., inside @code{mem}), a left shift is
7759converted into the appropriate multiplication by a power of two.
7760
7761@cindex @code{ior}, canonicalization of
7762@cindex @code{and}, canonicalization of
7763@cindex De Morgan's law
72938a4c 7764@item
090359d6 7765De Morgan's Law is used to move bitwise negation inside a bitwise
03dda8e3
RK
7766logical-and or logical-or operation. If this results in only one
7767operand being a @code{not} expression, it will be the first one.
7768
7769A machine that has an instruction that performs a bitwise logical-and of one
7770operand with the bitwise negation of the other should specify the pattern
7771for that instruction as
7772
3ab51846 7773@smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7774(define_insn ""
7775 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
7776 (and:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
7777 (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{})))]
7778 "@dots{}"
7779 "@dots{}")
3ab51846 7780@end smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7781
7782@noindent
7783Similarly, a pattern for a ``NAND'' instruction should be written
7784
3ab51846 7785@smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7786(define_insn ""
7787 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
7788 (ior:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
7789 (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{}))))]
7790 "@dots{}"
7791 "@dots{}")
3ab51846 7792@end smallexample
03dda8e3
RK
7793
7794In both cases, it is not necessary to include patterns for the many
7795logically equivalent RTL expressions.
7796
7797@cindex @code{xor}, canonicalization of
7798@item
7799The only possible RTL expressions involving both bitwise exclusive-or
7800and bitwise negation are @code{(xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y})}
bd819a4a 7801and @code{(not:@var{m} (xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}))}.
03dda8e3
RK
7802
7803@item
7804The sum of three items, one of which is a constant, will only appear in
7805the form
7806
3ab51846 7807@smallexample
03dda8e3 7808(plus:@var{m} (plus:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}) @var{constant})
3ab51846 7809@end smallexample
03dda8e3 7810
03dda8e3
RK
7811@cindex @code{zero_extract}, canonicalization of
7812@cindex @code{sign_extract}, canonicalization of
7813@item
7814Equality comparisons of a group of bits (usually a single bit) with zero
7815will be written using @code{zero_extract} rather than the equivalent
7816@code{and} or @code{sign_extract} operations.
7817
c536876e
AS
7818@cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
7819@item
7820@code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{x})
7821(sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted to @code{(mult:@var{m1}
7822(sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{x}) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise
7823for @code{zero_extend}.
7824
7825@item
7826@code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
7827@var{x} @var{s}) (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted
7828to @code{(mult:@var{m1} (sign_extend:@var{m1} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
7829@var{x} @var{s})) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise for
7830patterns using @code{zero_extend} and @code{lshiftrt}. If the second
7831operand of @code{mult} is also a shift, then that is extended also.
7832This transformation is only applied when it can be proven that the
7833original operation had sufficient precision to prevent overflow.
7834
03dda8e3
RK
7835@end itemize
7836
cd16503a
HPN
7837Further canonicalization rules are defined in the function
7838@code{commutative_operand_precedence} in @file{gcc/rtlanal.c}.
7839
a5249a21
HPN
7840@end ifset
7841@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
7842@node Expander Definitions
7843@section Defining RTL Sequences for Code Generation
7844@cindex expander definitions
7845@cindex code generation RTL sequences
7846@cindex defining RTL sequences for code generation
7847
7848On some target machines, some standard pattern names for RTL generation
7849cannot be handled with single insn, but a sequence of RTL insns can
7850represent them. For these target machines, you can write a
161d7b59 7851@code{define_expand} to specify how to generate the sequence of RTL@.
03dda8e3
RK
7852
7853@findex define_expand
7854A @code{define_expand} is an RTL expression that looks almost like a
7855@code{define_insn}; but, unlike the latter, a @code{define_expand} is used
7856only for RTL generation and it can produce more than one RTL insn.
7857
7858A @code{define_expand} RTX has four operands:
7859
7860@itemize @bullet
7861@item
7862The name. Each @code{define_expand} must have a name, since the only
7863use for it is to refer to it by name.
7864
03dda8e3 7865@item
f3a3d0d3
RH
7866The RTL template. This is a vector of RTL expressions representing
7867a sequence of separate instructions. Unlike @code{define_insn}, there
7868is no implicit surrounding @code{PARALLEL}.
03dda8e3
RK
7869
7870@item
7871The condition, a string containing a C expression. This expression is
7872used to express how the availability of this pattern depends on
f0523f02
JM
7873subclasses of target machine, selected by command-line options when GCC
7874is run. This is just like the condition of a @code{define_insn} that
03dda8e3
RK
7875has a standard name. Therefore, the condition (if present) may not
7876depend on the data in the insn being matched, but only the
7877target-machine-type flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions
7878during initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions
7879are available in a particular run.
7880
7881@item
7882The preparation statements, a string containing zero or more C
7883statements which are to be executed before RTL code is generated from
7884the RTL template.
7885
7886Usually these statements prepare temporary registers for use as
7887internal operands in the RTL template, but they can also generate RTL
7888insns directly by calling routines such as @code{emit_insn}, etc.
7889Any such insns precede the ones that come from the RTL template.
477c104e
MK
7890
7891@item
7892Optionally, a vector containing the values of attributes. @xref{Insn
7893Attributes}.
03dda8e3
RK
7894@end itemize
7895
7896Every RTL insn emitted by a @code{define_expand} must match some
7897@code{define_insn} in the machine description. Otherwise, the compiler
7898will crash when trying to generate code for the insn or trying to optimize
7899it.
7900
7901The RTL template, in addition to controlling generation of RTL insns,
7902also describes the operands that need to be specified when this pattern
7903is used. In particular, it gives a predicate for each operand.
7904
7905A true operand, which needs to be specified in order to generate RTL from
7906the pattern, should be described with a @code{match_operand} in its first
7907occurrence in the RTL template. This enters information on the operand's
f0523f02 7908predicate into the tables that record such things. GCC uses the
03dda8e3
RK
7909information to preload the operand into a register if that is required for
7910valid RTL code. If the operand is referred to more than once, subsequent
7911references should use @code{match_dup}.
7912
7913The RTL template may also refer to internal ``operands'' which are
7914temporary registers or labels used only within the sequence made by the
7915@code{define_expand}. Internal operands are substituted into the RTL
7916template with @code{match_dup}, never with @code{match_operand}. The
7917values of the internal operands are not passed in as arguments by the
7918compiler when it requests use of this pattern. Instead, they are computed
7919within the pattern, in the preparation statements. These statements
7920compute the values and store them into the appropriate elements of
7921@code{operands} so that @code{match_dup} can find them.
7922
7923There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
7924@code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
7925as a statement.
7926
7927@table @code
7928
7929@findex DONE
7930@item DONE
7931Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the pattern. The
7932only RTL insns resulting from the pattern on this occasion will be
7933those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within the
7934preparation statements; the RTL template will not be generated.
7935
7936@findex FAIL
7937@item FAIL
7938Make the pattern fail on this occasion. When a pattern fails, it means
7939that the pattern was not truly available. The calling routines in the
7940compiler will try other strategies for code generation using other patterns.
7941
7942Failure is currently supported only for binary (addition, multiplication,
c771326b 7943shifting, etc.) and bit-field (@code{extv}, @code{extzv}, and @code{insv})
03dda8e3
RK
7944operations.
7945@end table
7946
55e4756f
DD
7947If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
7948@code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_expand} acts like a
7949@code{define_insn} in that the RTL template is used to generate the
7950insn.
7951
7952The RTL template is not used for matching, only for generating the
7953initial insn list. If the preparation statement always invokes
7954@code{DONE} or @code{FAIL}, the RTL template may be reduced to a simple
7955list of operands, such as this example:
7956
7957@smallexample
7958@group
7959(define_expand "addsi3"
7960 [(match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7961 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
7962 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "")]
7963@end group
7964@group
7965 ""
7966 "
58097133 7967@{
55e4756f
DD
7968 handle_add (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2]);
7969 DONE;
58097133 7970@}")
55e4756f
DD
7971@end group
7972@end smallexample
7973
03dda8e3
RK
7974Here is an example, the definition of left-shift for the SPUR chip:
7975
7976@smallexample
7977@group
7978(define_expand "ashlsi3"
7979 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7980 (ashift:SI
7981@end group
7982@group
7983 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
7984 (match_operand:SI 2 "nonmemory_operand" "")))]
7985 ""
7986 "
7987@end group
7988@end smallexample
7989
7990@smallexample
7991@group
7992@{
7993 if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) != CONST_INT
7994 || (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) > 3)
7995 FAIL;
7996@}")
7997@end group
7998@end smallexample
7999
8000@noindent
8001This example uses @code{define_expand} so that it can generate an RTL insn
8002for shifting when the shift-count is in the supported range of 0 to 3 but
8003fail in other cases where machine insns aren't available. When it fails,
8004the compiler tries another strategy using different patterns (such as, a
8005library call).
8006
8007If the compiler were able to handle nontrivial condition-strings in
8008patterns with names, then it would be possible to use a
8009@code{define_insn} in that case. Here is another case (zero-extension
8010on the 68000) which makes more use of the power of @code{define_expand}:
8011
8012@smallexample
8013(define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
8014 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "")
8015 (const_int 0))
8016 (set (strict_low_part
8017 (subreg:HI
8018 (match_dup 0)
8019 0))
8020 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" ""))]
8021 ""
8022 "operands[1] = make_safe_from (operands[1], operands[0]);")
8023@end smallexample
8024
8025@noindent
8026@findex make_safe_from
8027Here two RTL insns are generated, one to clear the entire output operand
8028and the other to copy the input operand into its low half. This sequence
8029is incorrect if the input operand refers to [the old value of] the output
8030operand, so the preparation statement makes sure this isn't so. The
8031function @code{make_safe_from} copies the @code{operands[1]} into a
8032temporary register if it refers to @code{operands[0]}. It does this
8033by emitting another RTL insn.
8034
8035Finally, a third example shows the use of an internal operand.
8036Zero-extension on the SPUR chip is done by @code{and}-ing the result
8037against a halfword mask. But this mask cannot be represented by a
8038@code{const_int} because the constant value is too large to be legitimate
8039on this machine. So it must be copied into a register with
8040@code{force_reg} and then the register used in the @code{and}.
8041
8042@smallexample
8043(define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
8044 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
8045 (and:SI (subreg:SI
8046 (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "")
8047 0)
8048 (match_dup 2)))]
8049 ""
8050 "operands[2]
3a598fbe 8051 = force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (65535)); ")
03dda8e3
RK
8052@end smallexample
8053
f4559287 8054@emph{Note:} If the @code{define_expand} is used to serve a
c771326b 8055standard binary or unary arithmetic operation or a bit-field operation,
03dda8e3
RK
8056then the last insn it generates must not be a @code{code_label},
8057@code{barrier} or @code{note}. It must be an @code{insn},
8058@code{jump_insn} or @code{call_insn}. If you don't need a real insn
8059at the end, emit an insn to copy the result of the operation into
8060itself. Such an insn will generate no code, but it can avoid problems
bd819a4a 8061in the compiler.
03dda8e3 8062
a5249a21
HPN
8063@end ifset
8064@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
8065@node Insn Splitting
8066@section Defining How to Split Instructions
8067@cindex insn splitting
8068@cindex instruction splitting
8069@cindex splitting instructions
8070
fae15c93
VM
8071There are two cases where you should specify how to split a pattern
8072into multiple insns. On machines that have instructions requiring
8073delay slots (@pxref{Delay Slots}) or that have instructions whose
8074output is not available for multiple cycles (@pxref{Processor pipeline
8075description}), the compiler phases that optimize these cases need to
8076be able to move insns into one-instruction delay slots. However, some
8077insns may generate more than one machine instruction. These insns
8078cannot be placed into a delay slot.
03dda8e3
RK
8079
8080Often you can rewrite the single insn as a list of individual insns,
8081each corresponding to one machine instruction. The disadvantage of
8082doing so is that it will cause the compilation to be slower and require
8083more space. If the resulting insns are too complex, it may also
8084suppress some optimizations. The compiler splits the insn if there is a
8085reason to believe that it might improve instruction or delay slot
8086scheduling.
8087
8088The insn combiner phase also splits putative insns. If three insns are
8089merged into one insn with a complex expression that cannot be matched by
8090some @code{define_insn} pattern, the combiner phase attempts to split
8091the complex pattern into two insns that are recognized. Usually it can
8092break the complex pattern into two patterns by splitting out some
8093subexpression. However, in some other cases, such as performing an
8094addition of a large constant in two insns on a RISC machine, the way to
8095split the addition into two insns is machine-dependent.
8096
f3a3d0d3 8097@findex define_split
03dda8e3
RK
8098The @code{define_split} definition tells the compiler how to split a
8099complex insn into several simpler insns. It looks like this:
8100
8101@smallexample
8102(define_split
8103 [@var{insn-pattern}]
8104 "@var{condition}"
8105 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
8106 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
8107 @dots{}]
630d3d5a 8108 "@var{preparation-statements}")
03dda8e3
RK
8109@end smallexample
8110
8111@var{insn-pattern} is a pattern that needs to be split and
8112@var{condition} is the final condition to be tested, as in a
8113@code{define_insn}. When an insn matching @var{insn-pattern} and
8114satisfying @var{condition} is found, it is replaced in the insn list
8115with the insns given by @var{new-insn-pattern-1},
8116@var{new-insn-pattern-2}, etc.
8117
630d3d5a 8118The @var{preparation-statements} are similar to those statements that
03dda8e3
RK
8119are specified for @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
8120and are executed before the new RTL is generated to prepare for the
8121generated code or emit some insns whose pattern is not fixed. Unlike
8122those in @code{define_expand}, however, these statements must not
8123generate any new pseudo-registers. Once reload has completed, they also
8124must not allocate any space in the stack frame.
8125
582d1f90
PK
8126There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
8127@code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
8128as a statement.
8129
8130@table @code
8131
8132@findex DONE
8133@item DONE
8134Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the splitter. The
8135only RTL insns generated as replacement for the matched input insn will
8136be those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within
8137the preparation statements; the replacement pattern is not used.
8138
8139@findex FAIL
8140@item FAIL
8141Make the @code{define_split} fail on this occasion. When a @code{define_split}
8142fails, it means that the splitter was not truly available for the inputs
8143it was given, and the input insn will not be split.
8144@end table
8145
8146If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
8147@code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_split} uses the replacement
8148template.
8149
03dda8e3
RK
8150Patterns are matched against @var{insn-pattern} in two different
8151circumstances. If an insn needs to be split for delay slot scheduling
8152or insn scheduling, the insn is already known to be valid, which means
8153that it must have been matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
df2a54e9 8154@code{reload_completed} is nonzero, is known to satisfy the constraints
03dda8e3
RK
8155of that @code{define_insn}. In that case, the new insn patterns must
8156also be insns that are matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
df2a54e9 8157@code{reload_completed} is nonzero, must also satisfy the constraints
03dda8e3
RK
8158of those definitions.
8159
8160As an example of this usage of @code{define_split}, consider the following
8161example from @file{a29k.md}, which splits a @code{sign_extend} from
8162@code{HImode} to @code{SImode} into a pair of shift insns:
8163
8164@smallexample
8165(define_split
8166 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8167 (sign_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")))]
8168 ""
8169 [(set (match_dup 0)
8170 (ashift:SI (match_dup 1)
8171 (const_int 16)))
8172 (set (match_dup 0)
8173 (ashiftrt:SI (match_dup 0)
8174 (const_int 16)))]
8175 "
8176@{ operands[1] = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[1]); @}")
8177@end smallexample
8178
8179When the combiner phase tries to split an insn pattern, it is always the
8180case that the pattern is @emph{not} matched by any @code{define_insn}.
8181The combiner pass first tries to split a single @code{set} expression
8182and then the same @code{set} expression inside a @code{parallel}, but
8183followed by a @code{clobber} of a pseudo-reg to use as a scratch
8184register. In these cases, the combiner expects exactly two new insn
8185patterns to be generated. It will verify that these patterns match some
8186@code{define_insn} definitions, so you need not do this test in the
8187@code{define_split} (of course, there is no point in writing a
8188@code{define_split} that will never produce insns that match).
8189
8190Here is an example of this use of @code{define_split}, taken from
8191@file{rs6000.md}:
8192
8193@smallexample
8194(define_split
8195 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8196 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8197 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_add_cint_operand" "")))]
8198 ""
8199 [(set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 3)))
8200 (set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4)))]
8201"
8202@{
8203 int low = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 0xffff;
8204 int high = (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) >> 16;
8205
8206 if (low & 0x8000)
8207 high++, low |= 0xffff0000;
8208
3a598fbe
JL
8209 operands[3] = GEN_INT (high << 16);
8210 operands[4] = GEN_INT (low);
03dda8e3
RK
8211@}")
8212@end smallexample
8213
8214Here the predicate @code{non_add_cint_operand} matches any
8215@code{const_int} that is @emph{not} a valid operand of a single add
8216insn. The add with the smaller displacement is written so that it
8217can be substituted into the address of a subsequent operation.
8218
8219An example that uses a scratch register, from the same file, generates
8220an equality comparison of a register and a large constant:
8221
8222@smallexample
8223(define_split
8224 [(set (match_operand:CC 0 "cc_reg_operand" "")
8225 (compare:CC (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8226 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_short_cint_operand" "")))
8227 (clobber (match_operand:SI 3 "gen_reg_operand" ""))]
8228 "find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)
8229 && (GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == EQ
8230 || GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == NE)"
8231 [(set (match_dup 3) (xor:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 4)))
8232 (set (match_dup 0) (compare:CC (match_dup 3) (match_dup 5)))]
8233 "
8234@{
12bcfaa1 8235 /* @r{Get the constant we are comparing against, C, and see what it
03dda8e3 8236 looks like sign-extended to 16 bits. Then see what constant
12bcfaa1 8237 could be XOR'ed with C to get the sign-extended value.} */
03dda8e3
RK
8238
8239 int c = INTVAL (operands[2]);
8240 int sextc = (c << 16) >> 16;
8241 int xorv = c ^ sextc;
8242
3a598fbe
JL
8243 operands[4] = GEN_INT (xorv);
8244 operands[5] = GEN_INT (sextc);
03dda8e3
RK
8245@}")
8246@end smallexample
8247
8248To avoid confusion, don't write a single @code{define_split} that
8249accepts some insns that match some @code{define_insn} as well as some
8250insns that don't. Instead, write two separate @code{define_split}
8251definitions, one for the insns that are valid and one for the insns that
8252are not valid.
8253
6b24c259
JH
8254The splitter is allowed to split jump instructions into sequence of
8255jumps or create new jumps in while splitting non-jump instructions. As
d5f9df6a 8256the control flow graph and branch prediction information needs to be updated,
f282ffb3 8257several restriction apply.
6b24c259
JH
8258
8259Splitting of jump instruction into sequence that over by another jump
c21cd8b1 8260instruction is always valid, as compiler expect identical behavior of new
6b24c259
JH
8261jump. When new sequence contains multiple jump instructions or new labels,
8262more assistance is needed. Splitter is required to create only unconditional
8263jumps, or simple conditional jump instructions. Additionally it must attach a
63519d23 8264@code{REG_BR_PROB} note to each conditional jump. A global variable
addd6f64 8265@code{split_branch_probability} holds the probability of the original branch in case
e4ae5e77 8266it was a simple conditional jump, @minus{}1 otherwise. To simplify
addd6f64 8267recomputing of edge frequencies, the new sequence is required to have only
6b24c259
JH
8268forward jumps to the newly created labels.
8269
fae81b38 8270@findex define_insn_and_split
c88c0d42
CP
8271For the common case where the pattern of a define_split exactly matches the
8272pattern of a define_insn, use @code{define_insn_and_split}. It looks like
8273this:
8274
8275@smallexample
8276(define_insn_and_split
8277 [@var{insn-pattern}]
8278 "@var{condition}"
8279 "@var{output-template}"
8280 "@var{split-condition}"
8281 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
8282 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
8283 @dots{}]
630d3d5a 8284 "@var{preparation-statements}"
c88c0d42
CP
8285 [@var{insn-attributes}])
8286
8287@end smallexample
8288
8289@var{insn-pattern}, @var{condition}, @var{output-template}, and
8290@var{insn-attributes} are used as in @code{define_insn}. The
8291@var{new-insn-pattern} vector and the @var{preparation-statements} are used as
8292in a @code{define_split}. The @var{split-condition} is also used as in
8293@code{define_split}, with the additional behavior that if the condition starts
8294with @samp{&&}, the condition used for the split will be the constructed as a
d7d9c429 8295logical ``and'' of the split condition with the insn condition. For example,
c88c0d42
CP
8296from i386.md:
8297
8298@smallexample
8299(define_insn_and_split "zero_extendhisi2_and"
8300 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
8301 (zero_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "0")))
8302 (clobber (reg:CC 17))]
8303 "TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size"
8304 "#"
8305 "&& reload_completed"
f282ffb3 8306 [(parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
9c34dbbf 8307 (and:SI (match_dup 0) (const_int 65535)))
6ccde948 8308 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
c88c0d42
CP
8309 ""
8310 [(set_attr "type" "alu1")])
8311
8312@end smallexample
8313
ebb48a4d 8314In this case, the actual split condition will be
aee96fe9 8315@samp{TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size && reload_completed}.
c88c0d42
CP
8316
8317The @code{define_insn_and_split} construction provides exactly the same
8318functionality as two separate @code{define_insn} and @code{define_split}
8319patterns. It exists for compactness, and as a maintenance tool to prevent
8320having to ensure the two patterns' templates match.
8321
a5249a21
HPN
8322@end ifset
8323@ifset INTERNALS
04d8aa70
AM
8324@node Including Patterns
8325@section Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
8326@cindex insn includes
8327
8328@findex include
8329The @code{include} pattern tells the compiler tools where to
8330look for patterns that are in files other than in the file
8a36672b 8331@file{.md}. This is used only at build time and there is no preprocessing allowed.
04d8aa70
AM
8332
8333It looks like:
8334
8335@smallexample
8336
8337(include
8338 @var{pathname})
8339@end smallexample
8340
8341For example:
8342
8343@smallexample
8344
f282ffb3 8345(include "filestuff")
04d8aa70
AM
8346
8347@end smallexample
8348
27d30956 8349Where @var{pathname} is a string that specifies the location of the file,
8a36672b 8350specifies the include file to be in @file{gcc/config/target/filestuff}. The
04d8aa70
AM
8351directory @file{gcc/config/target} is regarded as the default directory.
8352
8353
f282ffb3
JM
8354Machine descriptions may be split up into smaller more manageable subsections
8355and placed into subdirectories.
04d8aa70
AM
8356
8357By specifying:
8358
8359@smallexample
8360
f282ffb3 8361(include "BOGUS/filestuff")
04d8aa70
AM
8362
8363@end smallexample
8364
8365the include file is specified to be in @file{gcc/config/@var{target}/BOGUS/filestuff}.
8366
8367Specifying an absolute path for the include file such as;
8368@smallexample
8369
f282ffb3 8370(include "/u2/BOGUS/filestuff")
04d8aa70
AM
8371
8372@end smallexample
f282ffb3 8373is permitted but is not encouraged.
04d8aa70
AM
8374
8375@subsection RTL Generation Tool Options for Directory Search
8376@cindex directory options .md
8377@cindex options, directory search
8378@cindex search options
8379
8380The @option{-I@var{dir}} option specifies directories to search for machine descriptions.
8381For example:
8382
8383@smallexample
8384
8385genrecog -I/p1/abc/proc1 -I/p2/abcd/pro2 target.md
8386
8387@end smallexample
8388
8389
8390Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
8391searched for header files. This can be used to override a system machine definition
8392file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
8393searched before the default machine description file directories. If you use more than
8394one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
8395order; the standard default directory come after.
8396
8397
a5249a21
HPN
8398@end ifset
8399@ifset INTERNALS
f3a3d0d3
RH
8400@node Peephole Definitions
8401@section Machine-Specific Peephole Optimizers
8402@cindex peephole optimizer definitions
8403@cindex defining peephole optimizers
8404
8405In addition to instruction patterns the @file{md} file may contain
8406definitions of machine-specific peephole optimizations.
8407
8408The combiner does not notice certain peephole optimizations when the data
8409flow in the program does not suggest that it should try them. For example,
8410sometimes two consecutive insns related in purpose can be combined even
8411though the second one does not appear to use a register computed in the
8412first one. A machine-specific peephole optimizer can detect such
8413opportunities.
8414
8415There are two forms of peephole definitions that may be used. The
8416original @code{define_peephole} is run at assembly output time to
8417match insns and substitute assembly text. Use of @code{define_peephole}
8418is deprecated.
8419
8420A newer @code{define_peephole2} matches insns and substitutes new
8421insns. The @code{peephole2} pass is run after register allocation
ebb48a4d 8422but before scheduling, which may result in much better code for
f3a3d0d3
RH
8423targets that do scheduling.
8424
8425@menu
8426* define_peephole:: RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
8427* define_peephole2:: RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
8428@end menu
8429
a5249a21
HPN
8430@end ifset
8431@ifset INTERNALS
f3a3d0d3
RH
8432@node define_peephole
8433@subsection RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
8434@findex define_peephole
8435
8436@need 1000
8437A definition looks like this:
8438
8439@smallexample
8440(define_peephole
8441 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
8442 @var{insn-pattern-2}
8443 @dots{}]
8444 "@var{condition}"
8445 "@var{template}"
630d3d5a 8446 "@var{optional-insn-attributes}")
f3a3d0d3
RH
8447@end smallexample
8448
8449@noindent
8450The last string operand may be omitted if you are not using any
8451machine-specific information in this machine description. If present,
8452it must obey the same rules as in a @code{define_insn}.
8453
8454In this skeleton, @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on are patterns to match
8455consecutive insns. The optimization applies to a sequence of insns when
8456@var{insn-pattern-1} matches the first one, @var{insn-pattern-2} matches
bd819a4a 8457the next, and so on.
f3a3d0d3
RH
8458
8459Each of the insns matched by a peephole must also match a
8460@code{define_insn}. Peepholes are checked only at the last stage just
8461before code generation, and only optionally. Therefore, any insn which
8462would match a peephole but no @code{define_insn} will cause a crash in code
8463generation in an unoptimized compilation, or at various optimization
8464stages.
8465
8466The operands of the insns are matched with @code{match_operands},
8467@code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup}, as usual. What is not
8468usual is that the operand numbers apply to all the insn patterns in the
8469definition. So, you can check for identical operands in two insns by
8470using @code{match_operand} in one insn and @code{match_dup} in the
8471other.
8472
8473The operand constraints used in @code{match_operand} patterns do not have
8474any direct effect on the applicability of the peephole, but they will
8475be validated afterward, so make sure your constraints are general enough
8476to apply whenever the peephole matches. If the peephole matches
8477but the constraints are not satisfied, the compiler will crash.
8478
8479It is safe to omit constraints in all the operands of the peephole; or
8480you can write constraints which serve as a double-check on the criteria
8481previously tested.
8482
8483Once a sequence of insns matches the patterns, the @var{condition} is
8484checked. This is a C expression which makes the final decision whether to
8485perform the optimization (we do so if the expression is nonzero). If
8486@var{condition} is omitted (in other words, the string is empty) then the
8487optimization is applied to every sequence of insns that matches the
8488patterns.
8489
8490The defined peephole optimizations are applied after register allocation
8491is complete. Therefore, the peephole definition can check which
8492operands have ended up in which kinds of registers, just by looking at
8493the operands.
8494
8495@findex prev_active_insn
8496The way to refer to the operands in @var{condition} is to write
8497@code{operands[@var{i}]} for operand number @var{i} (as matched by
8498@code{(match_operand @var{i} @dots{})}). Use the variable @code{insn}
8499to refer to the last of the insns being matched; use
8500@code{prev_active_insn} to find the preceding insns.
8501
8502@findex dead_or_set_p
8503When optimizing computations with intermediate results, you can use
8504@var{condition} to match only when the intermediate results are not used
8505elsewhere. Use the C expression @code{dead_or_set_p (@var{insn},
8506@var{op})}, where @var{insn} is the insn in which you expect the value
8507to be used for the last time (from the value of @code{insn}, together
8508with use of @code{prev_nonnote_insn}), and @var{op} is the intermediate
bd819a4a 8509value (from @code{operands[@var{i}]}).
f3a3d0d3
RH
8510
8511Applying the optimization means replacing the sequence of insns with one
8512new insn. The @var{template} controls ultimate output of assembler code
8513for this combined insn. It works exactly like the template of a
8514@code{define_insn}. Operand numbers in this template are the same ones
8515used in matching the original sequence of insns.
8516
8517The result of a defined peephole optimizer does not need to match any of
8518the insn patterns in the machine description; it does not even have an
8519opportunity to match them. The peephole optimizer definition itself serves
8520as the insn pattern to control how the insn is output.
8521
8522Defined peephole optimizers are run as assembler code is being output,
8523so the insns they produce are never combined or rearranged in any way.
8524
8525Here is an example, taken from the 68000 machine description:
8526
8527@smallexample
8528(define_peephole
8529 [(set (reg:SI 15) (plus:SI (reg:SI 15) (const_int 4)))
8530 (set (match_operand:DF 0 "register_operand" "=f")
8531 (match_operand:DF 1 "register_operand" "ad"))]
8532 "FP_REG_P (operands[0]) && ! FP_REG_P (operands[1])"
f3a3d0d3
RH
8533@{
8534 rtx xoperands[2];
a2a8cc44 8535 xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
f3a3d0d3 8536#ifdef MOTOROLA
0f40f9f7
ZW
8537 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,(sp)", xoperands);
8538 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,-(sp)", operands);
8539 return "fmove.d (sp)+,%0";
f3a3d0d3 8540#else
0f40f9f7
ZW
8541 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@", xoperands);
8542 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@-", operands);
8543 return "fmoved sp@@+,%0";
f3a3d0d3 8544#endif
0f40f9f7 8545@})
f3a3d0d3
RH
8546@end smallexample
8547
8548@need 1000
8549The effect of this optimization is to change
8550
8551@smallexample
8552@group
8553jbsr _foobar
8554addql #4,sp
8555movel d1,sp@@-
8556movel d0,sp@@-
8557fmoved sp@@+,fp0
8558@end group
8559@end smallexample
8560
8561@noindent
8562into
8563
8564@smallexample
8565@group
8566jbsr _foobar
8567movel d1,sp@@
8568movel d0,sp@@-
8569fmoved sp@@+,fp0
8570@end group
8571@end smallexample
8572
8573@ignore
8574@findex CC_REVERSED
8575If a peephole matches a sequence including one or more jump insns, you must
8576take account of the flags such as @code{CC_REVERSED} which specify that the
8577condition codes are represented in an unusual manner. The compiler
8578automatically alters any ordinary conditional jumps which occur in such
8579situations, but the compiler cannot alter jumps which have been replaced by
8580peephole optimizations. So it is up to you to alter the assembler code
8581that the peephole produces. Supply C code to write the assembler output,
8582and in this C code check the condition code status flags and change the
8583assembler code as appropriate.
8584@end ignore
8585
8586@var{insn-pattern-1} and so on look @emph{almost} like the second
8587operand of @code{define_insn}. There is one important difference: the
8588second operand of @code{define_insn} consists of one or more RTX's
8589enclosed in square brackets. Usually, there is only one: then the same
8590action can be written as an element of a @code{define_peephole}. But
8591when there are multiple actions in a @code{define_insn}, they are
8592implicitly enclosed in a @code{parallel}. Then you must explicitly
8593write the @code{parallel}, and the square brackets within it, in the
8594@code{define_peephole}. Thus, if an insn pattern looks like this,
8595
8596@smallexample
8597(define_insn "divmodsi4"
8598 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
8599 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
8600 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
8601 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
8602 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
8603 "TARGET_68020"
8604 "divsl%.l %2,%3:%0")
8605@end smallexample
8606
8607@noindent
8608then the way to mention this insn in a peephole is as follows:
8609
8610@smallexample
8611(define_peephole
8612 [@dots{}
8613 (parallel
8614 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
8615 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
8616 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
8617 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
8618 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))])
8619 @dots{}]
8620 @dots{})
8621@end smallexample
8622
a5249a21
HPN
8623@end ifset
8624@ifset INTERNALS
f3a3d0d3
RH
8625@node define_peephole2
8626@subsection RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
8627@findex define_peephole2
8628
8629The @code{define_peephole2} definition tells the compiler how to
ebb48a4d 8630substitute one sequence of instructions for another sequence,
f3a3d0d3
RH
8631what additional scratch registers may be needed and what their
8632lifetimes must be.
8633
8634@smallexample
8635(define_peephole2
8636 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
8637 @var{insn-pattern-2}
8638 @dots{}]
8639 "@var{condition}"
8640 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
8641 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
8642 @dots{}]
630d3d5a 8643 "@var{preparation-statements}")
f3a3d0d3
RH
8644@end smallexample
8645
8646The definition is almost identical to @code{define_split}
8647(@pxref{Insn Splitting}) except that the pattern to match is not a
8648single instruction, but a sequence of instructions.
8649
8650It is possible to request additional scratch registers for use in the
8651output template. If appropriate registers are not free, the pattern
8652will simply not match.
8653
8654@findex match_scratch
8655@findex match_dup
8656Scratch registers are requested with a @code{match_scratch} pattern at
8657the top level of the input pattern. The allocated register (initially) will
8658be dead at the point requested within the original sequence. If the scratch
8659is used at more than a single point, a @code{match_dup} pattern at the
8660top level of the input pattern marks the last position in the input sequence
8661at which the register must be available.
8662
8663Here is an example from the IA-32 machine description:
8664
8665@smallexample
8666(define_peephole2
8667 [(match_scratch:SI 2 "r")
8668 (parallel [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
8669 (match_operator:SI 3 "arith_or_logical_operator"
8670 [(match_dup 0)
8671 (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")]))
8672 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
8673 "! optimize_size && ! TARGET_READ_MODIFY"
8674 [(set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 1))
8675 (parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
8676 (match_op_dup 3 [(match_dup 0) (match_dup 2)]))
8677 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
8678 "")
8679@end smallexample
8680
8681@noindent
8682This pattern tries to split a load from its use in the hopes that we'll be
8683able to schedule around the memory load latency. It allocates a single
8684@code{SImode} register of class @code{GENERAL_REGS} (@code{"r"}) that needs
8685to be live only at the point just before the arithmetic.
8686
b192711e 8687A real example requiring extended scratch lifetimes is harder to come by,
f3a3d0d3
RH
8688so here's a silly made-up example:
8689
8690@smallexample
8691(define_peephole2
8692 [(match_scratch:SI 4 "r")
8693 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "") (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))
8694 (set (match_operand:SI 2 "" "") (match_dup 1))
8695 (match_dup 4)
8696 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "" "") (match_dup 1))]
630d3d5a 8697 "/* @r{determine 1 does not overlap 0 and 2} */"
f3a3d0d3
RH
8698 [(set (match_dup 4) (match_dup 1))
8699 (set (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4))
c8fbf1fa 8700 (set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 4))
f3a3d0d3
RH
8701 (set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 4))]
8702 "")
8703@end smallexample
8704
582d1f90
PK
8705There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
8706@code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
8707as a statement.
8708
8709@table @code
8710
8711@findex DONE
8712@item DONE
8713Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the peephole. The
8714only RTL insns generated as replacement for the matched input insn will
8715be those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within
8716the preparation statements; the replacement pattern is not used.
8717
8718@findex FAIL
8719@item FAIL
8720Make the @code{define_peephole2} fail on this occasion. When a @code{define_peephole2}
8721fails, it means that the replacement was not truly available for the
8722particular inputs it was given. In that case, GCC may still apply a
8723later @code{define_peephole2} that also matches the given insn pattern.
8724(Note that this is different from @code{define_split}, where @code{FAIL}
8725prevents the input insn from being split at all.)
8726@end table
8727
8728If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
8729@code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_peephole2} uses the replacement
8730template.
8731
f3a3d0d3 8732@noindent
a628d195
RH
8733If we had not added the @code{(match_dup 4)} in the middle of the input
8734sequence, it might have been the case that the register we chose at the
8735beginning of the sequence is killed by the first or second @code{set}.
f3a3d0d3 8736
a5249a21
HPN
8737@end ifset
8738@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
8739@node Insn Attributes
8740@section Instruction Attributes
8741@cindex insn attributes
8742@cindex instruction attributes
8743
8744In addition to describing the instruction supported by the target machine,
8745the @file{md} file also defines a group of @dfn{attributes} and a set of
8746values for each. Every generated insn is assigned a value for each attribute.
8747One possible attribute would be the effect that the insn has on the machine's
8748condition code. This attribute can then be used by @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}
8749to track the condition codes.
8750
8751@menu
8752* Defining Attributes:: Specifying attributes and their values.
8753* Expressions:: Valid expressions for attribute values.
8754* Tagging Insns:: Assigning attribute values to insns.
8755* Attr Example:: An example of assigning attributes.
8756* Insn Lengths:: Computing the length of insns.
8757* Constant Attributes:: Defining attributes that are constant.
13b72c22 8758* Mnemonic Attribute:: Obtain the instruction mnemonic as attribute value.
03dda8e3 8759* Delay Slots:: Defining delay slots required for a machine.
fae15c93 8760* Processor pipeline description:: Specifying information for insn scheduling.
03dda8e3
RK
8761@end menu
8762
a5249a21
HPN
8763@end ifset
8764@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
8765@node Defining Attributes
8766@subsection Defining Attributes and their Values
8767@cindex defining attributes and their values
8768@cindex attributes, defining
8769
8770@findex define_attr
8771The @code{define_attr} expression is used to define each attribute required
8772by the target machine. It looks like:
8773
8774@smallexample
8775(define_attr @var{name} @var{list-of-values} @var{default})
8776@end smallexample
8777
13b72c22
AK
8778@var{name} is a string specifying the name of the attribute being
8779defined. Some attributes are used in a special way by the rest of the
8780compiler. The @code{enabled} attribute can be used to conditionally
8781enable or disable insn alternatives (@pxref{Disable Insn
8782Alternatives}). The @code{predicable} attribute, together with a
8783suitable @code{define_cond_exec} (@pxref{Conditional Execution}), can
8784be used to automatically generate conditional variants of instruction
8785patterns. The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be used to check for the
8786instruction mnemonic (@pxref{Mnemonic Attribute}). The compiler
8787internally uses the names @code{ce_enabled} and @code{nonce_enabled},
8788so they should not be used elsewhere as alternative names.
03dda8e3
RK
8789
8790@var{list-of-values} is either a string that specifies a comma-separated
8791list of values that can be assigned to the attribute, or a null string to
8792indicate that the attribute takes numeric values.
8793
8794@var{default} is an attribute expression that gives the value of this
8795attribute for insns that match patterns whose definition does not include
8796an explicit value for this attribute. @xref{Attr Example}, for more
8797information on the handling of defaults. @xref{Constant Attributes},
8798for information on attributes that do not depend on any particular insn.
8799
8800@findex insn-attr.h
8801For each defined attribute, a number of definitions are written to the
8802@file{insn-attr.h} file. For cases where an explicit set of values is
8803specified for an attribute, the following are defined:
8804
8805@itemize @bullet
8806@item
8807A @samp{#define} is written for the symbol @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}}.
8808
8809@item
2eac577f 8810An enumerated class is defined for @samp{attr_@var{name}} with
03dda8e3 8811elements of the form @samp{@var{upper-name}_@var{upper-value}} where
4bd0bee9 8812the attribute name and value are first converted to uppercase.
03dda8e3
RK
8813
8814@item
8815A function @samp{get_attr_@var{name}} is defined that is passed an insn and
8816returns the attribute value for that insn.
8817@end itemize
8818
8819For example, if the following is present in the @file{md} file:
8820
8821@smallexample
8822(define_attr "type" "branch,fp,load,store,arith" @dots{})
8823@end smallexample
8824
8825@noindent
8826the following lines will be written to the file @file{insn-attr.h}.
8827
8828@smallexample
d327457f 8829#define HAVE_ATTR_type 1
03dda8e3
RK
8830enum attr_type @{TYPE_BRANCH, TYPE_FP, TYPE_LOAD,
8831 TYPE_STORE, TYPE_ARITH@};
8832extern enum attr_type get_attr_type ();
8833@end smallexample
8834
8835If the attribute takes numeric values, no @code{enum} type will be
8836defined and the function to obtain the attribute's value will return
8837@code{int}.
8838
7ac28727
AK
8839There are attributes which are tied to a specific meaning. These
8840attributes are not free to use for other purposes:
8841
8842@table @code
8843@item length
8844The @code{length} attribute is used to calculate the length of emitted
8845code chunks. This is especially important when verifying branch
8846distances. @xref{Insn Lengths}.
8847
8848@item enabled
8849The @code{enabled} attribute can be defined to prevent certain
8850alternatives of an insn definition from being used during code
8851generation. @xref{Disable Insn Alternatives}.
13b72c22
AK
8852
8853@item mnemonic
8854The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be defined to implement instruction
8855specific checks in e.g. the pipeline description.
8856@xref{Mnemonic Attribute}.
7ac28727
AK
8857@end table
8858
d327457f
JR
8859For each of these special attributes, the corresponding
8860@samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}} @samp{#define} is also written when the
8861attribute is not defined; in that case, it is defined as @samp{0}.
8862
8f4fe86c
RS
8863@findex define_enum_attr
8864@anchor{define_enum_attr}
8865Another way of defining an attribute is to use:
8866
8867@smallexample
8868(define_enum_attr "@var{attr}" "@var{enum}" @var{default})
8869@end smallexample
8870
8871This works in just the same way as @code{define_attr}, except that
8872the list of values is taken from a separate enumeration called
8873@var{enum} (@pxref{define_enum}). This form allows you to use
8874the same list of values for several attributes without having to
8875repeat the list each time. For example:
8876
8877@smallexample
8878(define_enum "processor" [
8879 model_a
8880 model_b
8881 @dots{}
8882])
8883(define_enum_attr "arch" "processor"
8884 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
8885(define_enum_attr "tune" "processor"
8886 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
8887@end smallexample
8888
8889defines the same attributes as:
8890
8891@smallexample
8892(define_attr "arch" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
8893 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
8894(define_attr "tune" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
8895 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
8896@end smallexample
8897
8898but without duplicating the processor list. The second example defines two
8899separate C enums (@code{attr_arch} and @code{attr_tune}) whereas the first
8900defines a single C enum (@code{processor}).
a5249a21
HPN
8901@end ifset
8902@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
8903@node Expressions
8904@subsection Attribute Expressions
8905@cindex attribute expressions
8906
8907RTL expressions used to define attributes use the codes described above
8908plus a few specific to attribute definitions, to be discussed below.
8909Attribute value expressions must have one of the following forms:
8910
8911@table @code
8912@cindex @code{const_int} and attributes
8913@item (const_int @var{i})
8914The integer @var{i} specifies the value of a numeric attribute. @var{i}
8915must be non-negative.
8916
8917The value of a numeric attribute can be specified either with a
00bc45c1
RH
8918@code{const_int}, or as an integer represented as a string in
8919@code{const_string}, @code{eq_attr} (see below), @code{attr},
8920@code{symbol_ref}, simple arithmetic expressions, and @code{set_attr}
8921overrides on specific instructions (@pxref{Tagging Insns}).
03dda8e3
RK
8922
8923@cindex @code{const_string} and attributes
8924@item (const_string @var{value})
8925The string @var{value} specifies a constant attribute value.
8926If @var{value} is specified as @samp{"*"}, it means that the default value of
8927the attribute is to be used for the insn containing this expression.
8928@samp{"*"} obviously cannot be used in the @var{default} expression
bd819a4a 8929of a @code{define_attr}.
03dda8e3
RK
8930
8931If the attribute whose value is being specified is numeric, @var{value}
8932must be a string containing a non-negative integer (normally
8933@code{const_int} would be used in this case). Otherwise, it must
8934contain one of the valid values for the attribute.
8935
8936@cindex @code{if_then_else} and attributes
8937@item (if_then_else @var{test} @var{true-value} @var{false-value})
8938@var{test} specifies an attribute test, whose format is defined below.
8939The value of this expression is @var{true-value} if @var{test} is true,
8940otherwise it is @var{false-value}.
8941
8942@cindex @code{cond} and attributes
8943@item (cond [@var{test1} @var{value1} @dots{}] @var{default})
8944The first operand of this expression is a vector containing an even
8945number of expressions and consisting of pairs of @var{test} and @var{value}
8946expressions. The value of the @code{cond} expression is that of the
8947@var{value} corresponding to the first true @var{test} expression. If
8948none of the @var{test} expressions are true, the value of the @code{cond}
8949expression is that of the @var{default} expression.
8950@end table
8951
8952@var{test} expressions can have one of the following forms:
8953
8954@table @code
8955@cindex @code{const_int} and attribute tests
8956@item (const_int @var{i})
df2a54e9 8957This test is true if @var{i} is nonzero and false otherwise.
03dda8e3
RK
8958
8959@cindex @code{not} and attributes
8960@cindex @code{ior} and attributes
8961@cindex @code{and} and attributes
8962@item (not @var{test})
8963@itemx (ior @var{test1} @var{test2})
8964@itemx (and @var{test1} @var{test2})
8965These tests are true if the indicated logical function is true.
8966
8967@cindex @code{match_operand} and attributes
8968@item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{pred} @var{constraints})
8969This test is true if operand @var{n} of the insn whose attribute value
8970is being determined has mode @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored
8971if @var{m} is @code{VOIDmode}) and the function specified by the string
df2a54e9 8972@var{pred} returns a nonzero value when passed operand @var{n} and mode
03dda8e3
RK
8973@var{m} (this part of the test is ignored if @var{pred} is the null
8974string).
8975
8976The @var{constraints} operand is ignored and should be the null string.
8977
0c0d3957
RS
8978@cindex @code{match_test} and attributes
8979@item (match_test @var{c-expr})
8980The test is true if C expression @var{c-expr} is true. In non-constant
8981attributes, @var{c-expr} has access to the following variables:
8982
8983@table @var
8984@item insn
8985The rtl instruction under test.
8986@item which_alternative
8987The @code{define_insn} alternative that @var{insn} matches.
8988@xref{Output Statement}.
8989@item operands
8990An array of @var{insn}'s rtl operands.
8991@end table
8992
8993@var{c-expr} behaves like the condition in a C @code{if} statement,
8994so there is no need to explicitly convert the expression into a boolean
89950 or 1 value. For example, the following two tests are equivalent:
8996
8997@smallexample
8998(match_test "x & 2")
8999(match_test "(x & 2) != 0")
9000@end smallexample
9001
03dda8e3
RK
9002@cindex @code{le} and attributes
9003@cindex @code{leu} and attributes
9004@cindex @code{lt} and attributes
9005@cindex @code{gt} and attributes
9006@cindex @code{gtu} and attributes
9007@cindex @code{ge} and attributes
9008@cindex @code{geu} and attributes
9009@cindex @code{ne} and attributes
9010@cindex @code{eq} and attributes
9011@cindex @code{plus} and attributes
9012@cindex @code{minus} and attributes
9013@cindex @code{mult} and attributes
9014@cindex @code{div} and attributes
9015@cindex @code{mod} and attributes
9016@cindex @code{abs} and attributes
9017@cindex @code{neg} and attributes
9018@cindex @code{ashift} and attributes
9019@cindex @code{lshiftrt} and attributes
9020@cindex @code{ashiftrt} and attributes
9021@item (le @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9022@itemx (leu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9023@itemx (lt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9024@itemx (ltu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9025@itemx (gt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9026@itemx (gtu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9027@itemx (ge @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9028@itemx (geu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9029@itemx (ne @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9030@itemx (eq @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9031These tests are true if the indicated comparison of the two arithmetic
9032expressions is true. Arithmetic expressions are formed with
9033@code{plus}, @code{minus}, @code{mult}, @code{div}, @code{mod},
9034@code{abs}, @code{neg}, @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor}, @code{not},
bd819a4a 9035@code{ashift}, @code{lshiftrt}, and @code{ashiftrt} expressions.
03dda8e3
RK
9036
9037@findex get_attr
9038@code{const_int} and @code{symbol_ref} are always valid terms (@pxref{Insn
9039Lengths},for additional forms). @code{symbol_ref} is a string
9040denoting a C expression that yields an @code{int} when evaluated by the
9041@samp{get_attr_@dots{}} routine. It should normally be a global
bd819a4a 9042variable.
03dda8e3
RK
9043
9044@findex eq_attr
9045@item (eq_attr @var{name} @var{value})
9046@var{name} is a string specifying the name of an attribute.
9047
9048@var{value} is a string that is either a valid value for attribute
9049@var{name}, a comma-separated list of values, or @samp{!} followed by a
9050value or list. If @var{value} does not begin with a @samp{!}, this
9051test is true if the value of the @var{name} attribute of the current
9052insn is in the list specified by @var{value}. If @var{value} begins
9053with a @samp{!}, this test is true if the attribute's value is
9054@emph{not} in the specified list.
9055
9056For example,
9057
9058@smallexample
9059(eq_attr "type" "load,store")
9060@end smallexample
9061
9062@noindent
9063is equivalent to
9064
9065@smallexample
9066(ior (eq_attr "type" "load") (eq_attr "type" "store"))
9067@end smallexample
9068
9069If @var{name} specifies an attribute of @samp{alternative}, it refers to the
9070value of the compiler variable @code{which_alternative}
9071(@pxref{Output Statement}) and the values must be small integers. For
bd819a4a 9072example,
03dda8e3
RK
9073
9074@smallexample
9075(eq_attr "alternative" "2,3")
9076@end smallexample
9077
9078@noindent
9079is equivalent to
9080
9081@smallexample
9082(ior (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 2))
9083 (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 3)))
9084@end smallexample
9085
9086Note that, for most attributes, an @code{eq_attr} test is simplified in cases
9087where the value of the attribute being tested is known for all insns matching
bd819a4a 9088a particular pattern. This is by far the most common case.
03dda8e3
RK
9089
9090@findex attr_flag
9091@item (attr_flag @var{name})
9092The value of an @code{attr_flag} expression is true if the flag
9093specified by @var{name} is true for the @code{insn} currently being
9094scheduled.
9095
9096@var{name} is a string specifying one of a fixed set of flags to test.
9097Test the flags @code{forward} and @code{backward} to determine the
81e7aa8e 9098direction of a conditional branch.
03dda8e3
RK
9099
9100This example describes a conditional branch delay slot which
9101can be nullified for forward branches that are taken (annul-true) or
9102for backward branches which are not taken (annul-false).
9103
9104@smallexample
9105(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "cbranch")
9106 [(eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9107 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9108 (attr_flag "forward"))
9109 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9110 (attr_flag "backward"))])
9111@end smallexample
9112
9113The @code{forward} and @code{backward} flags are false if the current
9114@code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
9115
03dda8e3
RK
9116@code{attr_flag} is only used during delay slot scheduling and has no
9117meaning to other passes of the compiler.
00bc45c1
RH
9118
9119@findex attr
9120@item (attr @var{name})
9121The value of another attribute is returned. This is most useful
9122for numeric attributes, as @code{eq_attr} and @code{attr_flag}
9123produce more efficient code for non-numeric attributes.
03dda8e3
RK
9124@end table
9125
a5249a21
HPN
9126@end ifset
9127@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
9128@node Tagging Insns
9129@subsection Assigning Attribute Values to Insns
9130@cindex tagging insns
9131@cindex assigning attribute values to insns
9132
9133The value assigned to an attribute of an insn is primarily determined by
9134which pattern is matched by that insn (or which @code{define_peephole}
9135generated it). Every @code{define_insn} and @code{define_peephole} can
9136have an optional last argument to specify the values of attributes for
9137matching insns. The value of any attribute not specified in a particular
9138insn is set to the default value for that attribute, as specified in its
9139@code{define_attr}. Extensive use of default values for attributes
9140permits the specification of the values for only one or two attributes
9141in the definition of most insn patterns, as seen in the example in the
bd819a4a 9142next section.
03dda8e3
RK
9143
9144The optional last argument of @code{define_insn} and
9145@code{define_peephole} is a vector of expressions, each of which defines
9146the value for a single attribute. The most general way of assigning an
9147attribute's value is to use a @code{set} expression whose first operand is an
9148@code{attr} expression giving the name of the attribute being set. The
9149second operand of the @code{set} is an attribute expression
bd819a4a 9150(@pxref{Expressions}) giving the value of the attribute.
03dda8e3
RK
9151
9152When the attribute value depends on the @samp{alternative} attribute
9153(i.e., which is the applicable alternative in the constraint of the
9154insn), the @code{set_attr_alternative} expression can be used. It
9155allows the specification of a vector of attribute expressions, one for
9156each alternative.
9157
9158@findex set_attr
9159When the generality of arbitrary attribute expressions is not required,
9160the simpler @code{set_attr} expression can be used, which allows
9161specifying a string giving either a single attribute value or a list
9162of attribute values, one for each alternative.
9163
9164The form of each of the above specifications is shown below. In each case,
9165@var{name} is a string specifying the attribute to be set.
9166
9167@table @code
9168@item (set_attr @var{name} @var{value-string})
9169@var{value-string} is either a string giving the desired attribute value,
9170or a string containing a comma-separated list giving the values for
9171succeeding alternatives. The number of elements must match the number
9172of alternatives in the constraint of the insn pattern.
9173
9174Note that it may be useful to specify @samp{*} for some alternative, in
9175which case the attribute will assume its default value for insns matching
9176that alternative.
9177
9178@findex set_attr_alternative
9179@item (set_attr_alternative @var{name} [@var{value1} @var{value2} @dots{}])
9180Depending on the alternative of the insn, the value will be one of the
9181specified values. This is a shorthand for using a @code{cond} with
9182tests on the @samp{alternative} attribute.
9183
9184@findex attr
9185@item (set (attr @var{name}) @var{value})
9186The first operand of this @code{set} must be the special RTL expression
9187@code{attr}, whose sole operand is a string giving the name of the
9188attribute being set. @var{value} is the value of the attribute.
9189@end table
9190
9191The following shows three different ways of representing the same
9192attribute value specification:
9193
9194@smallexample
9195(set_attr "type" "load,store,arith")
9196
9197(set_attr_alternative "type"
9198 [(const_string "load") (const_string "store")
9199 (const_string "arith")])
9200
9201(set (attr "type")
9202 (cond [(eq_attr "alternative" "1") (const_string "load")
9203 (eq_attr "alternative" "2") (const_string "store")]
9204 (const_string "arith")))
9205@end smallexample
9206
9207@need 1000
9208@findex define_asm_attributes
9209The @code{define_asm_attributes} expression provides a mechanism to
9210specify the attributes assigned to insns produced from an @code{asm}
9211statement. It has the form:
9212
9213@smallexample
9214(define_asm_attributes [@var{attr-sets}])
9215@end smallexample
9216
9217@noindent
9218where @var{attr-sets} is specified the same as for both the
9219@code{define_insn} and the @code{define_peephole} expressions.
9220
9221These values will typically be the ``worst case'' attribute values. For
9222example, they might indicate that the condition code will be clobbered.
9223
9224A specification for a @code{length} attribute is handled specially. The
9225way to compute the length of an @code{asm} insn is to multiply the
9226length specified in the expression @code{define_asm_attributes} by the
9227number of machine instructions specified in the @code{asm} statement,
9228determined by counting the number of semicolons and newlines in the
9229string. Therefore, the value of the @code{length} attribute specified
9230in a @code{define_asm_attributes} should be the maximum possible length
9231of a single machine instruction.
9232
a5249a21
HPN
9233@end ifset
9234@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
9235@node Attr Example
9236@subsection Example of Attribute Specifications
9237@cindex attribute specifications example
9238@cindex attribute specifications
9239
9240The judicious use of defaulting is important in the efficient use of
9241insn attributes. Typically, insns are divided into @dfn{types} and an
9242attribute, customarily called @code{type}, is used to represent this
9243value. This attribute is normally used only to define the default value
9244for other attributes. An example will clarify this usage.
9245
9246Assume we have a RISC machine with a condition code and in which only
9247full-word operations are performed in registers. Let us assume that we
9248can divide all insns into loads, stores, (integer) arithmetic
9249operations, floating point operations, and branches.
9250
9251Here we will concern ourselves with determining the effect of an insn on
9252the condition code and will limit ourselves to the following possible
9253effects: The condition code can be set unpredictably (clobbered), not
9254be changed, be set to agree with the results of the operation, or only
9255changed if the item previously set into the condition code has been
9256modified.
9257
9258Here is part of a sample @file{md} file for such a machine:
9259
9260@smallexample
9261(define_attr "type" "load,store,arith,fp,branch" (const_string "arith"))
9262
9263(define_attr "cc" "clobber,unchanged,set,change0"
9264 (cond [(eq_attr "type" "load")
9265 (const_string "change0")
9266 (eq_attr "type" "store,branch")
9267 (const_string "unchanged")
9268 (eq_attr "type" "arith")
9269 (if_then_else (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
9270 (const_string "set")
9271 (const_string "clobber"))]
9272 (const_string "clobber")))
9273
9274(define_insn ""
9275 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,r,m")
9276 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r,m,r"))]
9277 ""
9278 "@@
9279 move %0,%1
9280 load %0,%1
9281 store %0,%1"
9282 [(set_attr "type" "arith,load,store")])
9283@end smallexample
9284
9285Note that we assume in the above example that arithmetic operations
9286performed on quantities smaller than a machine word clobber the condition
9287code since they will set the condition code to a value corresponding to the
9288full-word result.
9289
a5249a21
HPN
9290@end ifset
9291@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
9292@node Insn Lengths
9293@subsection Computing the Length of an Insn
9294@cindex insn lengths, computing
9295@cindex computing the length of an insn
9296
9297For many machines, multiple types of branch instructions are provided, each
9298for different length branch displacements. In most cases, the assembler
9299will choose the correct instruction to use. However, when the assembler
b49900cc 9300cannot do so, GCC can when a special attribute, the @code{length}
03dda8e3
RK
9301attribute, is defined. This attribute must be defined to have numeric
9302values by specifying a null string in its @code{define_attr}.
9303
b49900cc 9304In the case of the @code{length} attribute, two additional forms of
03dda8e3
RK
9305arithmetic terms are allowed in test expressions:
9306
9307@table @code
9308@cindex @code{match_dup} and attributes
9309@item (match_dup @var{n})
9310This refers to the address of operand @var{n} of the current insn, which
9311must be a @code{label_ref}.
9312
9313@cindex @code{pc} and attributes
9314@item (pc)
0c94b59f
EB
9315For non-branch instructions and backward branch instructions, this refers
9316to the address of the current insn. But for forward branch instructions,
9317this refers to the address of the next insn, because the length of the
03dda8e3
RK
9318current insn is to be computed.
9319@end table
9320
9321@cindex @code{addr_vec}, length of
9322@cindex @code{addr_diff_vec}, length of
9323For normal insns, the length will be determined by value of the
b49900cc 9324@code{length} attribute. In the case of @code{addr_vec} and
03dda8e3
RK
9325@code{addr_diff_vec} insn patterns, the length is computed as
9326the number of vectors multiplied by the size of each vector.
9327
9328Lengths are measured in addressable storage units (bytes).
9329
40da08e0
JL
9330Note that it is possible to call functions via the @code{symbol_ref}
9331mechanism to compute the length of an insn. However, if you use this
9332mechanism you must provide dummy clauses to express the maximum length
9333without using the function call. You can an example of this in the
9334@code{pa} machine description for the @code{call_symref} pattern.
9335
03dda8e3
RK
9336The following macros can be used to refine the length computation:
9337
9338@table @code
03dda8e3
RK
9339@findex ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH
9340@item ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH (@var{insn}, @var{length})
9341If defined, modifies the length assigned to instruction @var{insn} as a
9342function of the context in which it is used. @var{length} is an lvalue
9343that contains the initially computed length of the insn and should be
a8aa4e0b 9344updated with the correct length of the insn.
03dda8e3
RK
9345
9346This macro will normally not be required. A case in which it is
161d7b59 9347required is the ROMP@. On this machine, the size of an @code{addr_vec}
03dda8e3
RK
9348insn must be increased by two to compensate for the fact that alignment
9349may be required.
9350@end table
9351
9352@findex get_attr_length
9353The routine that returns @code{get_attr_length} (the value of the
9354@code{length} attribute) can be used by the output routine to
9355determine the form of the branch instruction to be written, as the
9356example below illustrates.
9357
9358As an example of the specification of variable-length branches, consider
9359the IBM 360. If we adopt the convention that a register will be set to
9360the starting address of a function, we can jump to labels within 4k of
9361the start using a four-byte instruction. Otherwise, we need a six-byte
9362sequence to load the address from memory and then branch to it.
9363
9364On such a machine, a pattern for a branch instruction might be specified
9365as follows:
9366
9367@smallexample
9368(define_insn "jump"
9369 [(set (pc)
9370 (label_ref (match_operand 0 "" "")))]
9371 ""
03dda8e3
RK
9372@{
9373 return (get_attr_length (insn) == 4
0f40f9f7
ZW
9374 ? "b %l0" : "l r15,=a(%l0); br r15");
9375@}
9c34dbbf
ZW
9376 [(set (attr "length")
9377 (if_then_else (lt (match_dup 0) (const_int 4096))
9378 (const_int 4)
9379 (const_int 6)))])
03dda8e3
RK
9380@end smallexample
9381
a5249a21
HPN
9382@end ifset
9383@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
9384@node Constant Attributes
9385@subsection Constant Attributes
9386@cindex constant attributes
9387
9388A special form of @code{define_attr}, where the expression for the
9389default value is a @code{const} expression, indicates an attribute that
9390is constant for a given run of the compiler. Constant attributes may be
9391used to specify which variety of processor is used. For example,
9392
9393@smallexample
9394(define_attr "cpu" "m88100,m88110,m88000"
9395 (const
9396 (cond [(symbol_ref "TARGET_88100") (const_string "m88100")
9397 (symbol_ref "TARGET_88110") (const_string "m88110")]
9398 (const_string "m88000"))))
9399
9400(define_attr "memory" "fast,slow"
9401 (const
9402 (if_then_else (symbol_ref "TARGET_FAST_MEM")
9403 (const_string "fast")
9404 (const_string "slow"))))
9405@end smallexample
9406
9407The routine generated for constant attributes has no parameters as it
9408does not depend on any particular insn. RTL expressions used to define
9409the value of a constant attribute may use the @code{symbol_ref} form,
9410but may not use either the @code{match_operand} form or @code{eq_attr}
9411forms involving insn attributes.
9412
13b72c22
AK
9413@end ifset
9414@ifset INTERNALS
9415@node Mnemonic Attribute
9416@subsection Mnemonic Attribute
9417@cindex mnemonic attribute
9418
9419The @code{mnemonic} attribute is a string type attribute holding the
9420instruction mnemonic for an insn alternative. The attribute values
9421will automatically be generated by the machine description parser if
9422there is an attribute definition in the md file:
9423
9424@smallexample
9425(define_attr "mnemonic" "unknown" (const_string "unknown"))
9426@end smallexample
9427
9428The default value can be freely chosen as long as it does not collide
9429with any of the instruction mnemonics. This value will be used
9430whenever the machine description parser is not able to determine the
9431mnemonic string. This might be the case for output templates
9432containing more than a single instruction as in
9433@code{"mvcle\t%0,%1,0\;jo\t.-4"}.
9434
9435The @code{mnemonic} attribute set is not generated automatically if the
9436instruction string is generated via C code.
9437
9438An existing @code{mnemonic} attribute set in an insn definition will not
9439be overriden by the md file parser. That way it is possible to
9440manually set the instruction mnemonics for the cases where the md file
9441parser fails to determine it automatically.
9442
9443The @code{mnemonic} attribute is useful for dealing with instruction
9444specific properties in the pipeline description without defining
9445additional insn attributes.
9446
9447@smallexample
9448(define_attr "ooo_expanded" ""
9449 (cond [(eq_attr "mnemonic" "dlr,dsgr,d,dsgf,stam,dsgfr,dlgr")
9450 (const_int 1)]
9451 (const_int 0)))
9452@end smallexample
9453
a5249a21
HPN
9454@end ifset
9455@ifset INTERNALS
03dda8e3
RK
9456@node Delay Slots
9457@subsection Delay Slot Scheduling
9458@cindex delay slots, defining
9459
9460The insn attribute mechanism can be used to specify the requirements for
9461delay slots, if any, on a target machine. An instruction is said to
9462require a @dfn{delay slot} if some instructions that are physically
9463after the instruction are executed as if they were located before it.
9464Classic examples are branch and call instructions, which often execute
9465the following instruction before the branch or call is performed.
9466
9467On some machines, conditional branch instructions can optionally
9468@dfn{annul} instructions in the delay slot. This means that the
9469instruction will not be executed for certain branch outcomes. Both
9470instructions that annul if the branch is true and instructions that
9471annul if the branch is false are supported.
9472
9473Delay slot scheduling differs from instruction scheduling in that
9474determining whether an instruction needs a delay slot is dependent only
9475on the type of instruction being generated, not on data flow between the
9476instructions. See the next section for a discussion of data-dependent
9477instruction scheduling.
9478
9479@findex define_delay
9480The requirement of an insn needing one or more delay slots is indicated
9481via the @code{define_delay} expression. It has the following form:
9482
9483@smallexample
9484(define_delay @var{test}
9485 [@var{delay-1} @var{annul-true-1} @var{annul-false-1}
9486 @var{delay-2} @var{annul-true-2} @var{annul-false-2}
9487 @dots{}])
9488@end smallexample
9489
9490@var{test} is an attribute test that indicates whether this
9491@code{define_delay} applies to a particular insn. If so, the number of
9492required delay slots is determined by the length of the vector specified
9493as the second argument. An insn placed in delay slot @var{n} must
9494satisfy attribute test @var{delay-n}. @var{annul-true-n} is an
9495attribute test that specifies which insns may be annulled if the branch
9496is true. Similarly, @var{annul-false-n} specifies which insns in the
9497delay slot may be annulled if the branch is false. If annulling is not
bd819a4a 9498supported for that delay slot, @code{(nil)} should be coded.
03dda8e3
RK
9499
9500For example, in the common case where branch and call insns require
9501a single delay slot, which may contain any insn other than a branch or
9502call, the following would be placed in the @file{md} file:
9503
9504@smallexample
9505(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch,call")
9506 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
9507@end smallexample
9508
9509Multiple @code{define_delay} expressions may be specified. In this
9510case, each such expression specifies different delay slot requirements
9511and there must be no insn for which tests in two @code{define_delay}
9512expressions are both true.
9513
9514For example, if we have a machine that requires one delay slot for branches
9515but two for calls, no delay slot can contain a branch or call insn,
9516and any valid insn in the delay slot for the branch can be annulled if the
9517branch is true, we might represent this as follows:
9518
9519@smallexample
9520(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch")
9521 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
9522 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
9523 (nil)])
9524
9525(define_delay (eq_attr "type" "call")
9526 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)
9527 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
9528@end smallexample
9529@c the above is *still* too long. --mew 4feb93
9530
a5249a21
HPN
9531@end ifset
9532@ifset INTERNALS
fae15c93
VM
9533@node Processor pipeline description
9534@subsection Specifying processor pipeline description
9535@cindex processor pipeline description
9536@cindex processor functional units
9537@cindex instruction latency time
9538@cindex interlock delays
9539@cindex data dependence delays
9540@cindex reservation delays
9541@cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
9542@cindex automaton based pipeline description
9543@cindex regular expressions
9544@cindex deterministic finite state automaton
9545@cindex automaton based scheduler
9546@cindex RISC
9547@cindex VLIW
9548
ef261fee 9549To achieve better performance, most modern processors
fae15c93
VM
9550(super-pipelined, superscalar @acronym{RISC}, and @acronym{VLIW}
9551processors) have many @dfn{functional units} on which several
9552instructions can be executed simultaneously. An instruction starts
9553execution if its issue conditions are satisfied. If not, the
ef261fee 9554instruction is stalled until its conditions are satisfied. Such
fae15c93 9555@dfn{interlock (pipeline) delay} causes interruption of the fetching
431ae0bf 9556of successor instructions (or demands nop instructions, e.g.@: for some
fae15c93
VM
9557MIPS processors).
9558
9559There are two major kinds of interlock delays in modern processors.
9560The first one is a data dependence delay determining @dfn{instruction
9561latency time}. The instruction execution is not started until all
9562source data have been evaluated by prior instructions (there are more
9563complex cases when the instruction execution starts even when the data
c0478a66 9564are not available but will be ready in given time after the
fae15c93
VM
9565instruction execution start). Taking the data dependence delays into
9566account is simple. The data dependence (true, output, and
9567anti-dependence) delay between two instructions is given by a
9568constant. In most cases this approach is adequate. The second kind
9569of interlock delays is a reservation delay. The reservation delay
9570means that two instructions under execution will be in need of shared
431ae0bf 9571processors resources, i.e.@: buses, internal registers, and/or
fae15c93
VM
9572functional units, which are reserved for some time. Taking this kind
9573of delay into account is complex especially for modern @acronym{RISC}
9574processors.
9575
9576The task of exploiting more processor parallelism is solved by an
ef261fee 9577instruction scheduler. For a better solution to this problem, the
fae15c93 9578instruction scheduler has to have an adequate description of the
fa0aee89
PB
9579processor parallelism (or @dfn{pipeline description}). GCC
9580machine descriptions describe processor parallelism and functional
9581unit reservations for groups of instructions with the aid of
9582@dfn{regular expressions}.
ef261fee
R
9583
9584The GCC instruction scheduler uses a @dfn{pipeline hazard recognizer} to
fae15c93 9585figure out the possibility of the instruction issue by the processor
ef261fee
R
9586on a given simulated processor cycle. The pipeline hazard recognizer is
9587automatically generated from the processor pipeline description. The
fa0aee89
PB
9588pipeline hazard recognizer generated from the machine description
9589is based on a deterministic finite state automaton (@acronym{DFA}):
9590the instruction issue is possible if there is a transition from one
9591automaton state to another one. This algorithm is very fast, and
9592furthermore, its speed is not dependent on processor
9593complexity@footnote{However, the size of the automaton depends on
6ccde948
RW
9594processor complexity. To limit this effect, machine descriptions
9595can split orthogonal parts of the machine description among several
9596automata: but then, since each of these must be stepped independently,
9597this does cause a small decrease in the algorithm's performance.}.
fae15c93 9598
fae15c93 9599@cindex automaton based pipeline description
fa0aee89
PB
9600The rest of this section describes the directives that constitute
9601an automaton-based processor pipeline description. The order of
9602these constructions within the machine description file is not
9603important.
fae15c93
VM
9604
9605@findex define_automaton
9606@cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
9607The following optional construction describes names of automata
9608generated and used for the pipeline hazards recognition. Sometimes
9609the generated finite state automaton used by the pipeline hazard
ef261fee 9610recognizer is large. If we use more than one automaton and bind functional
daf2f129 9611units to the automata, the total size of the automata is usually
fae15c93
VM
9612less than the size of the single automaton. If there is no one such
9613construction, only one finite state automaton is generated.
9614
9615@smallexample
9616(define_automaton @var{automata-names})
9617@end smallexample
9618
9619@var{automata-names} is a string giving names of the automata. The
9620names are separated by commas. All the automata should have unique names.
c62347f0 9621The automaton name is used in the constructions @code{define_cpu_unit} and
fae15c93
VM
9622@code{define_query_cpu_unit}.
9623
9624@findex define_cpu_unit
9625@cindex processor functional units
c62347f0 9626Each processor functional unit used in the description of instruction
fae15c93
VM
9627reservations should be described by the following construction.
9628
9629@smallexample
9630(define_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
9631@end smallexample
9632
9633@var{unit-names} is a string giving the names of the functional units
9634separated by commas. Don't use name @samp{nothing}, it is reserved
9635for other goals.
9636
ef261fee 9637@var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
fae15c93
VM
9638which the unit is bound. The automaton should be described in
9639construction @code{define_automaton}. You should give
9640@dfn{automaton-name}, if there is a defined automaton.
9641
30028c85
VM
9642The assignment of units to automata are constrained by the uses of the
9643units in insn reservations. The most important constraint is: if a
9644unit reservation is present on a particular cycle of an alternative
9645for an insn reservation, then some unit from the same automaton must
9646be present on the same cycle for the other alternatives of the insn
9647reservation. The rest of the constraints are mentioned in the
9648description of the subsequent constructions.
9649
fae15c93
VM
9650@findex define_query_cpu_unit
9651@cindex querying function unit reservations
9652The following construction describes CPU functional units analogously
30028c85
VM
9653to @code{define_cpu_unit}. The reservation of such units can be
9654queried for an automaton state. The instruction scheduler never
9655queries reservation of functional units for given automaton state. So
9656as a rule, you don't need this construction. This construction could
431ae0bf 9657be used for future code generation goals (e.g.@: to generate
30028c85 9658@acronym{VLIW} insn templates).
fae15c93
VM
9659
9660@smallexample
9661(define_query_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
9662@end smallexample
9663
9664@var{unit-names} is a string giving names of the functional units
9665separated by commas.
9666
ef261fee 9667@var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
fae15c93
VM
9668which the unit is bound.
9669
9670@findex define_insn_reservation
9671@cindex instruction latency time
9672@cindex regular expressions
9673@cindex data bypass
ef261fee 9674The following construction is the major one to describe pipeline
fae15c93
VM
9675characteristics of an instruction.
9676
9677@smallexample
9678(define_insn_reservation @var{insn-name} @var{default_latency}
9679 @var{condition} @var{regexp})
9680@end smallexample
9681
9682@var{default_latency} is a number giving latency time of the
9683instruction. There is an important difference between the old
9684description and the automaton based pipeline description. The latency
9685time is used for all dependencies when we use the old description. In
ef261fee
R
9686the automaton based pipeline description, the given latency time is only
9687used for true dependencies. The cost of anti-dependencies is always
fae15c93
VM
9688zero and the cost of output dependencies is the difference between
9689latency times of the producing and consuming insns (if the difference
ef261fee
R
9690is negative, the cost is considered to be zero). You can always
9691change the default costs for any description by using the target hook
fae15c93
VM
9692@code{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST} (@pxref{Scheduling}).
9693
cc6a602b 9694@var{insn-name} is a string giving the internal name of the insn. The
fae15c93
VM
9695internal names are used in constructions @code{define_bypass} and in
9696the automaton description file generated for debugging. The internal
ef261fee 9697name has nothing in common with the names in @code{define_insn}. It is a
fae15c93
VM
9698good practice to use insn classes described in the processor manual.
9699
9700@var{condition} defines what RTL insns are described by this
9701construction. You should remember that you will be in trouble if
9702@var{condition} for two or more different
9703@code{define_insn_reservation} constructions is TRUE for an insn. In
9704this case what reservation will be used for the insn is not defined.
9705Such cases are not checked during generation of the pipeline hazards
9706recognizer because in general recognizing that two conditions may have
9707the same value is quite difficult (especially if the conditions
9708contain @code{symbol_ref}). It is also not checked during the
9709pipeline hazard recognizer work because it would slow down the
9710recognizer considerably.
9711
ef261fee 9712@var{regexp} is a string describing the reservation of the cpu's functional
fae15c93
VM
9713units by the instruction. The reservations are described by a regular
9714expression according to the following syntax:
9715
9716@smallexample
9717 regexp = regexp "," oneof
9718 | oneof
9719
9720 oneof = oneof "|" allof
9721 | allof
9722
9723 allof = allof "+" repeat
9724 | repeat
daf2f129 9725
fae15c93
VM
9726 repeat = element "*" number
9727 | element
9728
9729 element = cpu_function_unit_name
9730 | reservation_name
9731 | result_name
9732 | "nothing"
9733 | "(" regexp ")"
9734@end smallexample
9735
9736@itemize @bullet
9737@item
9738@samp{,} is used for describing the start of the next cycle in
9739the reservation.
9740
9741@item
9742@samp{|} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
9743regular expression @strong{or} a reservation described by the second
9744regular expression @strong{or} etc.
9745
9746@item
9747@samp{+} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
9748regular expression @strong{and} a reservation described by the
9749second regular expression @strong{and} etc.
9750
9751@item
9752@samp{*} is used for convenience and simply means a sequence in which
9753the regular expression are repeated @var{number} times with cycle
9754advancing (see @samp{,}).
9755
9756@item
9757@samp{cpu_function_unit_name} denotes reservation of the named
9758functional unit.
9759
9760@item
9761@samp{reservation_name} --- see description of construction
9762@samp{define_reservation}.
9763
9764@item
9765@samp{nothing} denotes no unit reservations.
9766@end itemize
9767
9768@findex define_reservation
9769Sometimes unit reservations for different insns contain common parts.
9770In such case, you can simplify the pipeline description by describing
9771the common part by the following construction
9772
9773@smallexample
9774(define_reservation @var{reservation-name} @var{regexp})
9775@end smallexample
9776
9777@var{reservation-name} is a string giving name of @var{regexp}.
9778Functional unit names and reservation names are in the same name
9779space. So the reservation names should be different from the
cc6a602b 9780functional unit names and can not be the reserved name @samp{nothing}.
fae15c93
VM
9781
9782@findex define_bypass
9783@cindex instruction latency time
9784@cindex data bypass
9785The following construction is used to describe exceptions in the
9786latency time for given instruction pair. This is so called bypasses.
9787
9788@smallexample
9789(define_bypass @var{number} @var{out_insn_names} @var{in_insn_names}
9790 [@var{guard}])
9791@end smallexample
9792
9793@var{number} defines when the result generated by the instructions
9794given in string @var{out_insn_names} will be ready for the
f9bf5a8e
RS
9795instructions given in string @var{in_insn_names}. Each of these
9796strings is a comma-separated list of filename-style globs and
9797they refer to the names of @code{define_insn_reservation}s.
9798For example:
9799@smallexample
9800(define_bypass 1 "cpu1_load_*, cpu1_store_*" "cpu1_load_*")
9801@end smallexample
9802defines a bypass between instructions that start with
9803@samp{cpu1_load_} or @samp{cpu1_store_} and those that start with
9804@samp{cpu1_load_}.
fae15c93 9805
ef261fee 9806@var{guard} is an optional string giving the name of a C function which
fae15c93
VM
9807defines an additional guard for the bypass. The function will get the
9808two insns as parameters. If the function returns zero the bypass will
9809be ignored for this case. The additional guard is necessary to
431ae0bf 9810recognize complicated bypasses, e.g.@: when the consumer is only an address
fae15c93
VM
9811of insn @samp{store} (not a stored value).
9812
20a07f44
VM
9813If there are more one bypass with the same output and input insns, the
9814chosen bypass is the first bypass with a guard in description whose
9815guard function returns nonzero. If there is no such bypass, then
9816bypass without the guard function is chosen.
9817
fae15c93
VM
9818@findex exclusion_set
9819@findex presence_set
30028c85 9820@findex final_presence_set
fae15c93 9821@findex absence_set
30028c85 9822@findex final_absence_set
fae15c93
VM
9823@cindex VLIW
9824@cindex RISC
cc6a602b
BE
9825The following five constructions are usually used to describe
9826@acronym{VLIW} processors, or more precisely, to describe a placement
9827of small instructions into @acronym{VLIW} instruction slots. They
9828can be used for @acronym{RISC} processors, too.
fae15c93
VM
9829
9830@smallexample
9831(exclusion_set @var{unit-names} @var{unit-names})
30028c85
VM
9832(presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
9833(final_presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
9834(absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
9835(final_absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
fae15c93
VM
9836@end smallexample
9837
9838@var{unit-names} is a string giving names of functional units
9839separated by commas.
9840
30028c85 9841@var{patterns} is a string giving patterns of functional units
0bdcd332 9842separated by comma. Currently pattern is one unit or units
30028c85
VM
9843separated by white-spaces.
9844
fae15c93
VM
9845The first construction (@samp{exclusion_set}) means that each
9846functional unit in the first string can not be reserved simultaneously
9847with a unit whose name is in the second string and vice versa. For
9848example, the construction is useful for describing processors
431ae0bf 9849(e.g.@: some SPARC processors) with a fully pipelined floating point
fae15c93
VM
9850functional unit which can execute simultaneously only single floating
9851point insns or only double floating point insns.
9852
9853The second construction (@samp{presence_set}) means that each
9854functional unit in the first string can not be reserved unless at
30028c85
VM
9855least one of pattern of units whose names are in the second string is
9856reserved. This is an asymmetric relation. For example, it is useful
9857for description that @acronym{VLIW} @samp{slot1} is reserved after
9858@samp{slot0} reservation. We could describe it by the following
9859construction
9860
9861@smallexample
9862(presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
9863@end smallexample
9864
9865Or @samp{slot1} is reserved only after @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
9866reservation. In this case we could write
9867
9868@smallexample
9869(presence_set "slot1" "slot0 b0")
9870@end smallexample
9871
9872The third construction (@samp{final_presence_set}) is analogous to
9873@samp{presence_set}. The difference between them is when checking is
9874done. When an instruction is issued in given automaton state
9875reflecting all current and planned unit reservations, the automaton
9876state is changed. The first state is a source state, the second one
9877is a result state. Checking for @samp{presence_set} is done on the
9878source state reservation, checking for @samp{final_presence_set} is
9879done on the result reservation. This construction is useful to
9880describe a reservation which is actually two subsequent reservations.
9881For example, if we use
9882
9883@smallexample
9884(presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
9885@end smallexample
9886
9887the following insn will be never issued (because @samp{slot1} requires
9888@samp{slot0} which is absent in the source state).
9889
9890@smallexample
9891(define_reservation "insn_and_nop" "slot0 + slot1")
9892@end smallexample
9893
9894but it can be issued if we use analogous @samp{final_presence_set}.
9895
9896The forth construction (@samp{absence_set}) means that each functional
9897unit in the first string can be reserved only if each pattern of units
9898whose names are in the second string is not reserved. This is an
9899asymmetric relation (actually @samp{exclusion_set} is analogous to
ff2ce160 9900this one but it is symmetric). For example it might be useful in a
a71b1c58
NC
9901@acronym{VLIW} description to say that @samp{slot0} cannot be reserved
9902after either @samp{slot1} or @samp{slot2} have been reserved. This
9903can be described as:
30028c85
VM
9904
9905@smallexample
a71b1c58 9906(absence_set "slot0" "slot1, slot2")
30028c85
VM
9907@end smallexample
9908
9909Or @samp{slot2} can not be reserved if @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
9910are reserved or @samp{slot1} and unit @samp{b1} are reserved. In
9911this case we could write
9912
9913@smallexample
9914(absence_set "slot2" "slot0 b0, slot1 b1")
9915@end smallexample
fae15c93 9916
ef261fee 9917All functional units mentioned in a set should belong to the same
fae15c93
VM
9918automaton.
9919
30028c85
VM
9920The last construction (@samp{final_absence_set}) is analogous to
9921@samp{absence_set} but checking is done on the result (state)
9922reservation. See comments for @samp{final_presence_set}.
9923
fae15c93
VM
9924@findex automata_option
9925@cindex deterministic finite state automaton
9926@cindex nondeterministic finite state automaton
9927@cindex finite state automaton minimization
9928You can control the generator of the pipeline hazard recognizer with
9929the following construction.
9930
9931@smallexample
9932(automata_option @var{options})
9933@end smallexample
9934
9935@var{options} is a string giving options which affect the generated
9936code. Currently there are the following options:
9937
9938@itemize @bullet
9939@item
9940@dfn{no-minimization} makes no minimization of the automaton. This is
30028c85
VM
9941only worth to do when we are debugging the description and need to
9942look more accurately at reservations of states.
fae15c93
VM
9943
9944@item
df1133a6
BE
9945@dfn{time} means printing time statistics about the generation of
9946automata.
9947
9948@item
9949@dfn{stats} means printing statistics about the generated automata
9950such as the number of DFA states, NDFA states and arcs.
e3c8eb86
VM
9951
9952@item
9953@dfn{v} means a generation of the file describing the result automata.
9954The file has suffix @samp{.dfa} and can be used for the description
9955verification and debugging.
9956
9957@item
9958@dfn{w} means a generation of warning instead of error for
9959non-critical errors.
fae15c93 9960
e12da141
BS
9961@item
9962@dfn{no-comb-vect} prevents the automaton generator from generating
9963two data structures and comparing them for space efficiency. Using
9964a comb vector to represent transitions may be better, but it can be
9965very expensive to construct. This option is useful if the build
9966process spends an unacceptably long time in genautomata.
9967
fae15c93
VM
9968@item
9969@dfn{ndfa} makes nondeterministic finite state automata. This affects
9970the treatment of operator @samp{|} in the regular expressions. The
9971usual treatment of the operator is to try the first alternative and,
9972if the reservation is not possible, the second alternative. The
9973nondeterministic treatment means trying all alternatives, some of them
96ddf8ef 9974may be rejected by reservations in the subsequent insns.
dfa849f3 9975
1e6a9047 9976@item
9c582551 9977@dfn{collapse-ndfa} modifies the behavior of the generator when
1e6a9047
BS
9978producing an automaton. An additional state transition to collapse a
9979nondeterministic @acronym{NDFA} state to a deterministic @acronym{DFA}
9980state is generated. It can be triggered by passing @code{const0_rtx} to
9981state_transition. In such an automaton, cycle advance transitions are
9982available only for these collapsed states. This option is useful for
9983ports that want to use the @code{ndfa} option, but also want to use
9984@code{define_query_cpu_unit} to assign units to insns issued in a cycle.
9985
dfa849f3
VM
9986@item
9987@dfn{progress} means output of a progress bar showing how many states
9988were generated so far for automaton being processed. This is useful
9989during debugging a @acronym{DFA} description. If you see too many
9990generated states, you could interrupt the generator of the pipeline
9991hazard recognizer and try to figure out a reason for generation of the
9992huge automaton.
fae15c93
VM
9993@end itemize
9994
9995As an example, consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} machine which can
9996issue three insns (two integer insns and one floating point insn) on
9997the cycle but can finish only two insns. To describe this, we define
9998the following functional units.
9999
10000@smallexample
10001(define_cpu_unit "i0_pipeline, i1_pipeline, f_pipeline")
ef261fee 10002(define_cpu_unit "port0, port1")
fae15c93
VM
10003@end smallexample
10004
10005All simple integer insns can be executed in any integer pipeline and
10006their result is ready in two cycles. The simple integer insns are
10007issued into the first pipeline unless it is reserved, otherwise they
10008are issued into the second pipeline. Integer division and
10009multiplication insns can be executed only in the second integer
793e17f9 10010pipeline and their results are ready correspondingly in 9 and 4
431ae0bf 10011cycles. The integer division is not pipelined, i.e.@: the subsequent
fae15c93
VM
10012integer division insn can not be issued until the current division
10013insn finished. Floating point insns are fully pipelined and their
ef261fee
R
10014results are ready in 3 cycles. Where the result of a floating point
10015insn is used by an integer insn, an additional delay of one cycle is
10016incurred. To describe all of this we could specify
fae15c93
VM
10017
10018@smallexample
10019(define_cpu_unit "div")
10020
68e4d4c5 10021(define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
ef261fee 10022 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), (port0 | port1)")
fae15c93 10023
68e4d4c5 10024(define_insn_reservation "mult" 4 (eq_attr "type" "mult")
ef261fee 10025 "i1_pipeline, nothing*2, (port0 | port1)")
fae15c93 10026
793e17f9 10027(define_insn_reservation "div" 9 (eq_attr "type" "div")
ef261fee 10028 "i1_pipeline, div*7, div + (port0 | port1)")
fae15c93 10029
68e4d4c5 10030(define_insn_reservation "float" 3 (eq_attr "type" "float")
ef261fee 10031 "f_pipeline, nothing, (port0 | port1))
fae15c93 10032
ef261fee 10033(define_bypass 4 "float" "simple,mult,div")
fae15c93
VM
10034@end smallexample
10035
10036To simplify the description we could describe the following reservation
10037
10038@smallexample
10039(define_reservation "finish" "port0|port1")
10040@end smallexample
10041
10042and use it in all @code{define_insn_reservation} as in the following
10043construction
10044
10045@smallexample
68e4d4c5 10046(define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
fae15c93
VM
10047 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), finish")
10048@end smallexample
10049
10050
a5249a21
HPN
10051@end ifset
10052@ifset INTERNALS
3262c1f5
RH
10053@node Conditional Execution
10054@section Conditional Execution
10055@cindex conditional execution
10056@cindex predication
10057
10058A number of architectures provide for some form of conditional
10059execution, or predication. The hallmark of this feature is the
10060ability to nullify most of the instructions in the instruction set.
10061When the instruction set is large and not entirely symmetric, it
10062can be quite tedious to describe these forms directly in the
10063@file{.md} file. An alternative is the @code{define_cond_exec} template.
10064
10065@findex define_cond_exec
10066@smallexample
10067(define_cond_exec
10068 [@var{predicate-pattern}]
10069 "@var{condition}"
aadaf24e
KT
10070 "@var{output-template}"
10071 "@var{optional-insn-attribues}")
3262c1f5
RH
10072@end smallexample
10073
10074@var{predicate-pattern} is the condition that must be true for the
10075insn to be executed at runtime and should match a relational operator.
10076One can use @code{match_operator} to match several relational operators
10077at once. Any @code{match_operand} operands must have no more than one
10078alternative.
10079
10080@var{condition} is a C expression that must be true for the generated
10081pattern to match.
10082
10083@findex current_insn_predicate
630d3d5a 10084@var{output-template} is a string similar to the @code{define_insn}
3262c1f5
RH
10085output template (@pxref{Output Template}), except that the @samp{*}
10086and @samp{@@} special cases do not apply. This is only useful if the
10087assembly text for the predicate is a simple prefix to the main insn.
10088In order to handle the general case, there is a global variable
10089@code{current_insn_predicate} that will contain the entire predicate
10090if the current insn is predicated, and will otherwise be @code{NULL}.
10091
aadaf24e
KT
10092@var{optional-insn-attributes} is an optional vector of attributes that gets
10093appended to the insn attributes of the produced cond_exec rtx. It can
10094be used to add some distinguishing attribute to cond_exec rtxs produced
10095that way. An example usage would be to use this attribute in conjunction
10096with attributes on the main pattern to disable particular alternatives under
10097certain conditions.
10098
ebb48a4d
JM
10099When @code{define_cond_exec} is used, an implicit reference to
10100the @code{predicable} instruction attribute is made.
0bddee8e
BS
10101@xref{Insn Attributes}. This attribute must be a boolean (i.e.@: have
10102exactly two elements in its @var{list-of-values}), with the possible
10103values being @code{no} and @code{yes}. The default and all uses in
10104the insns must be a simple constant, not a complex expressions. It
10105may, however, depend on the alternative, by using a comma-separated
10106list of values. If that is the case, the port should also define an
10107@code{enabled} attribute (@pxref{Disable Insn Alternatives}), which
10108should also allow only @code{no} and @code{yes} as its values.
3262c1f5 10109
ebb48a4d 10110For each @code{define_insn} for which the @code{predicable}
3262c1f5
RH
10111attribute is true, a new @code{define_insn} pattern will be
10112generated that matches a predicated version of the instruction.
10113For example,
10114
10115@smallexample
10116(define_insn "addsi"
10117 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
10118 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10119 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10120 "@var{test1}"
10121 "add %2,%1,%0")
10122
10123(define_cond_exec
10124 [(ne (match_operand:CC 0 "register_operand" "c")
10125 (const_int 0))]
10126 "@var{test2}"
10127 "(%0)")
10128@end smallexample
10129
10130@noindent
10131generates a new pattern
10132
10133@smallexample
10134(define_insn ""
10135 [(cond_exec
10136 (ne (match_operand:CC 3 "register_operand" "c") (const_int 0))
10137 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
10138 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10139 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))))]
10140 "(@var{test2}) && (@var{test1})"
10141 "(%3) add %2,%1,%0")
10142@end smallexample
c25c12b8 10143
a5249a21 10144@end ifset
477c104e
MK
10145@ifset INTERNALS
10146@node Define Subst
10147@section RTL Templates Transformations
10148@cindex define_subst
10149
10150For some hardware architectures there are common cases when the RTL
10151templates for the instructions can be derived from the other RTL
10152templates using simple transformations. E.g., @file{i386.md} contains
10153an RTL template for the ordinary @code{sub} instruction---
10154@code{*subsi_1}, and for the @code{sub} instruction with subsequent
10155zero-extension---@code{*subsi_1_zext}. Such cases can be easily
10156implemented by a single meta-template capable of generating a modified
10157case based on the initial one:
10158
10159@findex define_subst
10160@smallexample
10161(define_subst "@var{name}"
10162 [@var{input-template}]
10163 "@var{condition}"
10164 [@var{output-template}])
10165@end smallexample
10166@var{input-template} is a pattern describing the source RTL template,
10167which will be transformed.
10168
10169@var{condition} is a C expression that is conjunct with the condition
10170from the input-template to generate a condition to be used in the
10171output-template.
10172
10173@var{output-template} is a pattern that will be used in the resulting
10174template.
10175
10176@code{define_subst} mechanism is tightly coupled with the notion of the
bdb6985c 10177subst attribute (@pxref{Subst Iterators}). The use of
477c104e
MK
10178@code{define_subst} is triggered by a reference to a subst attribute in
10179the transforming RTL template. This reference initiates duplication of
10180the source RTL template and substitution of the attributes with their
10181values. The source RTL template is left unchanged, while the copy is
10182transformed by @code{define_subst}. This transformation can fail in the
10183case when the source RTL template is not matched against the
10184input-template of the @code{define_subst}. In such case the copy is
10185deleted.
10186
10187@code{define_subst} can be used only in @code{define_insn} and
10188@code{define_expand}, it cannot be used in other expressions (e.g. in
10189@code{define_insn_and_split}).
10190
10191@menu
10192* Define Subst Example:: Example of @code{define_subst} work.
10193* Define Subst Pattern Matching:: Process of template comparison.
10194* Define Subst Output Template:: Generation of output template.
10195@end menu
10196
10197@node Define Subst Example
10198@subsection @code{define_subst} Example
10199@cindex define_subst
10200
10201To illustrate how @code{define_subst} works, let us examine a simple
10202template transformation.
10203
10204Suppose there are two kinds of instructions: one that touches flags and
10205the other that does not. The instructions of the second type could be
10206generated with the following @code{define_subst}:
10207
10208@smallexample
10209(define_subst "add_clobber_subst"
10210 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
10211 (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))]
10212 ""
10213 [(set (match_dup 0)
10214 (match_dup 1))
10215 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))]
10216@end smallexample
10217
10218This @code{define_subst} can be applied to any RTL pattern containing
10219@code{set} of mode SI and generates a copy with clobber when it is
10220applied.
10221
10222Assume there is an RTL template for a @code{max} instruction to be used
10223in @code{define_subst} mentioned above:
10224
10225@smallexample
10226(define_insn "maxsi"
10227 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10228 (max:SI
10229 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10230 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10231 ""
10232 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10233 [@dots{}])
10234@end smallexample
10235
10236To mark the RTL template for @code{define_subst} application,
10237subst-attributes are used. They should be declared in advance:
10238
10239@smallexample
10240(define_subst_attr "add_clobber_name" "add_clobber_subst" "_noclobber" "_clobber")
10241@end smallexample
10242
10243Here @samp{add_clobber_name} is the attribute name,
10244@samp{add_clobber_subst} is the name of the corresponding
10245@code{define_subst}, the third argument (@samp{_noclobber}) is the
10246attribute value that would be substituted into the unchanged version of
10247the source RTL template, and the last argument (@samp{_clobber}) is the
10248value that would be substituted into the second, transformed,
10249version of the RTL template.
10250
10251Once the subst-attribute has been defined, it should be used in RTL
10252templates which need to be processed by the @code{define_subst}. So,
10253the original RTL template should be changed:
10254
10255@smallexample
10256(define_insn "maxsi<add_clobber_name>"
10257 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10258 (max:SI
10259 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10260 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10261 ""
10262 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10263 [@dots{}])
10264@end smallexample
10265
10266The result of the @code{define_subst} usage would look like the following:
10267
10268@smallexample
10269(define_insn "maxsi_noclobber"
10270 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10271 (max:SI
10272 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10273 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10274 ""
10275 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10276 [@dots{}])
10277(define_insn "maxsi_clobber"
10278 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10279 (max:SI
10280 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10281 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))
10282 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))]
10283 ""
10284 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10285 [@dots{}])
10286@end smallexample
10287
10288@node Define Subst Pattern Matching
10289@subsection Pattern Matching in @code{define_subst}
10290@cindex define_subst
10291
10292All expressions, allowed in @code{define_insn} or @code{define_expand},
10293are allowed in the input-template of @code{define_subst}, except
10294@code{match_par_dup}, @code{match_scratch}, @code{match_parallel}. The
10295meanings of expressions in the input-template were changed:
10296
10297@code{match_operand} matches any expression (possibly, a subtree in
10298RTL-template), if modes of the @code{match_operand} and this expression
10299are the same, or mode of the @code{match_operand} is @code{VOIDmode}, or
10300this expression is @code{match_dup}, @code{match_op_dup}. If the
10301expression is @code{match_operand} too, and predicate of
10302@code{match_operand} from the input pattern is not empty, then the
10303predicates are compared. That can be used for more accurate filtering
10304of accepted RTL-templates.
10305
10306@code{match_operator} matches common operators (like @code{plus},
10307@code{minus}), @code{unspec}, @code{unspec_volatile} operators and
10308@code{match_operator}s from the original pattern if the modes match and
10309@code{match_operator} from the input pattern has the same number of
10310operands as the operator from the original pattern.
10311
10312@node Define Subst Output Template
10313@subsection Generation of output template in @code{define_subst}
10314@cindex define_subst
10315
10316If all necessary checks for @code{define_subst} application pass, a new
10317RTL-pattern, based on the output-template, is created to replace the old
10318template. Like in input-patterns, meanings of some RTL expressions are
10319changed when they are used in output-patterns of a @code{define_subst}.
10320Thus, @code{match_dup} is used for copying the whole expression from the
10321original pattern, which matched corresponding @code{match_operand} from
10322the input pattern.
10323
10324@code{match_dup N} is used in the output template to be replaced with
10325the expression from the original pattern, which matched
10326@code{match_operand N} from the input pattern. As a consequence,
10327@code{match_dup} cannot be used to point to @code{match_operand}s from
10328the output pattern, it should always refer to a @code{match_operand}
8245edf3
PK
10329from the input pattern. If a @code{match_dup N} occurs more than once
10330in the output template, its first occurrence is replaced with the
10331expression from the original pattern, and the subsequent expressions
10332are replaced with @code{match_dup N}, i.e., a reference to the first
10333expression.
477c104e
MK
10334
10335In the output template one can refer to the expressions from the
10336original pattern and create new ones. For instance, some operands could
10337be added by means of standard @code{match_operand}.
10338
10339After replacing @code{match_dup} with some RTL-subtree from the original
10340pattern, it could happen that several @code{match_operand}s in the
10341output pattern have the same indexes. It is unknown, how many and what
10342indexes would be used in the expression which would replace
10343@code{match_dup}, so such conflicts in indexes are inevitable. To
10344overcome this issue, @code{match_operands} and @code{match_operators},
10345which were introduced into the output pattern, are renumerated when all
10346@code{match_dup}s are replaced.
10347
10348Number of alternatives in @code{match_operand}s introduced into the
10349output template @code{M} could differ from the number of alternatives in
10350the original pattern @code{N}, so in the resultant pattern there would
10351be @code{N*M} alternatives. Thus, constraints from the original pattern
10352would be duplicated @code{N} times, constraints from the output pattern
10353would be duplicated @code{M} times, producing all possible combinations.
10354@end ifset
10355
a5249a21 10356@ifset INTERNALS
c25c12b8
R
10357@node Constant Definitions
10358@section Constant Definitions
10359@cindex constant definitions
10360@findex define_constants
10361
10362Using literal constants inside instruction patterns reduces legibility and
10363can be a maintenance problem.
10364
10365To overcome this problem, you may use the @code{define_constants}
10366expression. It contains a vector of name-value pairs. From that
10367point on, wherever any of the names appears in the MD file, it is as
10368if the corresponding value had been written instead. You may use
10369@code{define_constants} multiple times; each appearance adds more
10370constants to the table. It is an error to redefine a constant with
10371a different value.
10372
10373To come back to the a29k load multiple example, instead of
10374
10375@smallexample
10376(define_insn ""
10377 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
10378 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
10379 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
10380 (use (reg:SI 179))
10381 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
10382 ""
10383 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
10384@end smallexample
10385
10386You could write:
10387
10388@smallexample
10389(define_constants [
10390 (R_BP 177)
10391 (R_FC 178)
10392 (R_CR 179)
10393 (R_Q 180)
10394])
10395
10396(define_insn ""
10397 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
10398 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
10399 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
10400 (use (reg:SI R_CR))
10401 (clobber (reg:SI R_CR))])]
10402 ""
10403 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
10404@end smallexample
10405
10406The constants that are defined with a define_constant are also output
10407in the insn-codes.h header file as #defines.
24609606
RS
10408
10409@cindex enumerations
10410@findex define_c_enum
10411You can also use the machine description file to define enumerations.
10412Like the constants defined by @code{define_constant}, these enumerations
10413are visible to both the machine description file and the main C code.
10414
10415The syntax is as follows:
10416
10417@smallexample
10418(define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
10419 @var{value0}
10420 @var{value1}
10421 @dots{}
10422 @var{valuen}
10423])
10424@end smallexample
10425
10426This definition causes the equivalent of the following C code to appear
10427in @file{insn-constants.h}:
10428
10429@smallexample
10430enum @var{name} @{
10431 @var{value0} = 0,
10432 @var{value1} = 1,
10433 @dots{}
10434 @var{valuen} = @var{n}
10435@};
10436#define NUM_@var{cname}_VALUES (@var{n} + 1)
10437@end smallexample
10438
10439where @var{cname} is the capitalized form of @var{name}.
10440It also makes each @var{valuei} available in the machine description
10441file, just as if it had been declared with:
10442
10443@smallexample
10444(define_constants [(@var{valuei} @var{i})])
10445@end smallexample
10446
10447Each @var{valuei} is usually an upper-case identifier and usually
10448begins with @var{cname}.
10449
10450You can split the enumeration definition into as many statements as
10451you like. The above example is directly equivalent to:
10452
10453@smallexample
10454(define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value0}])
10455(define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value1}])
10456@dots{}
10457(define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{valuen}])
10458@end smallexample
10459
10460Splitting the enumeration helps to improve the modularity of each
10461individual @code{.md} file. For example, if a port defines its
10462synchronization instructions in a separate @file{sync.md} file,
10463it is convenient to define all synchronization-specific enumeration
10464values in @file{sync.md} rather than in the main @file{.md} file.
10465
0fe60a1b
RS
10466Some enumeration names have special significance to GCC:
10467
10468@table @code
10469@item unspecv
10470@findex unspec_volatile
10471If an enumeration called @code{unspecv} is defined, GCC will use it
10472when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions. For example:
10473
10474@smallexample
10475(define_c_enum "unspecv" [
10476 UNSPECV_BLOCKAGE
10477])
10478@end smallexample
10479
10480causes GCC to print @samp{(unspec_volatile @dots{} 0)} as:
10481
10482@smallexample
10483(unspec_volatile ... UNSPECV_BLOCKAGE)
10484@end smallexample
10485
10486@item unspec
10487@findex unspec
10488If an enumeration called @code{unspec} is defined, GCC will use
10489it when printing out @code{unspec} expressions. GCC will also use
10490it when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions unless an
10491@code{unspecv} enumeration is also defined. You can therefore
10492decide whether to keep separate enumerations for volatile and
10493non-volatile expressions or whether to use the same enumeration
10494for both.
10495@end table
10496
24609606 10497@findex define_enum
8f4fe86c 10498@anchor{define_enum}
24609606
RS
10499Another way of defining an enumeration is to use @code{define_enum}:
10500
10501@smallexample
10502(define_enum "@var{name}" [
10503 @var{value0}
10504 @var{value1}
10505 @dots{}
10506 @var{valuen}
10507])
10508@end smallexample
10509
10510This directive implies:
10511
10512@smallexample
10513(define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
10514 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue0}
10515 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue1}
10516 @dots{}
10517 @var{cname}_@var{cvaluen}
10518])
10519@end smallexample
10520
8f4fe86c 10521@findex define_enum_attr
24609606 10522where @var{cvaluei} is the capitalized form of @var{valuei}.
8f4fe86c
RS
10523However, unlike @code{define_c_enum}, the enumerations defined
10524by @code{define_enum} can be used in attribute specifications
10525(@pxref{define_enum_attr}).
b11cc610 10526@end ifset
032e8348 10527@ifset INTERNALS
3abcb3a7
HPN
10528@node Iterators
10529@section Iterators
10530@cindex iterators in @file{.md} files
032e8348
RS
10531
10532Ports often need to define similar patterns for more than one machine
3abcb3a7 10533mode or for more than one rtx code. GCC provides some simple iterator
032e8348
RS
10534facilities to make this process easier.
10535
10536@menu
3abcb3a7
HPN
10537* Mode Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for different modes.
10538* Code Iterators:: Doing the same for codes.
57a4717b 10539* Int Iterators:: Doing the same for integers.
477c104e 10540* Subst Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for define_subst.
0016d8d9 10541* Parameterized Names:: Specifying iterator values in C++ code.
032e8348
RS
10542@end menu
10543
3abcb3a7
HPN
10544@node Mode Iterators
10545@subsection Mode Iterators
10546@cindex mode iterators in @file{.md} files
032e8348
RS
10547
10548Ports often need to define similar patterns for two or more different modes.
10549For example:
10550
10551@itemize @bullet
10552@item
10553If a processor has hardware support for both single and double
10554floating-point arithmetic, the @code{SFmode} patterns tend to be
10555very similar to the @code{DFmode} ones.
10556
10557@item
10558If a port uses @code{SImode} pointers in one configuration and
10559@code{DImode} pointers in another, it will usually have very similar
10560@code{SImode} and @code{DImode} patterns for manipulating pointers.
10561@end itemize
10562
3abcb3a7 10563Mode iterators allow several patterns to be instantiated from one
032e8348
RS
10564@file{.md} file template. They can be used with any type of
10565rtx-based construct, such as a @code{define_insn},
10566@code{define_split}, or @code{define_peephole2}.
10567
10568@menu
3abcb3a7 10569* Defining Mode Iterators:: Defining a new mode iterator.
6ccde948
RW
10570* Substitutions:: Combining mode iterators with substitutions
10571* Examples:: Examples
032e8348
RS
10572@end menu
10573
3abcb3a7
HPN
10574@node Defining Mode Iterators
10575@subsubsection Defining Mode Iterators
10576@findex define_mode_iterator
032e8348 10577
3abcb3a7 10578The syntax for defining a mode iterator is:
032e8348
RS
10579
10580@smallexample
923158be 10581(define_mode_iterator @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{condn}")])
032e8348
RS
10582@end smallexample
10583
10584This allows subsequent @file{.md} file constructs to use the mode suffix
10585@code{:@var{name}}. Every construct that does so will be expanded
10586@var{n} times, once with every use of @code{:@var{name}} replaced by
10587@code{:@var{mode1}}, once with every use replaced by @code{:@var{mode2}},
10588and so on. In the expansion for a particular @var{modei}, every
10589C condition will also require that @var{condi} be true.
10590
10591For example:
10592
10593@smallexample
3abcb3a7 10594(define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
032e8348
RS
10595@end smallexample
10596
10597defines a new mode suffix @code{:P}. Every construct that uses
10598@code{:P} will be expanded twice, once with every @code{:P} replaced
10599by @code{:SI} and once with every @code{:P} replaced by @code{:DI}.
10600The @code{:SI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == SImode} and
10601the @code{:DI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == DImode}.
10602
10603As with other @file{.md} conditions, an empty string is treated
10604as ``always true''. @code{(@var{mode} "")} can also be abbreviated
10605to @code{@var{mode}}. For example:
10606
10607@smallexample
3abcb3a7 10608(define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
032e8348
RS
10609@end smallexample
10610
10611means that the @code{:DI} expansion only applies if @code{TARGET_64BIT}
10612but that the @code{:SI} expansion has no such constraint.
10613
3abcb3a7
HPN
10614Iterators are applied in the order they are defined. This can be
10615significant if two iterators are used in a construct that requires
f30990b2 10616substitutions. @xref{Substitutions}.
032e8348 10617
f30990b2 10618@node Substitutions
3abcb3a7 10619@subsubsection Substitution in Mode Iterators
032e8348
RS
10620@findex define_mode_attr
10621
3abcb3a7 10622If an @file{.md} file construct uses mode iterators, each version of the
f30990b2
ILT
10623construct will often need slightly different strings or modes. For
10624example:
032e8348
RS
10625
10626@itemize @bullet
10627@item
10628When a @code{define_expand} defines several @code{add@var{m}3} patterns
10629(@pxref{Standard Names}), each expander will need to use the
10630appropriate mode name for @var{m}.
10631
10632@item
10633When a @code{define_insn} defines several instruction patterns,
10634each instruction will often use a different assembler mnemonic.
f30990b2
ILT
10635
10636@item
10637When a @code{define_insn} requires operands with different modes,
3abcb3a7 10638using an iterator for one of the operand modes usually requires a specific
f30990b2 10639mode for the other operand(s).
032e8348
RS
10640@end itemize
10641
10642GCC supports such variations through a system of ``mode attributes''.
10643There are two standard attributes: @code{mode}, which is the name of
10644the mode in lower case, and @code{MODE}, which is the same thing in
10645upper case. You can define other attributes using:
10646
10647@smallexample
923158be 10648(define_mode_attr @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{valuen}")])
032e8348
RS
10649@end smallexample
10650
10651where @var{name} is the name of the attribute and @var{valuei}
10652is the value associated with @var{modei}.
10653
3abcb3a7 10654When GCC replaces some @var{:iterator} with @var{:mode}, it will scan
f30990b2 10655each string and mode in the pattern for sequences of the form
3abcb3a7 10656@code{<@var{iterator}:@var{attr}>}, where @var{attr} is the name of a
f30990b2 10657mode attribute. If the attribute is defined for @var{mode}, the whole
923158be 10658@code{<@dots{}>} sequence will be replaced by the appropriate attribute
f30990b2 10659value.
032e8348
RS
10660
10661For example, suppose an @file{.md} file has:
10662
10663@smallexample
3abcb3a7 10664(define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
032e8348
RS
10665(define_mode_attr load [(SI "lw") (DI "ld")])
10666@end smallexample
10667
10668If one of the patterns that uses @code{:P} contains the string
10669@code{"<P:load>\t%0,%1"}, the @code{SI} version of that pattern
10670will use @code{"lw\t%0,%1"} and the @code{DI} version will use
10671@code{"ld\t%0,%1"}.
10672
f30990b2
ILT
10673Here is an example of using an attribute for a mode:
10674
10675@smallexample
3abcb3a7 10676(define_mode_iterator LONG [SI DI])
f30990b2 10677(define_mode_attr SHORT [(SI "HI") (DI "SI")])
923158be
RW
10678(define_insn @dots{}
10679 (sign_extend:LONG (match_operand:<LONG:SHORT> @dots{})) @dots{})
f30990b2
ILT
10680@end smallexample
10681
3abcb3a7
HPN
10682The @code{@var{iterator}:} prefix may be omitted, in which case the
10683substitution will be attempted for every iterator expansion.
032e8348
RS
10684
10685@node Examples
3abcb3a7 10686@subsubsection Mode Iterator Examples
032e8348
RS
10687
10688Here is an example from the MIPS port. It defines the following
10689modes and attributes (among others):
10690
10691@smallexample
3abcb3a7 10692(define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
032e8348
RS
10693(define_mode_attr d [(SI "") (DI "d")])
10694@end smallexample
10695
10696and uses the following template to define both @code{subsi3}
10697and @code{subdi3}:
10698
10699@smallexample
10700(define_insn "sub<mode>3"
10701 [(set (match_operand:GPR 0 "register_operand" "=d")
10702 (minus:GPR (match_operand:GPR 1 "register_operand" "d")
10703 (match_operand:GPR 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
10704 ""
10705 "<d>subu\t%0,%1,%2"
10706 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
10707 (set_attr "mode" "<MODE>")])
10708@end smallexample
10709
10710This is exactly equivalent to:
10711
10712@smallexample
10713(define_insn "subsi3"
10714 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
10715 (minus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "d")
10716 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
10717 ""
10718 "subu\t%0,%1,%2"
10719 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
10720 (set_attr "mode" "SI")])
10721
10722(define_insn "subdi3"
10723 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
10724 (minus:DI (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" "d")
10725 (match_operand:DI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
10726 ""
10727 "dsubu\t%0,%1,%2"
10728 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
10729 (set_attr "mode" "DI")])
10730@end smallexample
10731
3abcb3a7
HPN
10732@node Code Iterators
10733@subsection Code Iterators
10734@cindex code iterators in @file{.md} files
10735@findex define_code_iterator
032e8348
RS
10736@findex define_code_attr
10737
3abcb3a7 10738Code iterators operate in a similar way to mode iterators. @xref{Mode Iterators}.
032e8348
RS
10739
10740The construct:
10741
10742@smallexample
923158be 10743(define_code_iterator @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{condn}")])
032e8348
RS
10744@end smallexample
10745
10746defines a pseudo rtx code @var{name} that can be instantiated as
10747@var{codei} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{codei}
10748must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}.
10749
3abcb3a7 10750As with mode iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
032e8348
RS
10751expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
10752@var{code1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{code2}, and so on.
3abcb3a7 10753@xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
032e8348
RS
10754
10755It is possible to define attributes for codes as well as for modes.
10756There are two standard code attributes: @code{code}, the name of the
10757code in lower case, and @code{CODE}, the name of the code in upper case.
10758Other attributes are defined using:
10759
10760@smallexample
923158be 10761(define_code_attr @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{valuen}")])
032e8348
RS
10762@end smallexample
10763
3abcb3a7 10764Here's an example of code iterators in action, taken from the MIPS port:
032e8348
RS
10765
10766@smallexample
3abcb3a7
HPN
10767(define_code_iterator any_cond [unordered ordered unlt unge uneq ltgt unle ungt
10768 eq ne gt ge lt le gtu geu ltu leu])
032e8348
RS
10769
10770(define_expand "b<code>"
10771 [(set (pc)
10772 (if_then_else (any_cond:CC (cc0)
10773 (const_int 0))
10774 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
10775 (pc)))]
10776 ""
10777@{
10778 gen_conditional_branch (operands, <CODE>);
10779 DONE;
10780@})
10781@end smallexample
10782
10783This is equivalent to:
10784
10785@smallexample
10786(define_expand "bunordered"
10787 [(set (pc)
10788 (if_then_else (unordered:CC (cc0)
10789 (const_int 0))
10790 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
10791 (pc)))]
10792 ""
10793@{
10794 gen_conditional_branch (operands, UNORDERED);
10795 DONE;
10796@})
10797
10798(define_expand "bordered"
10799 [(set (pc)
10800 (if_then_else (ordered:CC (cc0)
10801 (const_int 0))
10802 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
10803 (pc)))]
10804 ""
10805@{
10806 gen_conditional_branch (operands, ORDERED);
10807 DONE;
10808@})
10809
923158be 10810@dots{}
032e8348
RS
10811@end smallexample
10812
57a4717b
TB
10813@node Int Iterators
10814@subsection Int Iterators
10815@cindex int iterators in @file{.md} files
10816@findex define_int_iterator
10817@findex define_int_attr
10818
10819Int iterators operate in a similar way to code iterators. @xref{Code Iterators}.
10820
10821The construct:
10822
10823@smallexample
10824(define_int_iterator @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{condn}")])
10825@end smallexample
10826
10827defines a pseudo integer constant @var{name} that can be instantiated as
10828@var{inti} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{int}
10829must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}. Int iterators can appear
10830in only those rtx fields that have 'i' as the specifier. This means that
10831each @var{int} has to be a constant defined using define_constant or
10832define_c_enum.
10833
10834As with mode and code iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
10835expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
10836@var{int1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{int2}, and so on.
10837@xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
10838
10839It is possible to define attributes for ints as well as for codes and modes.
10840Attributes are defined using:
10841
10842@smallexample
10843(define_int_attr @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{valuen}")])
10844@end smallexample
10845
10846Here's an example of int iterators in action, taken from the ARM port:
10847
10848@smallexample
10849(define_int_iterator QABSNEG [UNSPEC_VQABS UNSPEC_VQNEG])
10850
10851(define_int_attr absneg [(UNSPEC_VQABS "abs") (UNSPEC_VQNEG "neg")])
10852
10853(define_insn "neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
10854 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
10855 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
10856 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
10857 QABSNEG))]
10858 "TARGET_NEON"
10859 "vq<absneg>.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
003bb7f3 10860 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
57a4717b
TB
10861)
10862
10863@end smallexample
10864
10865This is equivalent to:
10866
10867@smallexample
10868(define_insn "neon_vqabs<mode>"
10869 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
10870 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
10871 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
10872 UNSPEC_VQABS))]
10873 "TARGET_NEON"
10874 "vqabs.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
003bb7f3 10875 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
57a4717b
TB
10876)
10877
10878(define_insn "neon_vqneg<mode>"
10879 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
10880 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
10881 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
10882 UNSPEC_VQNEG))]
10883 "TARGET_NEON"
10884 "vqneg.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
003bb7f3 10885 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
57a4717b
TB
10886)
10887
10888@end smallexample
10889
477c104e
MK
10890@node Subst Iterators
10891@subsection Subst Iterators
10892@cindex subst iterators in @file{.md} files
10893@findex define_subst
10894@findex define_subst_attr
10895
10896Subst iterators are special type of iterators with the following
10897restrictions: they could not be declared explicitly, they always have
10898only two values, and they do not have explicit dedicated name.
10899Subst-iterators are triggered only when corresponding subst-attribute is
10900used in RTL-pattern.
10901
10902Subst iterators transform templates in the following way: the templates
10903are duplicated, the subst-attributes in these templates are replaced
10904with the corresponding values, and a new attribute is implicitly added
10905to the given @code{define_insn}/@code{define_expand}. The name of the
10906added attribute matches the name of @code{define_subst}. Such
10907attributes are declared implicitly, and it is not allowed to have a
10908@code{define_attr} named as a @code{define_subst}.
10909
10910Each subst iterator is linked to a @code{define_subst}. It is declared
10911implicitly by the first appearance of the corresponding
10912@code{define_subst_attr}, and it is not allowed to define it explicitly.
10913
10914Declarations of subst-attributes have the following syntax:
10915
10916@findex define_subst_attr
10917@smallexample
10918(define_subst_attr "@var{name}"
10919 "@var{subst-name}"
10920 "@var{no-subst-value}"
10921 "@var{subst-applied-value}")
10922@end smallexample
10923
10924@var{name} is a string with which the given subst-attribute could be
10925referred to.
10926
10927@var{subst-name} shows which @code{define_subst} should be applied to an
10928RTL-template if the given subst-attribute is present in the
10929RTL-template.
10930
10931@var{no-subst-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
10932replaced in the first copy of the original RTL-template.
10933
10934@var{subst-applied-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
10935replaced in the second copy of the original RTL-template.
10936
0016d8d9
RS
10937@node Parameterized Names
10938@subsection Parameterized Names
10939@cindex @samp{@@} in instruction pattern names
10940Ports sometimes need to apply iterators using C++ code, in order to
10941get the code or RTL pattern for a specific instruction. For example,
10942suppose we have the @samp{neon_vq<absneg><mode>} pattern given above:
10943
10944@smallexample
10945(define_int_iterator QABSNEG [UNSPEC_VQABS UNSPEC_VQNEG])
10946
10947(define_int_attr absneg [(UNSPEC_VQABS "abs") (UNSPEC_VQNEG "neg")])
10948
10949(define_insn "neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
10950 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
10951 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
10952 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
10953 QABSNEG))]
10954 @dots{}
10955)
10956@end smallexample
10957
10958A port might need to generate this pattern for a variable
10959@samp{QABSNEG} value and a variable @samp{VDQIW} mode. There are two
10960ways of doing this. The first is to build the rtx for the pattern
10961directly from C++ code; this is a valid technique and avoids any risk
10962of combinatorial explosion. The second is to prefix the instruction
10963name with the special character @samp{@@}, which tells GCC to generate
10964the four additional functions below. In each case, @var{name} is the
10965name of the instruction without the leading @samp{@@} character,
10966without the @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholders, and with any underscore
10967before a @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholder removed if keeping it would
10968lead to a double or trailing underscore.
10969
10970@table @samp
10971@item insn_code maybe_code_for_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{})
10972See whether replacing the first @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholder with
10973iterator value @var{i1}, the second with iterator value @var{i2}, and
10974so on, gives a valid instruction. Return its code if so, otherwise
10975return @code{CODE_FOR_nothing}.
10976
10977@item insn_code code_for_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{})
10978Same, but abort the compiler if the requested instruction does not exist.
10979
10980@item rtx maybe_gen_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @dots{})
10981Check for a valid instruction in the same way as
10982@code{maybe_code_for_@var{name}}. If the instruction exists,
10983generate an instance of it using the operand values given by @var{op0},
10984@var{op1}, and so on, otherwise return null.
10985
10986@item rtx gen_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @dots{})
10987Same, but abort the compiler if the requested instruction does not exist,
10988or if the instruction generator invoked the @code{FAIL} macro.
10989@end table
10990
10991For example, changing the pattern above to:
10992
10993@smallexample
10994(define_insn "@@neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
10995 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
10996 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
10997 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
10998 QABSNEG))]
10999 @dots{}
11000)
11001@end smallexample
11002
11003would define the same patterns as before, but in addition would generate
11004the four functions below:
11005
11006@smallexample
11007insn_code maybe_code_for_neon_vq (int, machine_mode);
11008insn_code code_for_neon_vq (int, machine_mode);
11009rtx maybe_gen_neon_vq (int, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
11010rtx gen_neon_vq (int, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
11011@end smallexample
11012
11013Calling @samp{code_for_neon_vq (UNSPEC_VQABS, V8QImode)}
11014would then give @code{CODE_FOR_neon_vqabsv8qi}.
11015
11016It is possible to have multiple @samp{@@} patterns with the same
11017name and same types of iterator. For example:
11018
11019@smallexample
11020(define_insn "@@some_arithmetic_op<mode>"
11021 [(set (match_operand:INTEGER_MODES 0 "register_operand") @dots{})]
11022 @dots{}
11023)
11024
11025(define_insn "@@some_arithmetic_op<mode>"
11026 [(set (match_operand:FLOAT_MODES 0 "register_operand") @dots{})]
11027 @dots{}
11028)
11029@end smallexample
11030
11031would produce a single set of functions that handles both
11032@code{INTEGER_MODES} and @code{FLOAT_MODES}.
11033
032e8348 11034@end ifset